ADE7169ASTZF8 [ADI]

SPECIALTY ANALOG CIRCUIT, PQFP64, ROHS COMPLIANT, MS-026BCD, LQFP-64;
ADE7169ASTZF8
型号: ADE7169ASTZF8
厂家: ADI    ADI
描述:

SPECIALTY ANALOG CIRCUIT, PQFP64, ROHS COMPLIANT, MS-026BCD, LQFP-64

CD
文件: 总152页 (文件大小:2589K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
Single-Phase Energy Measurement IC  
with 8052 MCU, RTC, and LCD Driver  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
GENERAL FEATURES  
MICROPROCESSOR FEATURES  
Wide supply voltage operation: 2.4 V to 3.7 V  
Internal bipolar switch between regulated and battery inputs  
Ultralow power operation with power saving modes (PSM)  
Full operation: 4 mA to 1.6 mA (PLL clock dependent)  
Battery mode: 3.2 mA to 400 μA (PLL clock dependent)  
Sleep mode  
8052-based core  
Single-cycle 4 MIPS 8052 core  
8052-compatible instruction set  
32.768 kHz external crystal with on-chip PLL  
2 external interrupt sources  
External reset pin  
Real-time clock (RTC) mode: 1.5 μA  
Low power battery mode  
RTC and LCD mode: 38 μA (LCD charge pump enabled)  
Reference: 1.2 V 0.1% (10 ppm/°C drift)  
64-lead RoHS package options  
Wake-up from I/O, temperature change1, alarm, and  
universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter (UART)  
LCD driver operation  
Lead frame chip scale package (LFCSP)  
Temperature measurement  
Low profile quad flat package (LQFP)  
Real-time clock (RTC)  
Operating temperature range: −40°C to +85°C  
Counter for seconds, minutes, and hours  
Automatic battery switchover for RTC backup  
Operation down to 2.4 V  
ENERGY MEASUREMENT FEATURES  
Proprietary analog-to-digital converters (ADCs) and digital  
signal processing (DSP) provide high accuracy active  
(watt), reactive (var), and apparent energy (volt-ampere  
(VA)) measurement  
<0.1% error on active energy over a dynamic range of  
1000 to 1 @ 25°C  
<0.5% error on reactive energy over a dynamic range of  
1000 to 1 @ 25°C (ADE7169 and ADE7569 only)  
<0.5% error on root mean square (rms) measurements  
over a dynamic range of 500 to 1 for current (Irms) and  
100 to 1 for voltage (Vrms) @ 25°C  
Supports IEC 62053-21, IEC 62053-22, and IEC 62053-23;  
EN 50470-3 Class A, Class B, and Class C; and ANSI C12-16  
Differential input with programmable gain amplifiers (PGAs)  
supports shunts, current transformers, and di/dt current  
sensors (ADE7169 and ADE7569 only)  
Ultralow battery supply current: 1.5 μA  
Selectable output frequency: 1 Hz to 16 kHz  
Embedded digital crystal frequency compensation for  
calibration and temperature variation of 2 ppm resolution  
Integrated LCD driver  
108-segment driver for the ADE7566/ADE7569 and  
104-segment driver for the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169  
2×, 3×, or 4× multiplexing  
LCD voltages generated internally2 or with external resistors  
Internal adjustable drive voltages up to 5 V independent  
of power supply level2  
On-chip peripherals  
UART interface  
SPI or I2C  
Watchdog timer  
2 current inputs for antitamper detection in the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169  
High frequency outputs proportional to Irms, active, reactive,  
or apparent power (AP)  
Power supply management with user-selectable levels  
Memory: 16 kB flash memory, 512 bytes RAM  
Development tools  
Single-pin emulation  
IDE-based assembly and C-source debugging  
Table 1. Features Available on Each Part  
Feature  
Part No.  
1 Not available in the ADE7116.  
2 Not available in the ADE7116 or ADE7156.  
Antitamper  
Watt, VA, Irms, Vrms  
ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, ADE7169  
ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, ADE7169,  
ADE7566, ADE7569  
Var  
di/dt Sensor  
ADE7169, ADE7569  
ADE7169, ADE7569  
Rev. B  
Information furnished by Analog Devices is believed to be accurate and reliable. However, no  
responsibility is assumed by Analog Devices for its use, nor for any infringements of patents or other  
rights of third parties that may result from its use. Specifications subject to change without notice. No  
license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent or patent rights of Analog Devices.  
Trademarks and registeredtrademarks arethe property of their respective owners.  
One Technology Way, P.O. Box 9106, Norwood, MA 02062-9106, U.S.A.  
Tel: 781.329.4700  
www.analog.com  
Fax: 781.461.3113 ©2007–2008 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved.  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
General Features ............................................................................... 1  
Energy Measurement Features........................................................ 1  
Microprocessor Features.................................................................. 1  
Revision History ............................................................................... 3  
General Description......................................................................... 4  
Functional Block Diagrams............................................................. 4  
Specifications..................................................................................... 6  
Energy Metering........................................................................... 6  
Analog Peripherals ....................................................................... 7  
Digital Interface............................................................................ 8  
Timing Specifications ................................................................ 10  
Absolute Maximum Ratings.......................................................... 15  
Thermal Resistance .................................................................... 15  
ESD Caution................................................................................ 15  
Pin Configurations and Function Descriptions ......................... 16  
Typical Performance Characteristics ........................................... 22  
Performance Curves for the ADE7169 and ADE7569 Only 25  
Terminology .................................................................................... 26  
Special Function Register (SFR) Mapping .................................. 27  
Power Management........................................................................ 29  
Power Management Register Details....................................... 29  
Power Supply Architecture........................................................ 32  
Battery Switchover...................................................................... 32  
Power Supply Management (PSM) Interrupt ......................... 33  
Using the Power Supply Features ............................................. 35  
Operating Modes............................................................................ 37  
PSM0 (Normal Mode) ............................................................... 37  
PSM1 (Battery Mode) ................................................................ 37  
PSM2 (Sleep Mode).................................................................... 37  
3.3 V Peripherals and Wake-Up Events................................... 38  
Transitioning Between Operating Modes ............................... 39  
Using the Power Management Features .................................. 39  
Energy Measurement ..................................................................... 40  
Access to Energy Measurement SFRs...................................... 40  
Access to Internal Energy Measurement Registers................ 40  
Energy Measurement Registers ................................................ 43  
Energy Measurement Internal Register Details ..................... 44  
Interrupt Status/Enable SFRs.................................................... 47  
Analog Inputs.............................................................................. 49  
Analog-to-Digital Conversion.................................................. 50  
Fault Detection ........................................................................... 54  
di/dt Current Sensor and Digital Integrator for the  
ADE7169/ADE7569................................................................... 55  
Power Quality Measurements................................................... 57  
Phase Compensation ................................................................. 59  
RMS Calculation ........................................................................ 59  
Active Power Calculation.......................................................... 62  
Active Energy Calculation ........................................................ 64  
Reactive Power Calculation (ADE7169/ADE7569) .............. 67  
Reactive Energy Calculation (ADE7169/ADE7569)............. 68  
Apparent Power Calculation..................................................... 72  
Apparent Energy Calculation ................................................... 73  
Ampere-Hour Accumulation ................................................... 74  
Energy-to-Frequency Conversion............................................ 75  
Energy Register Scaling............................................................. 76  
Energy Measurement Interrupts .............................................. 76  
Temperature, Battery, and Supply Voltage Measurements........ 77  
Temperature Measurement....................................................... 79  
Battery Measurement................................................................. 79  
External Voltage Measurement ................................................ 80  
8052 MCU Core Architecture....................................................... 82  
MCU Registers............................................................................ 82  
Basic 8052 Registers................................................................... 84  
Standard 8052 SFRs.................................................................... 85  
Memory Overview ..................................................................... 85  
Addressing Modes...................................................................... 86  
Instruction Set ............................................................................ 88  
Read-Modify-Write Instructions ............................................. 90  
Instructions That Affect Flags .................................................. 90  
Dual Data Pointers ......................................................................... 92  
Interrupt System ............................................................................. 93  
Standard 8052 Interrupt Architecture..................................... 93  
Interrupt Architecture ............................................................... 93  
Interrupt Registers...................................................................... 93  
Interrupt Priority........................................................................ 94  
Interrupt Flags ............................................................................ 95  
Interrupt Vectors ........................................................................ 97  
Interrupt Latency........................................................................ 97  
Context Saving............................................................................ 97  
Watchdog Timer............................................................................. 98  
Rev. B | Page 2 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
LCD Driver ................................................................................... 100  
RTC Calibration........................................................................125  
UART Serial Interface...................................................................126  
UART SFRs ................................................................................126  
UART Operation Modes..........................................................129  
UART Baud Rate Generation..................................................130  
UART Additional Features ......................................................132  
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)..................................................133  
SPI Registers ..............................................................................133  
SPI Pins.......................................................................................136  
SPI Master Operating Modes ..................................................137  
SPI Interrupt and Status Flags.................................................138  
I2C-Compatible Interface.............................................................139  
Serial Clock Generation...........................................................139  
Slave Addresses..........................................................................139  
I2C Registers...............................................................................139  
Read and Write Operations .....................................................140  
I2C Receive and Transmit FIFOs.............................................141  
I/O Ports.........................................................................................142  
Parallel I/O.................................................................................142  
I/O Registers ..............................................................................143  
Port 0...........................................................................................146  
Port 1...........................................................................................146  
Port 2...........................................................................................146  
Determining the Version of the Part ..........................................147  
Outline Dimensions......................................................................148  
Ordering Guide .........................................................................149  
LCD Registers........................................................................... 100  
LCD Setup................................................................................. 103  
LCD Timing and Waveforms ................................................. 103  
Blink Mode................................................................................ 104  
Display Element Control......................................................... 104  
Voltage Generation .................................................................. 105  
LCD External Circuitry........................................................... 106  
LCD Function in PSM2 Mode ............................................... 106  
Flash Memory............................................................................... 108  
Flash Memory Overview......................................................... 108  
Flash Memory Organization................................................... 109  
Using the Flash Memory......................................................... 109  
Protecting the Flash Memory................................................. 113  
In-Circuit Programming......................................................... 114  
Timers............................................................................................ 115  
Timer Registers......................................................................... 115  
Timer 0 and Timer 1................................................................ 117  
Timer 2 ...................................................................................... 118  
PLL ................................................................................................. 120  
PLL Registers ............................................................................ 120  
Real-Time Clock (RTC) .............................................................. 121  
RTC SFRs .................................................................................. 121  
Read and Write Operations .................................................... 124  
RTC Modes ............................................................................... 124  
RTC Interrupts ......................................................................... 124  
REVISION HISTORY  
11/08—Rev. A to Rev. B  
Added ADE7116/ADE7156......................................... Throughout  
Changes to Table 1 ............................................................................1  
Added Figure 2 ..................................................................................5  
Changes to Table 13 ........................................................................16  
Added Figure 10 and Table 14; Renumbered Sequentially........19  
Added Exposed Pad Notation to Outline Dimensions ............148  
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................149  
12/07—Rev. 0 to Rev. A  
Added ADE7166/ADE7169.............................................. Universal  
Changes to Table 1 ............................................................................1  
Changes to Ordering Guide.........................................................144  
11/07—Revision 0: Initial Version  
Rev. B | Page 3 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
The microprocessor functionality includes a single-cycle 8052  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE75691 integrate the Analog Devices, Inc., energy (ADE)  
metering IC analog front end and fixed function DSP solution  
with an enhanced 8052 MCU core, an RTC, an LCD driver, and  
all the peripherals to make an electronic energy meter with an  
LCD display in a single part.  
core, a real-time clock with a power supply backup pin, an SPI  
or I2C® interface, and a UART interface. The ready-to-use infor-  
mation from the ADE core reduces the program memory size  
requirement, making it easy to integrate complicated design  
into 16 kB of flash memory.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 also include a 108-/104-segment LCD driver. In the  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569, this driver generates  
voltages capable of driving LCDs up to 5 V.  
The ADE measurement core includes active, reactive, and apparent  
energy calculations, as well as voltage and current rms measure-  
ments. This information is accessible for energy billing by using  
the built-in energy scalars. Many power line supervisory features  
such as SAG, peak, and zero crossing are included in the energy  
measurement DSP to simplify energy meter design.  
1 Patents pending.  
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAMS  
45 11 43 42 41 40 39 38  
37 36  
5
6
7
8
9 10  
57  
43 42  
38 39 40 41  
39 38  
7
6
12  
13  
14  
44  
P2.0/FP18  
P2.1/FP17  
P2.2/FP16  
2
SPI/I C  
3 × 16-BIT  
COUNTER  
TIMERS  
ADE7566/ADE7569  
SERIAL  
INTERFACE  
P2.3 (SDEN/P2.3)  
1.20V  
REF  
16 LCDVP2  
18 LCDVA  
17 LCDVB  
15 LCDVC  
3V/5V LCD  
CHARGE PUMP  
+
52  
53  
I
P
PGA1  
ADC  
ADC  
I
N
4
COM0  
...  
ENERGY  
MEASUREMENT  
DSP  
1
COM3  
+
49  
50  
108-SEGMENT  
LCD DRIVER  
V
P
PGA2  
FP0  
...  
35  
V
N
20 FP15  
SINGLE  
CYCLE  
8052  
PROGRAM MEMORY  
16kB FLASH  
14  
FP16  
WATCHDOG  
TIMER  
63  
54  
DGND  
AGND  
13 FP17  
12 FP18  
MCU  
USER RAM  
256 BYTES  
FP19  
11  
TEMP  
SENSOR  
TEMP  
ADC  
USER XRAM  
256 BYTES  
10 FP20  
9
8
FP21  
FP22  
FP23  
FP24  
FP25  
FP26  
FP27  
FP28  
DOWNLOADER  
DEBUGGER  
BATTERY  
ADC  
V
58  
BAT  
VDCIN  
ADC  
7
PLL  
6
5
POWER SUPPLY  
CONTROL AND  
MONITORING  
UART  
SERIAL  
PORT  
POR  
UART  
TIMER  
RTC  
OSC  
55  
1
LDO  
LDO  
59  
2
47  
46  
48  
45  
64  
60  
61  
62  
56  
51  
44  
37  
36  
Figure 1. ADE7566/ADE7569 Functional Block Diagram  
Rev. B | Page 4 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
45 11 43 42 41 40 39 38  
37 36  
5
6
7
8
9 10  
57  
43 42  
38 39 40 41  
39 38  
7
6
12  
13  
14  
44  
P2.0/FP18  
P2.1/FP17  
1.20V  
REF  
2
SPI/I C  
3 × 16-BIT  
COUNTER  
TIMERS  
P2.2/FP16  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169  
SERIAL  
INTERFACE  
P2.3 (SDEN/P2.3)  
19 LCDVP1  
16 LCDVP2  
18 LCDVA  
17 LCDVB  
15 LCDVC  
+
I
I
52  
53  
PA  
PGA1  
ADC  
ADC  
ADC  
3V/5V LCD  
I
N
CHARGE PUMP  
ENERGY  
MEASUREMENT  
DSP  
PGA1  
+
4
COM0  
...  
55  
PB  
1
COM3  
104-SEGMENT  
LCD DRIVER  
+
49  
50  
V
V
P
FP0  
...  
35  
PGA2  
N
SINGLE  
CYCLE  
8052  
20 FP15  
14 FP16  
13 FP17  
12 FP18  
PROGRAM MEMORY  
16kB FLASH  
WATCHDOG  
TIMER  
MCU  
63  
54  
DGND  
AGND  
USER RAM  
256 BYTES  
TEMP  
SENSOR  
TEMP  
ADC  
FP19  
11  
USER XRAM  
256 BYTES  
DOWNLOADER  
DEBUGGER  
10 FP20  
BATTERY  
ADC  
V
58  
FP21  
FP22  
FP23  
FP24  
FP25  
FP27  
FP28  
9
8
7
6
5
1
2
BAT  
VDCIN  
ADC  
PLL  
POWER SUPPLY  
CONTROL AND  
MONITORING  
UART  
SERIAL  
PORT  
POR  
UART  
TIMER  
RTC  
OSC  
LDO  
LDO  
59  
47  
46  
48  
45  
64  
60  
61  
62  
56  
51  
44  
37  
36  
Figure 2. ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 Functional Block Diagram  
Rev. B | Page 5 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
SPECIFICATIONS  
VDD = 3.3 V 5%, AGND = DGND = 0 V, on-chip reference XTALx = 32.768 kHz, TMIN to TMAX = −40°C to +85°C, unless otherwise noted.  
ENERGY METERING  
Table 2.  
Parameter  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
Test Conditions/Comments  
MEASUREMENT ACCURACY1  
Phase Error Between Channels2  
PF = 0.8 Capacitive  
0.05  
0.05  
0.1  
Degrees  
Degrees  
% of reading  
Phase lead: 37°  
Phase lag: 60°  
Over a dynamic range of 1000 to 1 at 25°C  
VDD = 3.3 V + 100 mV rms/120 Hz  
IPx = VP = 100 mV rms  
PF = 0.5 Inductive  
Active Energy Measurement Error2  
AC Power Supply Rejection2  
Output Frequency Variation  
DC Power Supply Rejection2  
Output Frequency Variation  
Active Energy Measurement Bandwidth1  
Reactive Energy Measurement Error2, 3  
Vrms Measurement Error2  
Vrms Measurement Bandwidth1  
Irms Measurement Error2  
0.01  
%
VDD = 3.3 V 117 mV dc  
0.01  
8
%
kHz  
0.5  
0.5  
3.9  
0.5  
3.9  
% of reading  
% of reading  
kHz  
% of reading  
kHz  
Over a dynamic range of 1000 to 1 at 25°C  
Over a dynamic range of 100 to 1 at 25°C  
Over a dynamic range of 500 to 1 at 25°C  
Irms Measurement Bandwidth1  
ANALOG INPUTS  
Maximum Signal Levels  
ADE7566/ADE7569  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169  
Input Impedance (DC)  
ADC Offset Error2  
400  
400  
250  
mV peak  
mV peak  
mV peak  
kΩ  
mV  
mV  
VP − VN differential input  
IP − IN differential input  
IPA − IN and IPB − IN differential inputs  
770  
10  
1
PGA1 = PGA2 = 1  
PGA1 = 16  
Gain Error2  
Current Channel  
Voltage Channel  
Gain Error Match  
3
3
0.2  
%
%
%
IPA = IPB = 0.4 V dc or IP = 0.4 V dc  
VP − VN = 0.4 V dc  
+3  
CF1 AND CF2 PULSE OUTPUT  
Maximum Output Frequency  
13.5  
kHz  
VP − VN = 400 mV peak, IPA − IN = 250 mV,  
PGA1 = 2 sine wave  
Duty Cycle  
Active High Pulse Width  
FAULT DETECTION 4  
50  
90  
%
ms  
If CF1 or CF2 frequency, >5.55 Hz  
If CF1 or CF2 frequency, <5.55 Hz  
Fault Detection Threshold  
Inactive Input ≠ Active Input  
Input Swap Threshold  
Inactive Input > Active Input  
Accuracy Fault Mode Operation  
IPA Active, IPB = AGND  
IPB Active, IPA = AGND  
Fault Detection Delay  
Swap Delay  
6.25  
6.25  
% of active  
% of active  
IPA or IPB active  
IPA or IPB active  
0.1  
0.1  
3
% of reading  
% of reading  
Seconds  
Over a dynamic range of 500 to 1  
Over a dynamic range of 500 to 1  
3
Seconds  
1 These specifications are not production tested but are guaranteed by design and/or characterization data on production release.  
2 See the Terminology section for definition.  
3 This function is not available in the ADE7166 or ADE7566.  
4 This function is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
Rev. B | Page 6 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ANALOG PERIPHERALS  
Table 3.  
Parameter  
Min  
Typ Max  
Unit  
Test Conditions/Comments  
1
INTERNAL ADCs (BATTERY, TEMPERATURE, VDCIN  
Power Supply Operating Range  
No Missing Codes2  
)
2.4  
8
3.7  
V
Bits  
μs  
Measured on VSWOUT  
Conversion Delay3  
38  
ADC Gain  
VDCIN Measurement  
VBAT Measurement  
Temperature Measurement  
ADC Offset  
15.3  
14.6  
0.78  
mV/LSB  
mV/LSB  
°C/LSB  
VDCIN Measurement at 3 V  
VBAT Measurement at 3.7 V  
Temperature Measurement at 25°C  
VDCIN Analog Input  
206  
205  
129  
LSB  
LSB  
LSB  
Maximum Signal Levels  
Input Impedance (DC)  
Low VDCIN Detection Threshold  
POWER-ON RESET (POR)  
VDD POR  
Detection Threshold  
POR Active Timeout Period  
VSWOUT POR  
0
1
1.09  
3.3  
V
MΩ  
V
1.2  
1.27  
2.95  
2.2  
2.5  
V
ms  
33  
Detection Threshold  
POR Active Timeout Period  
VINTD POR  
1.8  
V
ms  
20  
Detection Threshold  
POR Active Timeout Period  
VINTA POR  
Detection Threshold  
POR Active Timeout Period  
BATTERY SWITCHOVER  
2.0  
2.25  
2.25  
V
ms  
16  
2.05  
V
ms  
120  
Voltage Operating Range (VSWOUT  
VDD to VBAT Switching  
)
2.4  
2.5  
3.7  
V
Switching Threshold (VDD  
)
2.95  
V
Switching Delay  
10  
30  
ns  
ms  
When VDD to VBAT switch activated by VDD  
When VDD to VBAT switch activated by VDCIN  
VBAT to VDD Switching  
Switching Threshold (VDD  
Switching Delay  
VSWOUT to VBAT Leakage Current  
LCD, CHARGE PUMP ACTIVE4  
)
2.5  
2.95  
V
ms  
nA  
30  
10  
Based on VDD > 2.75 V  
VBAT = 0 V, VSWOUT = 3.43 V, TA = 25°C  
Charge Pump Capacitance Between LCDVP1 and  
LCDVP2  
100  
nF  
LCDVA, LCDVB, LCDVC Decoupling Capacitance  
LCDVA  
470  
0
nF  
V
1.75  
LCDVB  
0
3.5  
V
1/3 bias mode  
LCDVC  
0
5.3  
V
1/3 bias mode  
V1 Segment Line Voltage  
V2 Segment Line Voltage  
V3 Segment Line Voltage  
DC Voltage Across Segment and COMx Pin  
LCDVA − 0.1  
LCDVB − 0.1  
LCDVC − 0.1  
LCDVA  
LCDVB  
LCDVC  
50  
V
V
V
mV  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
LCDVC − LCDVB, LCDVC − LCDVA, or  
LCDVB − LCDVA  
Rev. B | Page 7 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Parameter  
Min  
Typ Max  
Unit  
Test Conditions/Comments  
LCD, RESISTOR LADDER ACTIVE  
Leakage Current  
20  
nA  
V
V
1/2 and 1/3 bias modes, no load  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
Current on segment line = −2 μA  
V1 Segment Line Voltage  
V2 Segment Line Voltage  
V3 Segment Line Voltage  
ON-CHIP REFERENCE  
Reference Error  
LCDVA − 0.1  
LCDVB − 0.1  
LCDVC − 0.1  
LCDVA  
LCDVB  
LCDVC  
V
0.9  
50  
mV  
dB  
ppm/°C  
TA = 25°C  
Power Supply Rejection  
Temperature Coefficient2  
80  
10  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116.  
2 These specifications are not production tested but are guaranteed by design and/or characterization data on production release.  
3 Delay between ADC conversion request and interrupt set.  
4 This function is not available in the ADE7116 or ADE7156.  
DIGITAL INTERFACE  
Table 4.  
Parameter  
LOGIC INPUTS1  
Min  
Typ  
Max Unit  
Test Conditions/Comments  
All Inputs Except XTAL1, XTAL2, BCTRL,  
INT0, INT1, RESET  
Input High Voltage, VINH  
Input Low Voltage, VINL  
BCTRL, INT0, INT1, RESET  
Input High Voltage, VINH  
Input Low Voltage, VINL  
Input Currents  
2.0  
1.3  
V
V
0.8  
V
V
0.8  
RESET  
100  
nA  
RESET = VSWOUT = 3.3 V  
Port 0, Port 1, Port 2  
100 nA  
Internal pull-up disabled, input = 0 V or VSWOUT  
Internal pull-up enabled, input = 0 V, VSWOUT = 3.3 V  
All digital inputs  
−3.75  
−8.5  
μA  
pF  
Input Capacitance  
FLASH MEMORY  
Endurance2  
Data Retention3  
10  
20,000  
20  
Cycles  
Years  
TJ = 85°C  
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR4  
Crystal Equivalent Series Resistance  
Crystal Frequency  
XTAL1 Input Capacitance  
XTAL2 Output Capacitance  
30  
32  
50  
kΩ  
kHz  
pF  
32.768 33.5  
12  
12  
pF  
MCU CLOCK RATE (fCORE  
)
4.096  
32  
MHz  
kHz  
Crystal = 32.768 kHz and CD bits = 000  
Crystal = 32.768 kHz and CD bits = 111  
LOGIC OUTPUTS  
Output High Voltage, VOH  
ISOURCE  
Output Low Voltage, VOL  
2.4  
V
μA  
V
VDD = 3.3 V 5%  
VDD = 3.3 V 5%  
80  
0.4  
2
5
ISINK  
mA  
START-UP TIME6  
PSM0 Power-On Time  
From Power Saving Mode 1 (PSM1)  
PSM1 to PSM0  
880  
130  
ms  
ms  
VDD at 2.75 V to PSM0 code execution  
VDD at 2.75 V to PSM0 code execution  
From Power Saving Mode 2 (PSM2)  
PSM2 to PSM1  
48  
ms  
ms  
Wake-up event to PSM1 code execution  
VDD at 2.75 V to PSM0 code execution  
PSM2 to PSM0  
186  
Rev. B | Page 8 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Parameter  
Min  
Typ  
Max Unit  
Test Conditions/Comments  
POWER SUPPLY INPUTS  
VDD  
VBAT  
3.13  
2.4  
3.3  
3.3  
3.46  
3.7  
V
V
INTERNAL POWER SUPPLY SWITCH (VSWOUT  
VBAT to VSWOUT On Resistance  
VDD to VSWOUT On Resistance  
VBAT to/from VDD Switching Open Time  
BCTRL State Change and Switch Delay  
VSWOUT Output Current Drive  
POWER SUPPLY OUTPUTS  
VINTA  
)
22  
10.2  
Ω
Ω
ns  
μs  
mA  
VBAT = 2.4 V  
VDD = 3.13 V  
40  
18  
6
2.3  
2.3  
2.70  
2.70  
V
V
VINTD  
VINTA Power Supply Rejection  
VINTD Power Supply Rejection  
POWER SUPPLY CURRENTS  
Current in Normal Mode (PSM0)  
60  
50  
dB  
dB  
4
5.3  
mA  
mA  
mA  
mA  
fCORE = 4.096 MHz, LCD and meter active  
fCORE = 1.024 MHz, LCD and meter active  
fCORE = 32.768 kHz, LCD and meter active  
fCORE = 4.096 MHz, metering ADC and DSP powered  
down  
2.1  
1.6  
3
3.9  
Current in PSM1  
Current in PSM2  
3.2  
880  
38  
5.05  
mA  
μA  
μA  
μA  
fCORE = 4.096 MHz, LCD active, VBAT = 3.7 V  
fCORE = 1.024 MHz, LCD active  
LCD active with charge pump at 3.3 V + RTC, VBAT = 3.3 V  
RTC only, TA = 25°C, VBAT = 3.3 V  
1.5  
1 Specifications guaranteed by design.  
2 Endurance is qualified as per JEDEC Standard 22 Method A117 and measured at −40°C, +25°C, +85°C, and +125°C.  
3 Retention lifetime equivalent at junction temperature (TJ) = 85°C as per JEDEC Standard 22 Method A117. Retention lifetime derates with junction temperature.  
4 Recommended crystal specifications.  
5 Test carried out with all the I/Os set to a low output level.  
6 Delay between power supply valid and execution of first instruction by 8052 core.  
Rev. B | Page 9 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TIMING SPECIFICATIONS  
AC inputs during testing were driven at VSWOUT − 0.5 V for Logic 1  
and at 0.45 V for Logic 0. Timing measurements were made at VIH  
minimum for Logic 1 and at VIL maximum for Logic 0, as shown in  
Figure 3.  
float when a 100 mV change from the loaded VOH/VOL level  
occurs, as shown in Figure 3.  
CLOAD for all outputs is equal to 80 pF, unless otherwise noted.  
VDD = 2.7 V to 3.6 V; all specifications TMIN to TMAX, unless  
For timing purposes, a port pin is no longer floating when a  
100 mV change from load voltage occurs. A port pin begins to  
otherwise noted.  
V
– 0.5V  
SWOUT  
V
– 0.1V  
V
– 0.1V  
– 0.1V  
LOAD  
LOAD  
0.2V  
+ 0.9V  
SWOUT  
TEST POINTS  
0.2V – 0.1V  
TIMING  
REFERENCE  
POINTS  
V
V
LOAD  
LOAD  
SWOUT  
V
+ 0.1V  
V
LOAD  
LOAD  
0.45V  
Figure 3. Timing Waveform Characteristics  
Table 5. Clock Input (External Clock Driven XTAL1) Parameter  
32.768 kHz External Crystal  
Parameter  
tCK  
tCKL  
tCKH  
tCKR  
Description  
Min  
Typ  
30.52  
6.26  
6.26  
9
Max  
Unit  
μs  
μs  
μs  
ns  
XTAL1 period  
XTAL1 width low  
XTAL1 width high  
XTAL1 rise time  
XTAL1 fall time  
Core clock frequency1  
tCKF  
1/tCORE  
9
ns  
MHz  
1.024  
1 The internal PLL locks onto a multiple (512×) of the 32.768 kHz external crystal frequency to provide a stable 4.096 MHz internal clock for the system. The core can  
operate at this frequency or at a binary submultiple defined by the CD bits of the POWCON SFR, Address 0xC5[2:0] (see Table 26).  
Table 6. I2C-Compatible Interface Timing Parameters (400 kHz)  
Parameter  
Description  
Typ  
1.3  
Unit  
μs  
μs  
μs  
μs  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
tBUF  
tL  
tH  
tSHD  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tRSU  
tPSU  
tR  
Bus-free time between stop condition and start condition  
SCLK low pulse width  
SCLK high pulse width  
Start condition hold time  
Data setup time  
Data hold time  
Setup time for repeated start  
Stop condition setup time  
Rise time of both SCLK and SDATA  
Fall time of both SCLK and SDATA  
Pulse width of spike suppressed  
1.36  
1.14  
251.35  
740  
400  
12.5  
400  
200  
300  
50  
tF  
tSUP  
1
1 Input filtering on both the SCLK and SDATA inputs suppresses noise spikes of <50 ns.  
tBUF  
tSUP  
tR  
SDATA (I/O)  
MSB  
LSB  
ACK  
MSB  
tF  
tDSU  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tDHD  
tR  
tRSU  
tH  
tPSU  
SCLK (I)  
tSHD  
1
8
9
1
2 TO 7  
tSUP  
tL  
S(R)  
PS  
tF  
STOP  
START  
REPEATED  
START  
CONDITION CONDITION  
Figure 4. I2C-Compatible Interface Timing  
Rev. B | Page 10 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 7. SPI Master Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 1) Parameters  
Parameter  
Description  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
2SPIR × tCORE  
1
1
tSL  
tSH  
SCLK low pulse width  
SCLK high pulse width  
Data output valid after SCLK edge  
Data input setup time before SCLK edge  
Data input hold time after SCLK edge  
Data output fall time  
Data output rise time  
SCLK rise time  
SCLK fall time  
2SPIR × tCORE  
1
tDAV  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tDF  
tDR  
tSR  
3 × tCORE  
0
tCORE  
1
19  
19  
19  
19  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
tSF  
1 tCORE depends on the clock divider or CD[2:0] bits of the POWCON SFR, Address 0xC5 (see Table 26); tCORE = 2CD/4.096 MHz.  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 0)  
tSH  
tSL  
tSR  
tSF  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 1)  
tDAV  
tDF  
tDR  
MOSI  
MISO  
MSB  
BITS [6:1]  
LSB  
LSB IN  
MSB IN  
BITS [6:1]  
tDSU  
tDHD  
Figure 5. SPI Master Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 1)  
Rev. B | Page 11 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 8. SPI Master Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 0) Parameters  
Parameter  
Description  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
2SPIR × tCORE  
(SPIR + 1) × tCORE  
(SPIR + 1) × tCORE  
1
1
1
tSL  
tSH  
SCLK low pulse width  
SCLK high pulse width  
2SPIR × tCORE  
1
1
tDAV  
tDOSU  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tDF  
tDR  
tSR  
tSF  
Data output valid after SCLK edge  
Data output setup before SCLK edge  
Data input setup time before SCLK edge  
Data input hold time after SCLK edge  
Data output fall time  
Data output rise time  
SCLK rise time  
SCLK fall time  
3 × tCORE  
75  
0
tCORE  
1
19  
19  
19  
19  
1 tCORE depends on the clock divider or CD[2:0] bits of the POWCON SFR, Address 0xC5 (see Table 26); tCORE = 2CD/4.096 MHz.  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 0)  
tSH  
tSL  
tSR  
tSF  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 1)  
tDAV  
tDOSU  
tDF  
tDR  
MOSI  
MISO  
MSB  
BITS [6:1]  
LSB  
LSB IN  
MSB IN  
BITS [6:1]  
tDSU tDHD  
Figure 6. SPI Master Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 0)  
Rev. B | Page 12 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 9. SPI Slave Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 1) Parameters  
Parameter  
Description  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
tSS  
SS to SCLK edge  
145  
ns  
1
1
tSL  
tSH  
SCLK low pulse width  
SCLK high pulse width  
Data output valid after SCLK edge  
Data input setup time before SCLK edge  
Data input hold time after SCLK edge  
Data output fall time  
Data output rise time  
SCLK rise time  
SCLK fall time  
SS high after SCLK edge  
6 × tCORE  
6 × tCORE  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
μs  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
tDAV  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tDF  
tDR  
tSR  
25  
0
2 × tCORE1 + 0.5 μs  
19  
19  
19  
19  
tSF  
tSFS  
0
1 tCORE depends on the clock divider or CD[2:0] bits of the POWCON SFR, Address 0xC5 (see Table 26); tCORE = 2CD/4.096 MHz.  
SS  
tSFS  
tSS  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 0)  
tSH  
tSL  
tSR  
tSF  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 1)  
tDAV  
tDF  
tDR  
MSB  
LSB  
BITS [6:1]  
MISO  
MOSI  
MSB IN  
BITS [6:1]  
LSB IN  
tDSU  
tDHD  
Figure 7. SPI Slave Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 1)  
Rev. B | Page 13 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 10. SPI Slave Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 0) Parameters  
Parameter  
Description  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
tSS  
SS to SCLK edge  
145  
ns  
1
1
tSL  
tSH  
tDAV  
tDSU  
tDHD  
tDF  
tDR  
tSR  
tSF  
tDOSS  
tSFS  
SCLK low pulse width  
SCLK high pulse width  
Data output valid after SCLK edge  
Data input setup time before SCLK edge  
Data input hold time after SCLK edge  
Data output fall time  
Data output rise time  
SCLK rise time  
SCLK fall time  
Data output valid after SS edge  
SS high after SCLK edge  
6 × tCORE  
6 × tCORE  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
μs  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
25  
0
2 × tCORE1+ 0.5 μs  
19  
19  
19  
19  
0
0
1 tCORE depends on the clock divider or CD[2:0] bits of the POWCON SFR, Address 0xC5 (see Table 26); tCORE = 2CD/4.096 MHz.  
SS  
tSFS  
tSS  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 0)  
tSH  
tSL  
tSR  
tSF  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 1)  
tDAV  
tDOSS  
tDF  
tDR  
MSB  
BITS [6:1]  
LSB  
MISO  
MOSI  
BITS [6:1]  
LSB IN  
MSB IN  
tDSU  
tDHD  
Figure 8. SPI Slave Mode Timing (SPICPHA = 0)  
Rev. B | Page 14 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS  
TA = 25°C, unless otherwise noted.  
Stresses above those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings  
may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress  
rating only; functional operation of the device at these or any  
other conditions above those indicated in the operational  
section of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute  
maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect  
device reliability.  
Table 11.  
Parameter  
Rating  
VDD to DGND  
VBAT to DGND  
VDCIN to DGND  
Input LCD Voltage to AGND, LCDVA,  
LCDVB, LCDVC1  
−0.3 V to +3.7 V  
−0.3 V to +3.7 V  
−0.3 V to VSWOUT + 0.3 V  
−0.3 V to VSWOUT + 0.3 V  
THERMAL RESISTANCE  
Analog Input Voltage to AGND, VP, VN,  
IP, IPA, IPB, and IN  
Digital Input Voltage to DGND  
Digital Output Voltage to DGND  
Operating Temperature Range  
(Industrial)  
Storage Temperature Range  
−2 V to +2 V  
θJA is specified for the worst-case conditions, that is, a device  
soldered in a circuit board for surface-mount packages.  
−0.3 V to VSWOUT + 0.3 V  
−0.3 V to VSWOUT + 0.3 V  
−40°C to +85°C  
Table 12. Thermal Resistance  
Package Type  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LFCSP  
θJA  
60  
27.1  
θJC  
Unit  
°C/W  
°C/W  
20.5  
2.3  
−65°C to +150°C  
64-Lead LQFP, Power Dissipation  
Lead Temperature (Soldering, 30 sec) 300°C  
1 When used with external resistor divider.  
ESD CAUTION  
Rev. B | Page 15 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PIN CONFIGURATIONS AND FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS  
PIN 1  
INDICATOR  
COM3/FP27  
COM2/FP28  
COM1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
48 INT0  
47 XTAL1  
46 XTAL2  
COM0  
45 BCTRL/INT1/P0.0  
44 SDEN/P2.3  
43 P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL  
42 P0.3/CF2  
41 P0.4/MOSI/SDATA  
40 P0.5/MISO  
39 P0.6/SCLK/T0  
38 P0.7/SS/T1  
37 P1.0/RxD  
36 P1.1/TxD  
35 FP0  
P1.2/FP25  
P1.3/T2EX/FP24  
P1.4/T2/FP23  
P1.5/FP22  
P1.6/FP21  
ADE7566/ADE7569  
TOP VIEW  
(Not to Scale)  
P1.7/FP20 10  
P0.1/FP19 11  
P2.0/FP18 12  
P2.1/FP17 13  
P2.2/FP16 14  
LCDVC 15  
34 FP1  
LCDVP2 16  
33 FP2  
NOTES  
1. IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE EXPOSED PAD ON THE BOTTOM OF THE LFCSP BE  
CONNECTED TO THE GROUND PLANE ON THE BOARD.  
Figure 9. Pin Configuration for the ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 13. Pin Function Descriptions  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
1
2
3
COM3/FP27  
COM2/FP28  
COM1  
Common Output 3/LCD Segment Output 27. COM3 is used for the LCD backplane.  
Common Output 2/LCD Segment Output 28. COM2 is used for the LCD backplane.  
Common Output 1. COM1 is used for the LCD backplane.  
4
COM0  
Common Output 0. COM0 is used for the LCD backplane.  
5
6
7
8
P1.2/FP25  
P1.3/T2EX/FP24  
P1.4/T2/FP23  
P1.5/FP22  
P1.6/FP21  
P1.7/FP20  
P0.1/FP19  
P2.0/FP18  
P2.1/FP17  
P2.2/FP16  
LCDVC  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.2/LCD Segment Output 25.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.3/Timer 2 Control Input/LCD Segment Output 24.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.4/Timer 2 Input/LCD Segment Output 23.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.5/LCD Segment Output 22.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.6/LCD Segment Output 21.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.7/LCD Segment Output 20.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.1/LCD Segment Output 19.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.0/LCD Segment Output 18.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.1/LCD Segment Output 17.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.2/LCD Segment Output 16.  
This pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or an analog output when  
the LCD charge pump is enabled. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF  
capacitor. When this pin is an analog input, it is internally connected to VDD. A resistor should be connected  
between this pin and LCDVB to generate the two highest voltages for the LCD waveforms (see the LCD  
Driver section).  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
LCDVP2  
LCDVB  
This pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or an analog output when  
the LCD charge pump is enabled. When this pin is an analog output, a 100 nF capacitor should be connected  
between this pin and LCDVP1. When this pin is an analog input, it is internally connected to LCDVP1 (see the  
LCD Driver section).  
This pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or an analog output when  
the LCD charge pump is enabled. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF  
capacitor. When this pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this pin and LCDVC to  
generate an intermediate voltage for the LCD driver. In 1/3 bias LCD mode, another resistor must be  
connected between this pin and LCDVA to generate another intermediate voltage. In 1/2 bias LCD mode,  
LCDVB and LCDVA are internally connected (see the LCD Driver section).  
Rev. B | Page 16 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
18  
LCDVA  
This pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or an analog output when the  
LCD charge pump is enabled. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF  
capacitor. When this pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this pin and LCDVP1  
to generate an intermediate voltage for the LCD driver. In 1/3 bias LCD mode, another resistor must be  
connected between this pin and LCDVB to generate another intermediate voltage. In 1/2 bias LCD mode,  
LCDVA and LCDVB are internally connected (see the LCD Driver section).  
19  
LCDVP1  
This pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or an analog output when the  
LCD charge pump is enabled. When this pin is an analog output, a 100 nF capacitor should be connected  
between this pin and LCDVP2. When this pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this  
pin and LCDVA to generate an intermediate voltage for the LCD driver. Another resistor must be connected  
between LCDVP1 and DGND to generate another intermediate voltage (see the LCD Driver section).  
20 to 35 FP15 to FP0  
LCD Segment Output 15 to LCD Segment Output 0.  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
P1.1/TxD  
P1.0/RxD  
P0.7/SS/T1  
P0.6/SCLK/T0  
P0.5/MISO  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.1/Transmitter Data Output (Asynchronous).  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.0/Receiver Data Input (Asynchronous).  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.7/Slave Select When SPI Is in Slave Mode/Timer 1 Input.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.6/Clock Output for I2C or SPI Port/Timer 0 Input.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.5/Data Input for SPI Port.  
P0.4/MOSI/SDATA General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.4/Data Output for SPI Port/I2C-Compatible Data Line.  
P0.3/CF2  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.3/Calibration Frequency Logic Output 2. The CF2 logic output gives  
instantaneous active, reactive, Irms, or apparent power information.  
43  
44  
P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.2/Calibration Frequency Logic Output 1/RTC Calibration Frequency Logic  
Output. The CF1 logic output gives instantaneous active, reactive, Irms, or apparent information. The RTCCAL  
logic output gives access to the calibrated RTC output.  
SDEN/P2.3  
Serial Download Mode Enable/General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.3. This pin is used to enable serial  
download mode through a resistor when pulled low on power-up or reset. On reset, this pin momentarily  
becomes an input, and the status of the pin is sampled. If there is no pull-down resistor in place, the pin  
momentarily goes high and then user code is executed. If the pin is pulled down on reset, the embedded  
serial download/debug kernel executes, and this pin remains low during the internal program execution.  
After reset, this pin can be used as a digital output port pin (P2.3).  
45  
46  
47  
BCTRL/INT1/P0.0  
XTAL2  
Digital Input for Battery Control/External Interrupt Input 1/General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.0. This logic  
input connects VDD or VBAT to VSWOUT internally when set to logic high or logic low, respectively. When left  
open, the connection between VDD or VBAT and VSWOUT is selected internally.  
A crystal can be connected across this pin and XTAL1 to provide a clock source for the ADE7566/ADE7569.  
The XTAL2 pin can drive one CMOS load when an external clock is supplied at XTAL1 or by the gate oscillator  
circuit. An internal 6 pF capacitor is connected to this pin.  
An external clock can be provided at this logic input. Alternatively, a tuning fork crystal can be connected  
across XTAL1 and XTAL2 to provide a clock source for the ADE7566/ADE7569. The clock frequency for  
specified operation is 32.768 kHz. An internal 6 pF capacitor is connected to this pin.  
XTAL1  
48  
INT0  
External Interrupt Input 0.  
49, 50  
VP, VN  
Analog Inputs for Voltage Channel. These inputs are fully differential voltage inputs with a maximum  
differential level of 400 mV for specified operation. This channel also has an internal PGA.  
51  
EA  
This pin is used as an input for emulation. When held high, this input enables the device to fetch code from  
internal program memory locations. The ADE7566/ADE7569 do not support external code memory. This pin  
should not be left floating.  
52, 53  
IP, IN  
Analog Inputs for Current Channel. These inputs are fully differential voltage inputs with a maximum  
differential level of 400 mV for specified operation. This channel also has an internal PGA.  
54  
55  
56  
57  
AGND  
FP26  
RESET  
REFIN/OUT  
This pin provides the ground reference for the analog circuitry.  
LCD Segment Output 26.  
Reset Input, Active Low.  
This pin provides access to the on-chip voltage reference. The on-chip reference has a nominal value of  
1.2 V 0.1% and a maximum temperature coefficient of 50 ppm/°C. This pin should be decoupled with a 1  
μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
58  
59  
VBAT  
Power Supply Input from the Battery with a 2.4 V to 3.7 V Range. This pin is connected internally to VDD when  
the battery is selected as the power supply for the ADE7566/ADE7569.  
This pin provides access to the on-chip 2.5 V analog LDO. No external active circuitry should be connected to  
this pin. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
VINTA  
Rev. B | Page 17 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
60  
61  
62  
VDD  
3.3 V Power Supply Input from the Regulator. This pin is connected internally to VSWOUT when the regulator is  
selected as the power supply for the ADE7566/ADE7569. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor  
in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
3.3 V Power Supply Output. This pin provides the supply voltage for the LDOs and internal circuitry of the  
ADE7566/ADE7569. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF  
capacitor.  
VSWOUT  
VINTD  
This pin provides access to the on-chip 2.5 V digital LDO. No external active circuitry should be connected to  
this pin. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
63  
64  
DGND  
VDCIN  
Ground Reference for Digital Circuitry.  
Analog Input for DC Voltage Monitoring. The maximum input voltage on this pin is VSWOUT with respect to  
AGND. This pin is used to monitor the preregulated dc voltage.  
EP  
Exposed Pad  
The exposed pad on the bottom of the LFCSP enhances thermal performance and is electrically connected  
to ground inside the package. It is recommended that the exposed pad be connected to the ground plane  
on the board.  
Rev. B | Page 18 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PIN 1  
INDICATOR  
COM3/FP27  
COM2/FP28  
COM1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
48 INT0  
47 XTAL1  
46 XTAL2  
COM0  
45 BCTRL/INT1/P0.0  
44 SDEN/P2.3  
43 P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL  
42 P0.3/CF2  
41 P0.4/MOSI/SDATA  
40 P0.5/MISO  
39 P0.6/SCLK/T0  
38 P0.7/SS/T1  
37 P1.0/RxD  
36 P1.1/TxD  
35 FP0  
P1.2/FP25  
P1.3/T2EX/FP24  
P1.4/T2/FP23  
P1.5/FP22  
P1.6/FP21  
ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169  
TOP VIEW  
(Not to Scale)  
P1.7/FP20 10  
P0.1/FP19 11  
P2.0/FP18 12  
P2.1/FP17 13  
P2.2/FP16 14  
LCDVC 15  
34 FP1  
LCDVP2 16  
33 FP2  
NOTES  
1. IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE EXPOSED PAD ON THE BOTTOM OF THE LFCSP BE  
CONNECTED TO THE GROUND PLANE ON THE BOARD.  
Figure 10. Pin Configuration for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169  
Table 14. Pin Function Descriptions  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
1
2
3
COM3/FP27  
COM2/FP28  
COM1  
Common Output 3/LCD Segment Output 27. COM3 is used for the LCD backplane.  
Common Output 2/LCD Segment Output 28. COM2 is used for the LCD backplane.  
Common Output 1. COM1 is used for the LCD backplane.  
4
COM0  
Common Output 0. COM0 is used for the LCD backplane.  
5
6
7
8
P1.2/FP25  
P1.3/T2EX/FP24  
P1.4/T2/FP23  
P1.5/FP22  
P1.6/FP21  
P1.7/FP20  
P0.1/FP19  
P2.0/FP18  
P2.1/FP17  
P2.2/FP16  
LCDVC  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.2/LCD Segment Output 25.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.3/Timer 2 Control Input/LCD Segment Output 24.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.4/Timer 2 Input/LCD Segment Output 23.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.5/LCD Segment Output 22.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.6/LCD Segment Output 21.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.7/LCD Segment Output 20.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.1/LCD Segment Output 19.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.0/LCD Segment Output 18.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.1/LCD Segment Output 17.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.2/LCD Segment Output 16.  
In the ADE7166/ADE7169, this pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or  
an analog output when the LCD charge pump is enabled. In the ADE7116/ADE7156, this pin is always an  
analog input. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF capacitor. When this  
pin is an analog input, it is internally connected to VDD. A resistor should be connected between this pin and  
LCDVB to generate the two highest voltages for the LCD waveforms (see the LCD Driver section).  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
LCDVP2  
LCDVB  
In the ADE7166/ADE7169, this pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or  
an analog output when the LCD charge pump is enabled. In the ADE7116 and ADE7156, this pin is always an  
analog input. When this pin is an analog output, a 100 nF capacitor should be connected between this pin and  
LCDVP1. When this pin is an analog input, it is internally connected to LCDVP1 (see the LCD Driver section).  
In the ADE7166/ADE7169, this pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or  
an analog output when the LCD charge pump is enabled. In the ADE7116/ADE7156, this pin is always an  
analog input. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF capacitor. When this  
pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this pin and LCDVC to generate an  
intermediate voltage for the LCD driver. In 1/3 bias LCD mode, another resistor must be connected between  
this pin and LCDVA to generate another intermediate voltage. In 1/2 bias LCD mode, LCDVB and LCDVA are  
internally connected (see the LCD Driver section).  
Rev. B | Page 19 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
18  
LCDVA  
In the ADE7166/ADE7169, this pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or  
an analog output when the LCD charge pump is enabled. In the ADE7116/ADE7156, this pin is always an  
analog input. When this pin is an analog output, it should be decoupled with a 470 nF capacitor. When this  
pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this pin and LCDVP1 to generate an inter-  
mediate voltage for the LCD driver. In 1/3 bias LCD mode, another resistor must be connected between this  
pin and LCDVB to generate another intermediate voltage. In 1/2 bias LCD mode, LCDVA and LCDVB are  
internally connected (see the LCD Driver section).  
19  
LCDVP1  
In the ADE7166/ADE7169, this pin can be either an analog input when the LCD resistor driver is enabled or  
an analog output when the LCD charge pump is enabled. In the ADE7116/ADE7156, this pin is always an  
analog input. When this pin is an analog output, a 100 nF capacitor should be connected between this pin and  
LCDVP2. When this pin is an analog input, a resistor should be connected between this pin and LCDVA to  
generate an intermediate voltage for the LCD driver. Another resistor must be connected between LCDVP1  
and DGND to generate another intermediate voltage (see the LCD Driver section).  
20 to 35 FP15 to FP0  
LCD Segment Output 0 to LCD Segment Output 15.  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
P1.1/TxD  
P1.0/RxD  
P0.7/SS/T1  
P0.6/SCLK/T0  
P0.5/MISO  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.1/Transmitter Data Output (Asynchronous).  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 1.0/Receiver Data Input (Asynchronous).  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.7/Slave Select When SPI Is in Slave Mode/Timer 1 Input.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.6/Clock Output for I2C or SPI Port/Timer 0 Input.  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.5/Data Input for SPI Port.  
P0.4/MOSI/SDATA General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.4/Data Output for SPI Port/I2C-Compatible Data Line.  
P0.3/CF2  
General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.3/Calibration Frequency Logic Output 2. The CF2 logic output gives  
instantaneous active, reactive, Irms, or apparent power information.  
43  
44  
P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.2/Calibration Frequency Logic Output 1/RTC Calibration Frequency Logic  
Output. The CF1 logic output gives instantaneous active, reactive, Irms, or apparent power information. The  
RTCCAL logic output gives access to the calibrated RTC output.  
SDEN/P2.3  
Serial Download Mode Enable/General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 2.3. This pin is used to enable serial  
download mode through a resistor when pulled low on power-up or reset. On reset, this pin momentarily  
becomes an input, and the status of the pin is sampled. If there is no pull-down resistor in place, the pin  
momentarily goes high and then user code is executed. If the pin is pulled down on reset, the embedded  
serial download/debug kernel executes, and this pin remains low during the internal program execution.  
After reset, this pin can be used as a digital output port pin (P2.3).  
45  
46  
47  
BCTRL/INT1/P0.0  
XTAL2  
Digital Input for Battery Control/External Interrupt Input 1/General-Purpose Digital I/O Port 0.0. This logic  
input connects VDD or VBAT to VSWOUT internally when set to logic high or logic low, respectively. When left  
open, the connection between VDD or VBAT and VSWOUT is selected internally.  
A crystal can be connected across this pin and XTAL1 to provide a clock source for the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169. The XTAL2 pin can drive one CMOS load when an external clock is supplied at XTAL1 or  
by the gate oscillator circuit. An internal 6 pF capacitor is connected to this pin.  
An external clock can be provided at this logic input. Alternatively, a tuning fork crystal can be connected  
across XTAL1 and XTAL2 to provide a clock source for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169. The clock  
frequency for specified operation is 32.768 kHz. An internal 6 pF capacitor is connected to this pin.  
XTAL1  
48  
INT0  
External Interrupt Input 0.  
49, 50  
VP, VN  
Analog Inputs for Voltage Channel. These inputs are fully differential voltage inputs with a maximum  
differential level of 400 mV for specified operation. This channel also has an internal PGA.  
51  
EA  
This pin is used as an input for emulation. When held high, this input enables the device to fetch code from  
internal program memory locations. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 do not support external  
code memory. This pin should not be left floating.  
52, 53  
IPA, IN  
Analog Inputs for Current Channel. These inputs are fully differential voltage inputs with a maximum  
differential level of 400 mV for specified operation. This channel also has an internal PGA.  
54  
55  
AGND  
IPB  
This pin provides the ground reference for the analog circuitry.  
Analog Input for Second Current Channel (IPB). This input is fully differential with a maximum differential  
level of 400 mV, referred to IN for specified operation. This channel also has an internal PGA.  
56  
57  
RESET  
Reset Input, Active Low.  
REFIN/OUT  
This pin provides access to the on-chip voltage reference. The on-chip reference has a nominal value of  
1.2 V 0.1% and a maximum temperature coefficient of 50 ppm/°C. This pin should be decoupled with a 1  
μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
58  
VBAT  
Power Supply Input from the Battery with a 2.4 V to 3.7 V Range. This pin is connected internally to VDD when  
the battery is selected as the power supply for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169.  
Rev. B | Page 20 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Pin No. Mnemonic  
Description  
59  
VINTA  
This pin provides access to the on-chip 2.5 V analog LDO. No external active circuitry should be connected to  
this pin. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
60  
VDD  
3.3 V Power Supply Input from the Regulator. This pin is connected internally to VSWOUT when the regulator is  
selected as the power supply for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169. This pin should be decoupled  
with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
61  
62  
VSWOUT  
3.3 V Power Supply Output. This pin provides the supply voltage for the LDOs and internal circuitry of the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with  
a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
This pin provides access to the on-chip 2.5 V digital LDO. No external active circuitry should be connected to  
this pin. This pin should be decoupled with a 10 μF capacitor in parallel with a ceramic 100 nF capacitor.  
VINTD  
63  
64  
DGND  
VDCIN  
Ground Reference for Digital Circuitry.  
Analog Input for DC Voltage Monitoring. The maximum input voltage on this pin is VSWOUT with respect to  
AGND. This pin is used to monitor the preregulated dc voltage.  
EP  
Exposed Pad  
The exposed pad on the bottom of the LFCSP enhances thermal performance and is electrically connected  
to ground inside the package. It is recommended that the exposed pad be connected to the ground plane  
on the board.  
Rev. B | Page 21 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS  
2.0  
2.0  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.5  
1.5  
1.0  
1.0  
+85°C; PF = 0.866  
+25°C; PF = 0.866  
–40°C; PF = 0.866  
0.5  
0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 1  
0
0
+85°C; PF = 0  
+25°C; PF = 0  
–40°C; PF = 0  
–40°C; PF = 1  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
MID CLASS C  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 11. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 14. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
2.0  
1.5  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.0  
MID CLASS C  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.5  
1.0  
MID CLASS C  
+25°C; PF = 1  
0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–40°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 1  
0
0
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
–40°C; PF = 1  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
MID CLASS C  
MID CLASS C  
10  
0.1  
1
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 12. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 15. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
2.0  
2.0  
GAIN = 1  
MID CLASS C  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.5  
1.5  
1.0  
1.0  
0.5  
0
+25°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
0.5  
0
+85°C; PF = 0  
+25°C; PF = 0  
–40°C; PF = 1  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–0.5  
–40°C; PF = 0  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
MID CLASS C  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 16. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 13. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Rev. B | Page 22 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
1.5  
0.5  
0.4  
GAIN = 1  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
GAIN = 8  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.0  
0.3  
MID CLASS C  
0.2  
V
; 3.3V  
rms  
I
; 3.3V  
rms  
0.5  
V
; 3.43V  
rms  
PF = 1  
PF = –0.5  
PF = +0.5  
0.1  
I
; 3.43V  
rms  
V
; 3.13V  
rms  
0
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
0
–0.1  
–0.2  
–0.3  
–0.4  
–0.5  
I
; 3.13V  
rms  
MID CLASS C  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 17. Voltage and Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Power Supply with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 20. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 8)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
1.0  
1.0  
GAIN = 1  
GAIN = 8  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
0.8  
0.8  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
0.6  
0.6  
MID CLASS B  
0.4  
0.4  
PF = 1  
PF = 1  
0.2  
0.2  
PF = +0.5  
PF = 0.5  
0
0
MID CLASS B  
–0.2  
–0.4  
–0.6  
–0.8  
–1.0  
–0.2  
PF = –0.5  
–0.4  
–0.6  
–0.8  
–1.0  
40  
45  
50  
55  
60  
65  
70  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
LINE FREQUENCY (Hz)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 18. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 1)  
over Frequency with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 21. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 8)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
1.5  
0.5  
GAIN = 1  
GAIN = 8  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.0  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
0.4  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
0.3  
MID CLASS C  
VAR; 3.43V  
W; 3.3V  
0.2  
0.1  
0.5  
PF = +0.5  
PF = 1  
VAR; 3.3V  
0
0
VAR; 3.13V  
–0.1  
–0.2  
–0.3  
–0.4  
–0.5  
W; 3.43V  
PF = –0.5  
–0.5  
W; 3.13V  
MID CLASS C  
–1.0  
–1.5  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 19. Active and Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading  
(Gain = 1) over Power Supply with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 22. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 8)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Rev. B | Page 23 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
2.0  
1.0  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
0.8  
1.5  
0.6  
–40°C; PF = 0  
+85°C; PF = 0  
1.0  
+85°C; PF = 0.866  
–40°C; PF = 0.866  
0.4  
0.5  
0.2  
+25°C; PF = 1  
0
0
+25°C; PF = 0.866  
+25°C; PF = 0  
–40°C; PF = 1  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–0.2  
–0.4  
–0.6  
–0.8  
–1.0  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
MID CLASS C  
10  
0.1  
1
100  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 23. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 26. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
2.0  
2.0  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
MID CLASS C  
1.5  
1.0  
1.5  
1.0  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
+25°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
0.5  
0.5  
–40°C; PF = 1  
0
0
+85°C; PF = 1  
–40°C; PF = 1  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
+25°C; PF = 1  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
MID CLASS C  
10  
MID CLASS C  
10  
0.1  
1
100  
0.1  
1
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 24. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 27. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
1.0  
2.0  
GAIN = 16  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
0.8  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
1.5  
1.0  
0.6  
+85°C; PF = 0  
0.4  
0.2  
–40°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 1  
0.5  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
–40°C; PF = 0  
0
0
–0.2  
–0.4  
–0.6  
–0.8  
–1.0  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
+25°C; PF = 0  
MID CLASS C  
10  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
0.1  
1
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 28. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Figure 25. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Temperature with Internal Reference, Integrator Off  
Rev. B | Page 24 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PERFORMANCE CURVES FOR THE ADE7169 AND ADE7569 ONLY  
2.0  
1.5  
2.0  
1.5  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR ON  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR ON  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
MID CLASS C  
1.0  
–40°C; PF = 1  
1.0  
+25°C; PF = 1  
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
+85°C; PF = 0.5  
+25°C; PF = 0.5  
–40°C; PF = 0.5  
0.5  
0.5  
0
0
+25°C; PF = 1  
+85°C; PF = 1  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–0.5  
–1.0  
–1.5  
–2.0  
–40°C; PF = 1  
MID CLASS C  
10  
MID CLASS C  
10  
0.1  
1
100  
0.1  
1
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 31. Current RMS Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator On  
Figure 29. Active Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator On  
1.0  
GAIN = 16  
INTEGRATOR ON  
0.8  
INTERNAL REFERENCE  
0.6  
0.4  
+25°C; PF = 0  
+85°C; PF = 0.866  
0.2  
–40°C; PF = 0  
+25°C; PF = 0.866  
0
–0.2  
+85°C; PF = 0  
–0.4  
–40°C; PF = 0.866  
–0.6  
–0.8  
–1.0  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
CURRENT CHANNEL (% of Full Scale)  
Figure 30. Reactive Energy Error as a Percentage of Reading (Gain = 16)  
over Power Factor with Internal Reference, Integrator On  
Rev. B | Page 25 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TERMINOLOGY  
For the dc PSR measurement, a reading at nominal supplies  
Measurement Error  
(3.3 V) is taken. A second reading is obtained with the same  
input signal levels when the supplies are varied 5%. Any error  
introduced is again expressed as a percentage of the reading.  
The error associated with the energy measurement made by the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
is defined by the following formula:  
ADC Offset Error  
Percentage Error =  
ADC offset error is the dc offset associated with the analog  
inputs to the ADCs. It means that, with the analog inputs  
connected to AGND, the ADCs still see a dc analog input  
signal. The magnitude of the offset depends on the gain  
and input range selection (see the Typical Performance  
Characteristics section). However, when HPF1 is switched  
on, the offset is removed from the current channel, and the  
power calculation is not affected by this offset. The offsets  
can be removed by performing an offset calibration (see the  
Analog Inputs section).  
Energy Register True Energy  
(1)  
×100%  
True Energy  
Phase Error Between Channels  
The digital integrator and the high-pass filter (HPF) in the  
current channel have a nonideal phase response. To offset this  
phase response and equalize the phase response between  
channels, two phase correction networks are placed in the  
current channel: one for the digital integrator and the other for  
the HPF. The phase correction networks correct the phase  
response of the corresponding component and ensure a phase  
match between current channel and voltage channel to within  
0.1° over a range of 45 Hz to 65 Hz with the digital integrator  
off. With the digital integrator on, the phase is corrected to  
within 0.4° over a range of 45 Hz to 65 Hz.  
Gain Error  
Gain error is the difference between the measured ADC output  
code (minus the offset) and the ideal output code (see the  
Current Channel ADC section and Voltage Channel ADC  
section). It is measured for each of the gain settings on the  
current channel (1, 2, 4, 8, and 16). The difference is expressed  
as a percentage of the ideal code.  
Power Supply Rejection (PSR)  
PSR quantifies the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 measurement error as a percentage of  
reading when the power supplies are varied. For the ac PSR  
measurement, a reading at nominal supplies (3.3 V) is taken.  
A second reading is obtained with the same input signal levels  
when an ac (100 mV rms/120 Hz) signal is introduced onto the  
supplies. Any error introduced by this ac signal is expressed as a  
percentage of reading (see the Measurement Error definition).  
Rev. B | Page 26 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER (SFR) MAPPING  
Table 15.  
Mnemonic  
INTPR  
Address Description  
Mnemonic  
TEMPADC  
IRMSH  
Address Description  
0xFF  
Interrupt pins configuration  
0xD7  
0xD6  
0xD5  
Temperature ADC value (see Table 55).  
Irms measurement MSB (see Table 31).  
Irms measurement middle byte  
(see Table 31).  
(see Table 17).  
SCRATCH4  
SCRATCH3  
SCRATCH2  
SCRATCH1  
BATVTH  
0xFE  
0xFD  
0xFC  
0xFB  
0xFA  
Scratch Pad 4 (see Table 25).  
Scratch Pad 3 (see Table 24).  
Scratch Pad 2 (see Table 23).  
Scratch Pad 1 (see Table 22).  
Battery detection threshold  
(see Table 52).  
IRMSM  
IRMSL  
VRMSH  
VRMSM  
0xD4  
0xD3  
0xD2  
Irms measurement LSB (see Table 31).  
Vrms measurement MSB (see Table 31).  
Vrms measurement middle byte  
(see Table 31).  
STRBPER  
IPSMF  
0xF9  
0xF8  
0xF7  
0xF6  
0xF5  
0xF4  
0xF3  
Peripheral ADC strobe period  
(see Table 49).  
Power management interrupt flag  
(see Table 18).  
RTC temperature compensation  
(see Table 135).  
RTC nominal compensation  
(see Table 134).  
Battery switchover configuration (see  
Table 19).  
Peripheral configuration  
(see Table 20).  
Temperature and supply delta  
(see Table 50).  
Auxiliary math (see Table 56).  
VDCIN ADC value (see Table 53).  
LCD Segment Enable 2 (see Table 98).  
Power management interrupt enable  
(see Table 21).  
SPI interrupt status (see Table 150).  
I2C interrupt status (see Table 154).  
SPI Configuration SFR 2 (see Table 149).  
I2C slave address (see Table 153).  
SPI Configuration SFR 1 (see Table 148).  
I2C mode (see Table 152).  
Selection 2 sample MSB (see Table 31).  
Selection 2 sample middle byte  
(see Table 31).  
Selection 2 sample LSB (see Table 31).  
Selection 1 sample MSB (see Table 31).  
Selection 1 sample middle byte (see  
Table 31).  
VRMSL  
PSW  
TH2  
TL2  
RCAP2H  
0xD1  
0xD0  
0xCD  
0xCC  
0xCB  
Vrms measurement LSB (see Table 31).  
Program status word (see Table 57).  
Timer 2 high byte (see Table 120).  
Timer 2 low byte (see Table 121).  
Timer 2 reload/capture high byte  
(see Table 122).  
Timer 2 reload/capture low byte  
(see Table 123).  
Timer/Counter 2 control (see Table 115).  
Flash high byte address (see Table 110).  
Flash low byte address (see Table 109).  
Power control (see Table 26).  
Key (see Table 126).  
Watchdog timer (see Table 85).  
Flash read protection (see Table 108).  
Flash Write/Erase Protection 1  
(see Table 107).  
Flash Write/Erase Protection 0  
(see Table 106).  
Flash data (see Table 105).  
Flash protection key (see Table 104).  
Flash key (see Table 103).  
Flash control (see Table 102).  
Interrupt priority (see Table 79).  
Port 2 weak pull-up enable  
(see Table 159).  
Port 1 weak pull-up enable  
(see Table 158).  
Port 0 weak pull-up enable  
(see Table 157).  
LCD Configuration Y (see Table 91).  
Configuration (see Table 63).  
LCD data (see Table 97).  
TEMPCAL  
RTCCOMP  
BATPR  
RCAP2L  
0xCA  
T2CON  
EADRH  
EADRL  
POWCON  
KYREG  
WDCON  
PROTR  
PROTB1  
0xC8  
0xC7  
0xC6  
0xC5  
0xC1  
0xC0  
0xBF  
0xBE  
PERIPH  
DIFFPROG  
B
0xF0  
0xEF  
0xED  
0xEC  
VDCINADC  
LCDSEGE2  
IPSME  
PROTB0  
0xBD  
SPISTAT  
0xEA  
0xEA  
0xE9  
0xE9  
0xE8  
0xE8  
0xE7  
0xE6  
EDATA  
PROTKY  
FLSHKY  
ECON  
0xBC  
0xBB  
0xBA  
0xB9  
0xB8  
0xB4  
SPI2CSTAT  
SPIMOD2  
I2CADR  
SPIMOD1  
I2CMOD  
WAV2H  
IP  
PINMAP2  
WAV2M  
PINMAP1  
PINMAP0  
0xB3  
0xB2  
WAV2L  
WAV1H  
WAV1M  
0xE5  
0xE4  
0xE3  
LCDCONY  
CFG  
LCDDAT  
LCDPTR  
IEIP2  
0xB1  
0xAF  
0xAE  
0xAC  
0xA9  
WAV1L  
ACC  
0xE2  
0xE0  
0xDF  
0xDE  
0xDD  
0xDC  
0xDB  
0xDA  
0xD9  
0xD8  
Selection 1 sample LSB (see Table 31).  
Accumulator (see Table 56).  
LCD pointer (see Table 96).  
Interrupt Enable and Priority 2  
(see Table 80).  
BATADC  
MIRQSTH  
MIRQSTM  
MIRQSTL  
MIRQENH  
MIRQENM  
MIRQENL  
ADCGO  
Battery ADC value (see Table 54).  
Interrupt Status 3 (see Table 42).  
Interrupt Status 2 (see Table 41).  
Interrupt Status 1 (see Table 40).  
Interrupt Enable 3 (see Table 45).  
Interrupt Enable 2 (see Table 44).  
Interrupt Enable 1 (see Table 43).  
Start ADC measurement (see Table 51).  
IE  
0xA8  
0xA7  
0xA6  
0xA5  
0xA4  
0xA3  
Interrupt enable (see Table 78).  
DPCON  
INTVAL  
HOUR  
MIN  
Data pointer control (see Table 76).  
RTC alarm interval (see Table 133).  
RTC hours counter (see Table 132).  
RTC minutes counter (see Table 131).  
RTC seconds counter (see Table 130).  
SEC  
Rev. B | Page 27 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Mnemonic  
Address Description  
Mnemonic  
Address Description  
HTHSEC  
0xA2  
RTC hundredths of a second counter  
(see Table 129).  
RTC configuration (see Table 128).  
Port 2 (see Table 162).  
Extended port configuration  
(see Table 156).  
MDATM  
0x93  
0x92  
0x91  
Energy measurement pointer data  
middle byte (see Table 31).  
Energy measurement pointer data LSB  
(see Table 31).  
Energy measurement pointer address  
(see Table 30).  
TIMECON  
P2  
EPCFG  
0xA1  
0xA0  
0x9F  
MDATL  
MADDPT  
P1  
0x90  
0x8D  
0x8C  
0x8B  
0x8A  
0x89  
Port 1 (see Table 161).  
SBAUDT  
SBAUDF  
0x9E  
0x9D  
Enhanced serial baud rate control (see  
Table 142).  
UART timer fractional divider  
(see Table 143).  
LCD Configuration X (see Table 89).  
SPI/I2C receive buffer (see Table 147).  
SPI/I2C transmit buffer (see Table 146).  
Serial port buffer (see Table 141).  
Serial communications control  
(see Table 140).  
LCD segment enable (see Table 95).  
LCD clock (see Table 92).  
LCD configuration (see Table 88).  
Energy measurement pointer data MSB  
(see Table 31).  
TH1  
TH0  
TL1  
TL0  
TMOD  
Timer 1 high byte (see Table 118).  
Timer 0 high byte (see Table 116).  
Timer 1 low byte (see Table 119).  
Timer 0 low byte (see Table 117).  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1  
mode (see Table 113).  
LCDCONX  
SPI2CRx  
SPI2CTx  
SBUF  
0x9C  
0x9B  
0x9A  
0x99  
0x98  
TCON  
0x88  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1  
control (see Table 114).  
SCON  
PCON  
DPH  
DPL  
SP  
0x87  
0x83  
0x82  
0x81  
0x80  
Program control (see Table 58).  
Data pointer high (see Table 60).  
Data pointer low (see Table 59).  
Stack pointer (see Table 62).  
Port 0 (see Table 160).  
LCDSEGE  
LCDCLK  
LCDCON  
MDATH  
0x97  
0x96  
0x95  
0x94  
P0  
Rev. B | Page 28 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
POWER MANAGEMENT  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 have elaborate power management circuitry that  
manages the switchover from regular power supply to battery  
and manages power supply failures. The power management  
functionalities can be accessed directly through the 8052 SFRs  
(see Table 16).  
Table 16. Power Management SFRs  
SFR Address  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Mnemonic  
Description  
0xEC  
0xF5  
0xF8  
0xFF  
0xF4  
0xC5  
0xFB  
0xFC  
IPSME  
BATPR  
IPSMF  
INTPR  
Power management interrupt enable (see Table 21).  
Battery switchover configuration (see Table 19).  
Power management interrupt flag (see Table 18).  
Interrupt pins configuration (see Table 17).  
Peripheral configuration (see Table 20).  
Power control (see Table 26).  
Scratch Pad 1 (see Table 22).  
Scratch Pad 2 (see Table 23).  
Scratch Pad 3 (see Table 24).  
Scratch Pad 4 (see Table 25).  
PERIPH  
POWCON  
SCRATCH1  
SCRATCH2  
SCRATCH3  
SCRATCH4  
0xFD  
0xFE  
POWER MANAGEMENT REGISTER DETAILS  
Table 17. Interrupt Pins Configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
RTCCAL  
0
Controls RTC calibration output. When set, the RTC calibration frequency selected by the FSEL bits is  
output on the P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL pin.  
[6:5]  
FSEL  
00  
Sets RTC calibration output frequency and calibration window.  
FSEL  
00  
Result (Calibration Window, Frequency)  
30.5 sec, 1 Hz  
01  
30.5 sec, 512 Hz  
10  
0.244 sec, 500 Hz  
11  
0.244 sec, 16 kHz  
4
Reserved  
INT1PRG  
N/A  
000  
[3:1]  
Controls the function of INT1.  
INT1PRG  
X00  
X01  
Result  
GPIO enabled  
BCTRL enabled  
INT1 input disabled  
INT1 input enabled  
01X  
11X  
0
INT0PRG  
0
Controls the function of INT0.  
INT0PRG  
Result  
0
1
INT0 input disabled  
INT0 input enabled  
Writing to the Interrupt Pins Configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF)  
To protect the RTC from runaway code, a key must be written to the key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1) to obtain write access to INTPR.  
KYREG (see Table 126) should be set to 0xEA to unlock this SFR and reset to 0 after a timekeeping register is written to. The RTC  
registers can be written using the following 8052 assembly code:  
MOV  
MOV  
KYREG, #0EAh  
INTPR, #080h  
Rev. B | Page 29 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 18. Power Management Interrupt Flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8)  
Bit Bit Address Mnemonic Default Description  
7
0xFF  
FPSR  
0
Power supply restored interrupt flag. Set when the VDD power supply has been restored.  
This occurs when the source of VSWOUT changes from VBAT to VDD  
.
6
5
4
3
0xFE  
0xFD  
0xFC  
0xFB  
FPSM  
FSAG  
Reserved  
FVADC1  
0
0
0
0
PSM interrupt flag. Set when an enabled PSM interrupt condition occurs.  
Voltage SAG interrupt flag. Set when an ADE energy measurement SAG condition occurs.  
This bit must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
VDCINADC monitor interrupt flag. Set when VDCIN changes by VDCIN_DIFF or when VDCIN  
measurement is ready.  
VBAT monitor interrupt flag. Set when VBAT falls below BATVTH or when VBAT measurement is ready.  
Battery switchover interrupt flag. Set when VSWOUT switches from VDD to VBAT.  
VDCIN monitor interrupt flag. Set when VDCIN falls below 1.2 V.  
2
1
0
0xFA  
0xF9  
0xF8  
FBAT1  
FBSO  
FVDCIN1  
0
0
0
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Table 19. Battery Switchover Configuration SFR (BATPR, Address 0xF5)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
BATPRG  
Default  
Description  
[7:2]  
[1:0]  
00  
These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Control bits for battery switchover.  
00  
BATPRG  
Result  
00  
01  
1X  
Battery switchover enabled on low VDD  
Battery switchover enabled on low VDD and low VDCIN  
Battery switchover disabled  
Table 20. Peripheral Configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address 0xF4)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
RXFLAG  
0
1
1
0
If set, indicates that an Rx edge event triggered wake-up from PSM2.  
Indicates the power supply that is internally connected to VSWOUT (0: VSWOUT = VBAT; 1: VSWOUT = VDD).  
If set, indicates that VDD power supply is ready for operation.  
6
VSWSOURCE  
VDD_OK  
5
4
PLL_FLT  
If set, indicates that a PLL fault occurred where the PLL lost lock. Set the PLLACK bit (see Table 51) in  
the start ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8) to acknowledge the fault and clear the  
PLL_FLT bit.  
3
REF_BAT_EN  
0
Set this bit to enable internal voltage reference in PSM2 mode. This bit should be set if LCD is on in  
PSM1 and PSM2 mode.  
2
Reserved  
RXPROG  
0
This bit must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Controls the function of the P1.0/RxD pin.  
[1:0]  
00  
RXPROG  
Result  
00  
01  
11  
GPIO  
RxD with wake-up disabled  
RxD with wake-up enabled  
Table 21. Power Management Interrupt Enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EPSR  
Reserved  
ESAG  
Reserved  
EVADC1  
EBAT1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Enables a PSM interrupt when the power supply restored interrupt flag (FPSR) is set.  
Reserved.  
Enables a PSM interrupt when the voltage SAG interrupt flag (FSAG) is set.  
This bit must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Enables a PSM interrupt when the VDCINADC monitor interrupt flag (FVADC) is set.  
Enables a PSM interrupt when the VBAT monitor interrupt flag (FBAT) is set.  
Enables a PSM interrupt when the battery switchover interrupt flag (FBSO) is set.  
Enables a PSM interrupt when the VDCIN monitor interrupt flag (FVDCIN) is set.  
EBSO  
EVDCIN1  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Rev. B | Page 30 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 22. Scratch Pad 1 SFR (SCRATCH1, Address 0xFB)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
SCRATCH1 Value can be written/read in this register. This value is maintained in all the power saving modes.  
0
Table 23. Scratch Pad 2 SFR (SCRATCH2, Address 0xFC)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
SCRATCH2 Value can be written/read in this register. This value is maintained in all the power saving modes.  
0
Table 24. Scratch Pad 3 SFR (SCRATCH3, Address 0xFD)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
SCRATCH3 Value can be written/read in this register. This value is maintained in all the power saving modes.  
0
Table 25. Scratch Pad 4 SFR (SCRATCH4, Address 0xFE)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
SCRATCH4 Value can be written/read in this register. This value is maintained in all the power saving modes.  
0
Clearing the Scratch Pad Registers (SCRATCH1, Address 0xFB to SCRATCH4, Address 0xFE)  
Note that these scratch pad registers are cleared only when the part loses VDD and VBAT  
.
Table 26. Power Control SFR (POWCON, Address 0xC5)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
Reserved  
1
0
Reserved.  
6
METER_OFF  
Set this bit to turn off the modulators and energy metering DSP circuitry to reduce power if  
metering functions are not needed in PSM0 mode.  
5
Reserved  
COREOFF  
Reserved  
CD  
0
This bit should be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
4
0
Set this bit to shut down the core and enter PSM2 mode if in the PSM1 operating mode.  
3
0
Reserved.  
[2:0]  
010  
Controls the core clock frequency, fCORE. fCORE = 4.096 MHz/2CD  
.
CD  
Result (fCORE in MHz)  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
4.096  
2.048  
1.024  
0.512  
0.256  
0.128  
0.064  
0.032  
Writing to the Power Control SFR (POWCON, Address 0xC5)  
Writing data to the POWCON SFR involves writing 0xA7 into the key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1), which is described in Table 126,  
followed by a write to the POWCON SFR. For example,  
MOV KYREG,#0A7h  
MOV POWCON,#10h  
;Write KYREG to 0xA7 to get write access to the POWCON SFR  
;Shut down the core  
Rev. B | Page 31 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The battery switchover functionality provided by the ADE7116/  
POWER SUPPLY ARCHITECTURE  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 allows a  
seamless transition from VDD to VBAT. An automatic battery  
switchover option ensures a stable power supply to the device, as  
long as the external battery voltage is above 2.75 V. It allows  
continuous code execution even while the internal power  
supply is switching from VDD to VBAT and back. Note that the  
energy metering ADCs are not available when VBAT is being  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has two power supply inputs, VDD and VBAT, which  
require only a single 3.3 V power supply at VDD for full operation.  
A battery backup, or secondary power supply, with a maximum  
of 3.7 V can be connected to the VBAT input. Internally, the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
connect VDD or VBAT to VSWOUT, which is used to derive power for  
the device circuitry. The VSWOUT output pin reflects the voltage at  
the internal power supply (VSWOUT) and has a maximum output  
current of 6 mA. This pin can also be used to power a limited  
used for VSWOUT  
.
Power supply monitor (PSM) interrupts can be enabled to  
indicate when battery switchover occurs and when the VDD  
power supply is restored (see the Power Supply Management  
(PSM) Interrupt section.)  
number of peripheral components. The 2.5 V analog supply (VINTA  
)
and the 2.5 V supply for the core logic (VINTD) are derived by on-  
chip linear regulators from VSWOUT. Figure 32 shows the power  
supply architecture of the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
VDD to VBAT  
The following three events switch the internal power supply  
(VSWOUT) from VDD to VBAT  
:
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide automatic battery switchover between VDD  
and VBAT based on the voltage level detected at VDD or VDCIN. In  
addition, the BCTRL input can be used to trigger a battery  
switchover. The conditions for switching VSWOUT from VDD to  
VDCIN < 1.2 V. When VDCIN falls below 1.2 V, VSWOUT  
switches from VDD to VBAT. This event is enabled when the  
BATPRG[1:0] bits in the battery switchover configuration  
SFR (BATPR, Address 0xF5) = 0b01. Setting these bits  
disables switchover based on VDCIN. Battery switchover on  
low VDCIN is disabled by default.  
VDD < 2.75 V. When VDD falls below 2.75 V, VSWOUT  
switches from VDD to VBAT. This event is enabled when the  
BATPRG[1:0] bits in the BATPR SFR are cleared.  
Falling edge on BCTRL. When the battery control pin,  
BCTRL, goes low, VSWOUT switches from VDD to VBAT. This  
external switchover signal can trigger a switchover to VBAT  
at any time. Setting the INT1PRG bits to X01 in the  
interrupt pins configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF)  
enables the battery control pin (see Table 17).  
VBAT and back to VDD are described in the Battery Switchover  
section. VDCIN is an input pin that can be connected to a 0 V to  
3.3 V dc signal. This input is intended for power supply super-  
visory purposes and does not provide power to the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 circuitry.  
V
V
V
V
DCIN  
DD  
BAT  
SWOUT  
*
MCU  
ADE  
ADC  
V
INTD  
LDO  
LDO  
POWER SUPPLY  
MANAGEMENT  
V
BCTRL  
SW  
V
INTA  
*
Switching from VBAT to VDD  
ADC  
LCD  
2
SPI/I C  
To switch VSWOUT from VBAT to VDD, all of the following events  
must be true:  
SCRATCH PAD  
RTC  
UART  
2.5V  
*
TEMPERATURE ADC  
VDD > 2.75 V. VSWOUT switches back to VDD after VDD remains  
3.3V  
above 2.75 V.  
*NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7116.  
VDCIN > 1.2 V and VDD > 2.75 V. If the low VDCIN condition  
is enabled, VSWOUT switches to VDD after VDCIN remains  
above 1.2 V and VDD remains above 2.75 V.  
Rising edge on BCTRL. If the battery control pin is enabled,  
VSWOUT switches back to VDD after BCTRL is high, and the  
first or second bullet point is satisfied.  
Figure 32. Power Supply Architecture  
BATTERY SWITCHOVER  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 monitor VDD, VBAT, and VDCIN. Automatic battery switch-  
over from VDD to VBAT can be configured based on the status of  
the VDD, VDCIN, or BCTRL pin. Battery switchover is enabled by  
default. Setting Bit 1 in the Battery Switchover Configuration SFR  
(BATPR, Address 0xF5) disables battery switchover so that VDD  
is always connected to VSWOUT (see Table 19). The source of  
VSWOUT is indicated by Bit 6 in the Peripheral Configuration SFR  
(PERIPH, Address 0xF4), which is described in Table 20. Bit 6 is  
set when VSWOUT is connected to VDD and cleared when VSWOUT is  
connected to VBAT  
.
Rev. B | Page 32 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The power management interrupt enable SFR (IPSME,  
Address 0xEC) controls the events that result in a PSM  
interrupt (see Table 21). Figure 33 illustrates how the PSM  
interrupt vector is shared among the PSM interrupt sources.  
The PSM interrupt flags are latched and must be cleared by  
writing to the IPSMF power management interrupt flag SFR,  
Address 0xF8 (see Table 18).  
POWER SUPPLY MANAGEMENT (PSM) INTERRUPT  
The power supply monitor interrupt alerts the 8052 core of  
power supply events. The PSM interrupt is disabled by default.  
Setting the EPSM bit in the interrupt enable and Priority 2 SFR  
(IEIP2, Address 0xA9) enables the PSM interrupt (see Table 80).  
EPSR  
FPSR  
ESAG  
FSAG  
EVADC  
FVADC  
FPSM  
EPSM  
PENDING PSM  
INTERRUPT  
TRUE?  
EBAT  
FBAT  
EBSO  
FBSO  
EVDCIN  
FVDCIN  
IPSME ADDR. 0xEC  
IPSMF ADDR. 0xF8  
IEIP2 ADDR. 0xA9  
EPSR  
FPSR  
RESERVED  
FPSM  
ESAG  
RESERVED  
RESERVED  
PSI  
EVADC*  
FVADC*  
EADE  
EBAT*  
FBAT*  
ETI  
EBSO  
FBSO  
EPSM  
EVDCIN*  
FVDCIN*  
ESI  
FSAG  
RESERVED  
PTI  
RESERVED  
NOT INVOLVED IN PSM INTERRUPT SIGNAL CHAIN.  
*NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7116.  
Figure 33. Power Supply Management Interrupt Sources  
Rev. B | Page 33 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Battery Switchover and Power Supply Restored  
PSM Interrupt  
VBAT Monitor PSM Interrupt  
The VBAT voltage is measured using a dedicated ADC. These  
measurements take place in the background at intervals to  
check the change in VBAT. The FBAT bit is set when the battery  
level is lower than the threshold set in the battery detection  
threshold SFR (BATVTH, Address 0xFA), described in Table 52,  
or when a new measurement is ready in the battery ADC value  
SFR (BATADC, Address 0xDF), described in Table 54. See the  
Battery Measurement section for more information. Setting the  
EBAT bit in the power management interrupt enable SFR  
(IPSME, Address 0xEC) enables this event to generate a PSM  
interrupt. Note that this feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can be configured to generate a PSM interrupt when  
the source of VSWOUT changes from VDD to VBAT, indicating  
battery switchover. Setting the EBSO bit in the power manage-  
ment interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC) enables this  
event to generate a PSM interrupt (see Table 21).  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can also be configured to generate an interrupt when  
the source of VSWOUT changes from VBAT to VDD, indicating that  
the VDD power supply has been restored. Setting the EPSR bit in  
the power management interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address  
0xEC) enables this event to generate a PSM interrupt.  
VDCIN Monitor PSM Interrupt  
The VDCIN voltage is monitored by a comparator. The FVDCIN  
bit in the power management interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF,  
Address 0xF8) is set when the VDCIN input level is lower than  
1.2 V. Setting the EVDCIN bit in the IPSME SFR enables this  
event to generate a PSM interrupt. This event, which is associated  
with the SAG monitoring, can be used to detect that a power  
supply (VDD) is compromised and to trigger further actions  
prior to initiating a switch from VDD to VBAT. Note that this  
feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
The flags in the IPSMF SFR for these interrupts, FBSO and  
FPSR, are set regardless of whether the respective enable bits  
have been set. The battery switchover and power supply restore  
event flags, FBSO and FPSR, are latched. These events must be  
cleared by writing a 0 to these bits. Bit 6 (VSWSOURCE) in the  
peripheral configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address 0xF4) tracks  
the source of VSWOUT. The bit is set when VSWOUT is connected to  
VDD and cleared when VSWOUT is connected to VBAT  
.
VDCIN ADC PSM Interrupt  
SAG Monitor PSM Interrupt  
The ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 can be  
configured to generate a PSM interrupt when VDCIN changes  
magnitude by more than a configurable threshold. This threshold  
is set in the temperature and supply delta SFR (DIFFPROG,  
Address 0xF3), which is described in Table 50. See the External  
Voltage Measurement section for more information. Setting the  
EVADC bit in the power management interrupt enable SFR  
(IPSME, Address 0xEC) enables this event to generate a PSM  
interrupt. Note that this feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 energy measurement DSP monitors the ac voltage  
input at the VP and VN input pins. The SAGLVL register  
(Address 0x14) is used to set the threshold for a line voltage  
SAG event. The FSAG bit in the power management interrupt  
flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8) is set if the line voltage stays  
below the level set in the SAGLVL register for the number of  
line cycles set in the SAGCYC register (Address 0x13). See the  
Line Voltage SAG Detection section for more information.  
Setting the ESAG bit in the power management interrupt enable  
SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC) enables this event to generate a  
PSM interrupt.  
The VDCIN voltage is measured using a dedicated ADC. These  
measurements take place in the background at intervals to check  
the change in VDCIN. Conversions can also be initiated by writing to  
the start ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8), as  
described in Table 51. The FVADC flag in the power manage-  
ment interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8) indicates when  
a VDCIN measurement is ready. See the External Voltage  
Measurement section for details on how VDCIN is measured.  
Rev. B | Page 34 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
When a SAG event occurs, user code can be configured to back up  
data and prepare for battery switchover if desired. The relative  
spacing of these interrupts depends on the design of the power  
supply.  
USING THE POWER SUPPLY FEATURES  
In an energy meter application, the 3.3 V power supply (VDD) is  
typically generated from the ac line voltage and regulated to 3.3 V  
by a voltage regulator IC. The preregulated dc voltage, typically  
5 V to 12 V, can be connected to VDCIN through a resistor divider.  
A 3.6 V battery can be connected to VBAT. Figure 34 shows how  
the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 power supply inputs are set up in this application.  
Figure 36 shows the sequence of events that occurs if the main  
power supply starts to fail in the power meter application shown  
in Figure 34, with battery switchover on low VDCIN or low VDD  
enabled.  
Finally, the transition between VDD and VBAT and the different  
power supply modes (see the Operating Modes section) are  
represented in Figure 37 and Figure 38.  
Figure 35 shows the sequence of events that occurs if the main  
power supply generated by the PSU starts to fail in the power  
meter application shown in Figure 34. The SAG detection can  
provide the earliest warning of a potential problem on VDD.  
45  
BCTRL  
(240V, 220V, 110V TYPICAL)  
AC INPUT  
V
P
49  
50  
SAG  
DETECTION  
V
N
5V TO 12V DC  
V
DCIN  
VOLTAGE  
SUPERVISORY  
64  
VOLTAGE  
SUPERVISORY  
POWER SUPPLY  
MANAGEMENT  
IPSMF SFR  
(ADDR. 0xF8)  
V
DD  
3.3V  
PSU  
60  
REGULATOR  
V
SW  
61  
58  
V
SWOUT  
V
BAT  
Figure 34. Power Supply Management for Energy Meter Application  
V
– V  
N
P
SAG LEVEL TRIP POINT  
SAGCYC = 1  
V
DCIN  
1.2V  
t1  
V
DD  
2.75V  
t2  
SAG EVENT  
(FSAG = 1)  
V
EVENT  
IF SWITCHOVER ON LOW V IS ENABLED,  
DD  
AUTOMATIC BATTERY SWITCHOVER  
DCIN  
(FVDCIN = 1)  
OCCURS. V  
IS CONNECTED TO V .  
SWOUT  
BAT  
BSO EVENT  
(FBSO = 1)  
Figure 35. Power Supply Management Interrupts and Battery Switchover with Only VDD Enabled for Battery Switchover  
Rev. B | Page 35 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 27. Power Supply Event Timing Operating Modes  
Parameter  
Time  
Description  
t1  
t2  
t3  
10 ns min  
10 ns min  
30 ms typ  
Time between when VDCIN goes below 1.2 V and when FVDCIN is raised.  
Time between when VDD falls below 2.75 V and when battery switchover occurs.  
Time between when VDCIN falls below 1.2 V and when battery switchover occurs if VDCIN is enabled to cause  
battery switchover.  
t4  
130 ms typ  
Time between when power supply restore conditions are met (VDCIN > 1.2 V and VDD > 2.75 V if BATPRG[1:0] =  
0b01 or VDD > 2.75 V if BATPRG[1:0] = 0b00) and when VSWOUT switches to VDD  
.
V
– V  
N
P
SAG LEVEL TRIP POINT  
SAGCYC = 1  
V
DCIN  
1.2V  
t3  
t1  
V
DD  
2.75V  
SAG EVENT  
(FSAG = 1)  
V
EVENT  
IF SWITCHOVER ON LOW V  
ENABLED, AUTOMATIC BATTERY  
IS  
DCIN  
(FVDCIN = 1)  
DCIN  
SWITCHOVER OCCURS. V  
SWOUT  
IS CONNECTED TO V  
.
BAT  
BSO EVENT  
(FBSO = 1)  
Figure 36. Power Supply Management Interrupts and Battery Switchover with VDD or VDCIN Enabled for Battery Switchover  
V
V  
N
P
SAG LEVEL  
TRIP POINT  
V
EVENT  
SAG EVENT  
DCIN  
V
EVENT  
DCIN  
V
DCIN  
1.2V  
130ms MIN.  
30ms MIN.  
V
BAT  
V
DD  
2.75V  
V
SW  
PSM0  
PSM0  
PSM0  
BATTERY SWITCH  
ENABLED ON  
PSM1 OR PSM2  
LOW V  
DCIN  
V
SW  
PSM0  
BATTERY SWITCH  
ENABLED ON  
LOW V  
DD  
PSM1 OR PSM2  
Figure 37. Power Supply Management Transitions Between Modes  
Rev. B | Page 36 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
OPERATING MODES  
The program counter for the 8052, also held in volatile  
memory, becomes invalid when the 2.5 V supply is shut  
down. Therefore, the program does not resume from  
where it left off but always starts from the power-on reset  
vector when the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 exit PSM2.  
PSM0 (NORMAL MODE)  
In PSM0, or normal operating mode, VSWOUT is connected to  
VDD. All of the analog circuitry and the digital circuitry powered  
by VINTD and VINTA are enabled by default. In normal mode, the  
default clock frequency, fCORE, which is established during a  
power-on reset or software reset, is 1.024 MHz.  
The 3.3 V peripherals (temperature ADC1, VDCIN ADC1, RTC,  
and LCD) are active in PSM2. They can be enabled or disabled  
to reduce power consumption and are configured for PSM2  
operation when the MCU core is active (see Table 29 for more  
information about the peripherals and their PSM2 configuration).  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 remain in PSM2 until an event occurs to wake them up.  
PSM1 (BATTERY MODE)  
In PSM1, or battery mode, VSWOUT is connected to VBAT. In this  
operating mode, the 8052 core and all of the digital circuitry are  
enabled by default. The analog circuitry for the ADE energy  
metering DSP powered by VINTA is disabled. This analog circuitry  
automatically restarts, and the switch to the VDD power supply  
occurs, when the VDD supply is >2.75 V and the PWRDN bit in  
the MODE1 register (Address 0x0B) is cleared (see Table 33). The  
default fCORE for PSM1, established during a power-on reset or  
software reset, is 1.024 MHz.  
In PSM2 mode, the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 provide four scratch pad RAM SFRs that  
are maintained during this mode. These SFRs can be used  
to save data from PSM0 or PSM1 mode when entering PSM2  
mode (see Table 22 to Table 25).  
PSM2 (SLEEP MODE)  
PSM2 is a low power consumption sleep mode for use in battery  
operation. In this mode, VSWOUT is connected to VBAT. All of the  
2.5 V digital and analog circuitry powered through VINTA and VINTD  
is disabled, including the MCU core, resulting in the following:  
In PSM2, the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 maintain some SFRs (see Table 28). The  
SFRs that are not listed in this table should be restored when the  
part enters PSM0 or PSM1 mode from PSM2 mode.  
The RAM in the MCU is no longer valid.  
Table 28. SFRs Maintained in PSM2 Mode  
I/O Configuration  
Power Supply Management  
RTC Peripherals  
LCD Peripherals  
Interrupt pins configuration SFR  
(INTPR, Address 0xFF); see Table 17  
Battery detection threshold SFR  
(BATVTH, Address 0xFA); see  
Table 52  
RTC nominal compensation SFR  
(RTCCOMP, Address 0xF6); see  
Table 134  
LCD Segment Enable 2 SFR  
(LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED); see  
Table 98  
Peripheral configuration SFR  
(PERIPH, Address 0xF4);  
see Table 20  
Battery switchover configuration RTC temperature compensation  
LCD Configuration Y SFR  
(LCDCONY, Address 0xB1); see  
Table 91  
SFR (BATPR, Address 0xF5); see  
Table 19  
SFR (TEMPCAL, Address 0xF7);  
see Table 135  
Port 0 weak pull-up enable SFR  
(PINMAP0, Address 0xB2); see  
Table 157  
Battery ADC value SFR  
(BATADC, Address 0xDF); see  
Table 541  
RTC configuration SFR (TIMECON, LCD Configuration X SFR  
Address 0xA1); see Table 128  
(LCDCONX, Address 0x9C); see  
Table 89  
Port 1 weak pull-up enable SFR  
(PINMAP1, Address 0xB3); see  
Table 158  
Peripheral ADC strobe period SFR Hundredths of a second counter  
LCD configuration SFR  
(STRBPER, Address 0xF9);  
SFR (HTHSEC, 0xA2); see Table 129 (LCDCON, Address 0x95); see  
Table 88  
see Table 491  
Port 2 weak pull-up enable SFR  
(PINMAP2, Address 0xB4); see  
Table 159  
Temperature and supply delta SFR  
(DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3); see  
Table 501  
Seconds counter SFR (SEC, 0xA3); LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK,  
see Table 130  
Address 0x96); see Table 92  
Scratch Pad 1 SFR (SCRATCH1,  
Address 0xFB); see Table 22  
VDCIN ADC value SFR (VDCINADC,  
Address 0xEF); see Table 531  
Minutes counter SFR (MIN, 0xA4); LCD segment enable SFR  
see Table 131  
(LCDSEGE, Address 0x97); see  
Table 95  
Scratch Pad 2 SFR (SCRATCH2,  
Address 0xFC); see Table 23  
Temperature ADC value SFR  
(TEMPADC, Address 0xD7); see  
Table 551  
Hours counter SFR (HOUR, 0xA5); LCD pointer SFR (LCDPTR,  
see Table 132 Address 0xAC); see Table 96  
Scratch Pad 3 SFR (SCRATCH3,  
Address 0xFD); see Table 24  
Alarm interval SFR (INTVAL, 0xA6); LCD data SFR (LCDDAT,  
see Table 133 Address 0xAE); see Table 97  
Scratch Pad 4 SFR (SCRATCH4,  
Address 0xFE); see Table 25  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Rev. B | Page 37 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
3.3 V PERIPHERALS AND WAKE-UP EVENTS  
Some of the 3.3 V peripherals are capable of waking the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 from PSM2  
mode. The events that can cause the devices to wake up from  
PSM2 mode are listed in the Wake-Up Event column in Table 29.  
The interrupt flag associated with these events must be cleared  
prior to executing instructions that put the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 in PSM2 mode after  
wake-up.  
Table 29. 3.3 V Peripherals and Wake-Up Events  
Wake-  
Up  
Event  
3.3 V  
Peripheral  
Wake-Up  
Enable Bits  
Interrupt  
Vector  
Flag  
Comments  
Temperature ∆T  
ADC  
Maskable  
The temperature ADC can wake up the ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569. A pending interrupt is generated  
according to the description in the Temperature Measurement  
section. This wake-up event can be disabled by disabling temperature  
measurements in the temperature and supply delta SFR (DIFFPROG,  
Address 0xF3) in PSM2 mode. The temperature interrupt needs to be  
serviced and acknowledged prior to entering PSM2 mode.  
VDCIN ADC  
ΔV  
Maskable  
FVADC  
PSR  
IPSM  
IPSM  
The VDCIN measurement can wake up the ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569. FVADC is set according to the  
description in the External Voltage Measurement section. This wake-  
up event can be disabled by clearing EVADC in the power manage-  
ment interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC); see Table 21. The  
FVADC flag needs to be cleared prior to entering PSM2 mode.  
Power Supply PSR  
Management  
Nonmaskable  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 wake  
up if the power supply is restored (if VSWOUT switches to be connected  
to VDD). The VSWSOURCE flag, Bit 6 of the peripheral configuration SFR  
(PERIPH, Address 0xF4), is set to indicate that VSWOUT is connected to VDD  
.
RTC  
Midnight Nonmaskable  
Midnight IRTC  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
wake up at midnight every day to update their calendars. The RTC  
interrupt needs to be serviced and acknowledged prior to entering  
PSM2 mode.  
Alarm  
Maskable  
ALARM  
IRTC  
An alarm can be set to wake the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 after the desired amount of time. The  
RTC alarm is enabled by setting the ALARM bit in the RTC configur-  
ation SFR (TIMECON, 0xA1). The RTC interrupt needs to be serviced  
and acknowledged prior to entering PSM2 mode.  
I/O Ports1  
INT0  
INT1  
INT0PRG = 1  
IE0  
IE1  
The edge of the interrupt is selected by the IT0 bit in the TCON SFR  
(TCON, Address 0x88). The IE0 flag bit in the TCON SFR is not affected.  
The Interrupt 0 interrupt needs to be serviced and acknowledged  
prior to entering PSM2 mode.  
INT1PRG = 11x  
The edge of the interrupt is selected by the IT1 bit in the TCON SFR  
(TCON, Address 0x88). The IE1 flag bit in the TCON SFR is not affected.  
The Interrupt 1 interrupt needs to be serviced and acknowledged  
prior to entering PSM2 mode.  
Rx Edge  
RESET  
RXPROG[1:0] = PERIPH[7]  
An Rx edge event occurs if a rising or falling edge is detected on the  
Rx line. The UART RxD flag needs to be cleared prior to entering  
PSM2 mode.  
11  
(RXFG)  
External  
Reset  
Nonmaskable  
If the RESET pin is brought low while the ASE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 are in PSM2 mode, they  
wake up to PSM1 mode.  
LCD  
The LCD can be enabled/disabled in PSM2 mode. The LCD data  
memory remains intact.  
Scratch Pad  
The four SCRATCHx registers remain intact in PSM2 mode.  
1 All I/O pins are treated as inputs. The weak pull-up on each I/O pin can be disabled individually in the Port 0 weak pull-up enable SFR (PINMAP0, Address 0xB2), Port 1  
weak pull-up enable SFR (PINMAP1, Address 0xB3), and Port 2 weak pull-up enable SFR (PINMAP2, Address 0xB4) to decrease current consumption. The interrupts can  
be enabled or disabled.  
Rev. B | Page 38 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Automatic Switch to VDD (PSM2 to PSM0)  
TRANSITIONING BETWEEN OPERATING MODES  
If the conditions to switch VSWOUT from VBAT to VDD occur (see  
the Battery Switchover section), the operating mode switches to  
PSM0. When this switch occurs, the analog circuitry used in the  
ADE energy measurement DSP automatically restarts. Note that  
code execution continues normally. A software reset can be perf-  
ormed to start PSM0 code execution at the power-on reset vector.  
The operating mode of the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 is determined by the power  
supply connected to VSWOUT. Therefore, changes in the power  
supply, such as when VSWOUT switches from VDD to VBAT or when  
VSWOUT switches to VDD, alter the operating mode. This section  
describes events that change the operating mode.  
USING THE POWER MANAGEMENT FEATURES  
Automatic Battery Switchover (PSM0 to PSM1)  
If any of the enabled battery switchover events occurs (see the  
Battery Switchover section), VSWOUT switches to VBAT. This  
switchover results in a transition from PSM0 to PSM1 operating  
mode. When battery switchover occurs, the analog circuitry  
used in the ADE energy measurement DSP is disabled. To  
reduce power consumption, the user code can initiate a  
transition to PSM2.  
Because program flow is different for each operating mode, the  
status of VSWOUT must be known at all times. The VSWSOURCE  
bit in the peripheral configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address  
0xF4) indicates the power supply to which VSWOUT is connected  
(see Table 20). This bit can be used to control program flow on  
wake-up. Because code execution always starts at the power-on  
reset vector, Bit 6 of the PERIPH SFR can be tested to determine  
which power supply is being used and to branch to normal code  
execution or to wake up event code execution. Power supply  
events can also occur when the MCU core is active. To be aware  
of the events that change what VSWOUT is connected to, use the  
following guidelines:  
Entering Sleep Mode (PSM1 to PSM2)  
To reduce power consumption when VSWOUT is connected to  
VBAT, user code can initiate sleep mode, PSM2, by setting Bit 4  
in the power control SFR (POWCON, Address 0xC5) to shut  
down the MCU core. Events capable of waking the MCU can be  
enabled (see the 3.3 V Peripherals and Wake-Up Events section).  
Enable the battery switchover interrupt (EBSO)  
if VSWOUT = VDD at power-up.  
Servicing Wake-Up Events (PSM2 to PSM1)  
Enable the power supply restored interrupt (EPSR)  
if VSWOUT = VBAT at power-up.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 may need to wake up from PSM2 mode to service  
wake-up events (see the 3.3 V Peripherals and Wake-Up Events).  
PSM1 code execution begins at the power-on reset vector. After  
servicing the wake-up event, the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 can return to PSM2 mode by  
setting Bit 4 in the power control SFR (POWCON, Address  
0xC5) to shut down the MCU core.  
An early warning that battery switchover is about to occur is  
provided by SAG detection and, possibly, by low VDCIN detection  
(see the Battery Switchover section).  
For a user-controlled battery switchover, enable automatic  
battery switchover on low VDD only. Next, enable the low VDCIN  
event to generate the PSM interrupt. When a low VDCIN event  
occurs, start data backup. Upon completion of the data backup,  
enable battery switchover on low VDCIN. Battery switchover  
occurs 30 ms later.  
POWER SUPPLY  
RESTORED  
AUTOMATIC BATTERY  
SWITCHOVER  
PSM1  
PSM0  
BATTERY MODE  
NORMAL MODE  
CONNECTED TO V  
V
CONNECTED TO V  
V
SWOUT  
BAT  
SWOUT  
DD  
POWER SUPPLY  
RESTORED  
WAKE-UP  
EVENT  
USER CODE DIRECTS MCU  
TO SHUT DOWN CORE AFTER  
SERVICING WAKE-UP EVENT  
PSM2  
SLEEP MODE  
CONNECTED TO V  
V
SWOUT  
BAT  
Figure 38. Transitioning Between Operating Modes  
Rev. B | Page 39 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ENERGY MEASUREMENT  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 offer a fixed function, energy measurement, digital  
processing core that provides all the information needed to  
measure energy in single-phase energy meters. The part  
provides two ways to access the energy measurements: direct  
access through SFRs for time sensitive information and indirect  
access through address and data SFRs for the majority of energy  
measurements. The Irms, Vrms, interrupts, and waveform registers  
are readily available through the SFRs, as shown in Table 31.  
Other energy measurement information is mapped to a page of  
memory that is accessed indirectly through the MADDPT,  
MDATL, MDATM, and MDATH SFRs. The address and data  
SFRs act as pointers to the energy measurement internal  
registers.  
in the MADDPT SFR. If the internal register is one byte long,  
only the MDATL SFR content is copied to the internal register,  
and the MDATM SFR and MDATH SFR contents are ignored.  
The energy measurement core functions with an internal clock  
of 4.096 MHz/5 or 819.2 kHz. Because the 8052 core functions  
with another clock, 4.096 MHz∕2CD, synchronization between  
the two clock environments when CD = 0 or 1 is an issue. When  
data is written to the internal energy measurement registers, a  
small wait period needs to be implemented before another read  
or write to these registers can take place.  
Sample code to write 0x0155 to the 2-byte SAGLVL register  
located at Address 0x14 in the energy measurement memory  
space is as follows:  
MOV  
MOV  
MOV  
MOV  
DJNZ  
MDATM,#01h  
ACCESS TO ENERGY MEASUREMENT SFRs  
MDATL,#55h  
Access to the energy measurement SFRs is achieved by reading  
or writing to the SFR addresses provided in Table 31. The  
internal data for the MIRQx SFRs is latched byte by byte into  
the SFR when the SFR is read.  
MADDPT,#SAGLVL_W (Address 0x94)  
A,#05h  
ACC,$  
;Next write or read to energy  
measurement SFR can be done after  
this.  
The WAV1x, WAV2x, VRMSx, and IRMSx registers are all 3-byte  
SFRs. The 24-bit data is latched into these SFRs when the high  
byte is read. Reading the low or medium byte before the high  
byte results in reading the data from the previous latched sample.  
Reading the Internal Energy Measurement Registers  
When Bit 7 of the energy measurement pointer address SFR  
(MADDPT, Address 0x91) is cleared, the content of the internal  
energy measurement register designated by the address in  
MADDPT is transferred to the MDATx SFRs. If the internal  
register is one byte long, only the MDATL SFR content is  
updated with a new value, and the MDATM SFR and MDATH  
SFR contents are reset to 0x00.  
Sample code to read the VRMSx register is as follows:  
MOV  
R1, VRMSH  
//latches data in VRMSH,  
VRMSM, and VRMSL SFRs  
MOV  
MOV  
R2, VRMSM  
R3, VRMSL  
ACCESS TO INTERNAL ENERGY MEASUREMENT  
REGISTERS  
The energy measurement core functions with an internal clock  
of 4.096 MHz/5 or 819.2 kHz. Because the 8052 core functions  
with another clock, 4.096 MHz∕2CD, synchronization between  
the two clock environments when CD = 0 or 1 is an issue. When  
data is read from the internal energy measurement registers, a  
small wait period needs to be implemented before the MDATx  
SFRs are transferred to another SFR.  
Access to the internal energy measurement registers is achieved  
by writing to the energy measurement pointer address SFR  
(MADDPT, Address 0x91). This SFR selects the energy measure-  
ment register to be accessed and determines whether a read or  
a write is performed (see Table 30).  
Table 30. Energy Measurement Pointer Address SFR  
(MADDPT, Address 0x91)  
Sample code to read the peak voltage in the 2-byte VPKLVL  
register located at 0x16 into the data pointer is as follows:  
Bit  
Description  
MOV  
MOV  
DJNZ  
MOV  
MOV  
MADDPT,#VPKLVL_R (Address 0x16)  
7
1 = write, 0 = read  
A,#05h  
[6:0]  
Energy measurement internal register address  
ACC,$  
Writing to the Internal Energy Measurement Registers  
DPH,MDATM  
DPL,MDATL  
When Bit 7 of the energy measurement pointer address SFR  
(MADDPT, Address 0x91) is set, the content of the MDATx  
SFRs (MDATL, MDATM, and MDATH) is transferred to the  
internal energy measurement register designated by the address  
Rev. B | Page 40 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 31. Energy Measurement SFRs  
Address  
0x91  
0x92  
0x93  
0x94  
0xD1  
0xD2  
0xD3  
0xD4  
0xD5  
0xD6  
0xD9  
0xDA  
0xDB  
0xDC  
0xDD  
0xDE  
0xE2  
0xE3  
0xE4  
0xE5  
0xE6  
0xE7  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
R
R
R
R
Mnemonic  
MADDPT  
MDATL  
MDATM  
MDATH  
VRMSL  
VRMSM  
VRMSH  
IRMSL  
Description  
Energy measurement pointer address.  
Energy measurement pointer data LSB.  
Energy measurement pointer data middle byte.  
Energy measurement pointer data MSB.  
Vrms measurement LSB.  
Vrms measurement middle byte.  
Vrms measurement MSB.  
Irms measurement LSB.  
IRMSM  
IRMSH  
Irms measurement middle byte.  
Irms measurement MSB.  
R
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
R
R
R
R
MIRQENL  
MIRQENM  
MIRQENH  
MIRQSTL  
MIRQSTM  
MIRQSTH  
WAV1L  
WAV1M  
WAV1H  
WAV2L  
Energy measurement interrupt enable LSB.  
Energy measurement interrupt enable middle byte.  
Energy measurement interrupt enable MSB.  
Energy measurement interrupt status LSB.  
Energy measurement interrupt status middle byte.  
Energy measurement interrupt status MSB.  
Selection 1 sample LSB.  
Selection 1 sample middle byte.  
Selection 1 sample MSB.  
Selection 2 sample LSB.  
WAV2M  
WAV2H  
Selection 2 sample middle byte.  
Selection 2 sample MSB.  
R
×1, ×2, ×4,  
×8, ×16  
INTEGRATOR  
WGAIN[11:0]  
{GAIN[2:0]}  
I
I
P
N
MULTIPLIER  
dt  
PGA1  
I
ADC  
LPF2  
HPF  
CF1NUM[15:0]  
WATTOS[15:0]  
π
VARGAIN[11:0]  
PHCAL[7:0]  
2
CF1  
DFC  
Ф
LPF2  
CF1DEN[15:0]  
CF2NUM[15:0]  
VAROS[15:0]  
VAGAIN[11:0]  
IRMSOS[11:0]  
2
2
×
×
CF2  
DFC  
LPF  
VRMSOS[11:0]  
VARDIV[7:0]  
V
V
CF2DEN[15:0]  
P
PGA2  
ADC  
VADIV[7:0]  
%
%
%
WDIV[7:0]  
LPF  
HPF  
N
METERING SFRs  
Figure 39. ADE7566 and ADE7569 Energy Metering Block Diagram  
Rev. B | Page 41 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
×1, ×2, ×4,  
×8, ×16  
{GAIN[2:0]}  
I
PA  
INTEGRATOR  
WGAIN[11:0]  
PGA1  
PGA1  
I
ADC  
ADC  
MULTIPLIER  
HPF  
HPF  
I
N
dt  
LPF2  
WATTOS[15:0]  
π
I
2
PB  
CF1NUM[15:0]  
IBGAIN[11:0]  
PHCAL[7:0]  
VARGAIN[11:0]  
CF1  
DFC  
Ф
LPF2  
CF1DEN[15:0]  
CF2NUM[15:0]  
VAROS[15:0]  
VAGAIN[11:0]  
IRMSOS[11:0]  
2
2
×
×
CF2  
DFC  
LPF  
VRMSOS[11:0]  
VARDIV[7:0]  
V
2P  
CF2DEN[15:0]  
PGA2  
ADC  
VADIV[7:0]  
%
%
%
WDIV[7:0]  
LPF  
HPF  
V
2N  
METERING SFRs  
Figure 40. ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, and ADE7169 Energy Metering Block Diagram  
Rev. B | Page 42 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ENERGY MEASUREMENT REGISTERS  
Table 32. Energy Measurement Register List  
Address  
Length Signed/  
MADDPT[6:0] Mnemonic R/W (Bits)  
Unsigned Default Description  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x06  
0x07  
WATTHR  
RWATTHR  
LWATTHR  
VARHR1  
RVARHR1  
LVARHR1  
VAHR  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
24  
24  
24  
24  
24  
24  
24  
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reads Wh accumulator without reset.  
Reads Wh accumulator with reset.  
Reads Wh accumulator synchronous to line cycle.  
Reads VARh accumulator without reset.  
Reads VARh accumulator with reset.  
Reads VARh accumulator synchronous to line cycle.  
Reads VAh accumulator without reset. If the VARMSCFCON bit in the  
MODE2 register (Address 0x0C) is set, this register accumulates Irms  
.
0x08  
0x09  
RVAHR  
LVAHR  
R
R
24  
24  
S
S
0
0
Reads VAh accumulator with reset. If the VARMSCFCON bit in the  
MODE2 register (Address 0x0C) is set, this register accumulates Irms  
.
Reads VAh accumulator synchronous to line cycle. If the VARMSCFCON  
bit in the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C) is set, this register accumulates  
Irms.  
0x0A  
0x0B  
0x0C  
0x0D  
PER_FREQ  
MODE1  
R
16  
8
U
U
U
U
0
Reads line period or frequency register depending on MODE2 register.  
Sets basic configuration of energy measurement (see Table 33).  
Sets basic configuration of energy measurement (see Table 34).  
R/W  
R/W  
0x06  
0x40  
0
MODE2  
8
WAVMODE R/W  
8
Sets configuration of Waveform Sample 1 and Waveform Sample 2  
(see Table 35).  
0x0E  
0x0F  
NLMODE  
R/W  
8
8
U
U
0
0
Sets level of energy no load thresholds (see Table 36).  
ACCMODE R/W  
Sets configuration of watt and var accumulation and various tamper  
alarms (see Table 37).  
0x10  
0x11  
PHCAL  
R/W  
8
S
0x40  
Sets phase calibration register (see the Phase Compensation section).  
ZXTOUT  
R/W 12  
0x0FFF Sets timeout for zero-crossing timeout detection (see the Zero-  
Crossing Timeout section).  
0x12  
0x13  
0x14  
0x15  
0x16  
LINCYC  
SAGCYC  
SAGLVL  
IPKLVL  
R/W 16  
U
U
U
U
U
0xFFFF Sets number of half-line cycles for LWATTHR, LVARHR, and LVAHR  
accumulators.  
R/W  
8
0xFF  
Sets number of half-line cycles for SAG detection (see the Line  
Voltage SAG Detection section).  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
0
Sets detection level for SAG detection (see the Line Voltage SAG  
Detection section).  
0xFFFF Sets peak detection level for current peak detection (see the Peak  
Detection section).  
VPKLVL  
0xFFFF Sets peak detection level for voltage peak detection (see the Peak  
Detection section).  
0x17  
0x18  
0x19  
IPEAK  
R
R
R
24  
24  
24  
U
U
U
0
0
0
Reads current peak level without reset (see the Peak Detection section).  
Reads current peak level with reset (see the Peak Detection section).  
RSTIPEAK  
VPEAK  
Reads voltage peak level without reset (see the Peak Detection  
section).  
0x1A  
0x1B  
0x1C  
0x1D  
0x1E  
0x1F  
0x20  
0x21  
0x22  
0x23  
0x24  
RSTVPEAK  
GAIN  
R
24  
8
U
U
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reads voltage peak level with reset (see the Peak Detection section).  
Sets PGA gain of analog inputs (see Table 38).  
Sets matching gain for IPB current input.  
Sets watt gain register.  
R/W  
IBGAIN2  
WGAIN  
VARGAIN1  
VAGAIN  
WATTOS  
VAROS1  
IRMSOS  
VRMSOS  
WDIV  
R/W 12  
R/W 12  
R/W 12  
R/W 12  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
R/W 12  
R/W 12  
Sets var gain register.  
Sets VA gain register.  
Sets watt offset register.  
Sets var offset register.  
Sets current rms offset register.  
Sets voltage rms offset register.  
Sets watt energy scaling register.  
R/W  
8
Rev. B | Page 43 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Address Length Signed/  
MADDPT[6:0] Mnemonic R/W (Bits) Unsigned Default Description  
0x25  
0x26  
0x27  
0x28  
0x29  
0x2A  
0x3B  
0x3C  
0x3D  
0x3E  
0x3F  
VARDIV  
R/W  
R/W  
8
8
U
U
U
U
U
U
0
0
0
Sets var energy scaling register.  
Sets VA energy scaling register.  
Sets CF1 numerator register.  
VADIV  
CF1NUM  
CF1DEN  
CF2NUM  
CF2DEN  
Reserved  
Reserved  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
R/W 16  
0x003F Sets CF1 denominator register.  
Sets CF2 numerator register.  
0x003F Sets CF2 denominator register.  
0
0
This register must be set to its default value for proper operation.  
0x0300 This register must be set to its default value for proper operation.  
CALMODE2 R/W  
8
U
0
0
0
Set calibration mode.  
Reserved  
This register must be set to its default value for proper operation.  
This register must be set to its default value for proper operation.  
Reserved  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
2 This function is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
ENERGY MEASUREMENT INTERNAL REGISTER DETAILS  
Table 33. MODE1 Register (MODE1, Address 0x0B)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SWRST  
DISZXLPF  
INTE  
SWAPBITS  
PWRDN  
DISCF2  
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
Setting this bit resets all of the energy measurement registers to their default values.  
Setting this bit disables the zero-crossing low-pass filter.  
Setting this bit enables the digital integrator for use with a di/dt sensor.  
Setting this bit swaps CH1 ADC and CH2 ADC.  
Setting this bit powers down voltage and current ADCs.  
Setting this bit disables Frequency Output CF2.  
DISCF1  
DISHPF  
Setting this bit disables Frequency Output CF1.  
Setting this bit disables the HPFs in voltage and current channels.  
Table 34. MODE2 Register (MODE2, Address 0x0C)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:6]  
CF2SEL  
01  
Configuration bits for CF2 output.  
CF2SEL  
00  
01  
Result  
CF2 frequency is proportional to active power.  
CF2 frequency is proportional to reactive power.1  
CF2 frequency is proportional to apparent power or Irms  
1X  
.
[5:4]  
CF1SEL  
00  
0
Configuration bits for CF1 output.  
CF1SEL  
00  
01  
Result  
CF1 frequency is proportional to active power.  
CF1 frequency is proportional to reactive power.1  
CF1 frequency is proportional to apparent power or Irms  
1X  
.
3
VARMSCFCON  
Configuration bits for apparent power or Irms for CF1, CF2 outputs and VA accumulation registers  
(VAHR, RVAHR, and LVAHR). Note that CF1 cannot be proportional to VA if CF2 is proportional to  
Irms, and vice versa.  
VARMSCFCON Result  
0
1
If CF1SEL[1:0] = 1X, CF1 is proportional to VA.  
If CF2SEL[1:0] = 1X, CF2 is proportional to VA.  
If CF1SEL[1:0] = 1X, CF1 is proportional to Irms  
.
If CF2SEL[1:0] = 1X, CF2 is proportional to Irms  
.
2
ZXRMS  
0
Logic 1 enables update of rms values synchronously to Voltage ZX.  
Rev. B | Page 44 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
1
FREQSEL  
0
Configuration bits to select period or frequency measurement for PER_FREQ register  
(Address 0x0A).  
FREQSEL  
Result  
0
1
PER_FREQ register holds a period measurement.  
PER_FREQ register holds a frequency measurement.  
0
WAVEN  
0
When this bit is set, waveform sampling mode is enabled.  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 35. Waveform Mode Register (WAVMODE, Address 0x0D)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:5]  
WAV2SEL  
000  
Waveform Sample 2 selection for samples mode.  
WAV2SEL  
000  
Source  
Current  
001  
Voltage  
010  
011  
100  
101  
Active power multiplier output  
Reactive power multiplier output1  
VA multiplier output  
Irms LPF output  
Others  
Reserved  
[4:2]  
WAV1SEL  
000  
Waveform Sample 1 selection for samples mode.  
WAV1SEL  
000  
Source  
Current  
001  
Voltage  
010  
011  
100  
101  
Active power multiplier output  
Reactive power multiplier output1  
VA multiplier output  
Irms LPF output (low 24-bit)  
Reserved  
Others  
[1: 0]  
DTRT  
00  
Waveform samples output data rate.  
DTRT  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Update Rate (Clock = fCORE/5 = 819.2 kHz)  
25.6 kSPS (clock/32)  
12.8 kSPS (clock/64)  
6.4 kSPS (clock/128)  
3.2 kSPS (clock/256)  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 36. No Load Configuration Register (NLMODE, Address 0x0E)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
DISVARCMP1  
0
0
Setting this bit disables fundamental var gain compensation over line frequency.  
6
IRMSNOLOAD  
Logic 1 enables Irms no load threshold detection. The level is defined by the setting of the  
VANOLOAD bits.  
[5:4]  
VANOLOAD  
00  
Apparent power no load threshold.  
VANOLOAD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No load detection disabled  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.030% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.015% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.0075% of full scale  
Rev. B | Page 45 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
VARNOLOAD1  
Default  
Description  
[3:2]  
00  
Reactive power no load threshold.  
VARNOLOAD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No load detection disabled  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.015% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.0075% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.0037% of full scale  
[1:0]  
APNOLOAD  
00  
Active power no load threshold.  
APNOLOAD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No load detection disabled  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.015% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.0075% of full scale  
No load detection enabled with threshold = 0.0037% of full scale  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 37. Accumulation Mode Register (ACCMODE, Address 0x0F)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
ICHANNEL1  
Default  
Description  
7
0
This bit indicates the current channel used to measure energy in antitampering mode.  
0 = Channel A (IPA)  
1 = Channel B (IPB)  
6
FAULTSIGN1  
0
Configuration bit to select the event that triggers a fault interrupt.  
0 = FAULT interrupt occurs when part enters fault mode  
1 = FAULT interrupt occurs when part enters normal mode  
5
4
VARSIGN2  
APSIGN  
0
0
Configuration bit to select the event that triggers a reactive power sign interrupt. If cleared to 0,  
a VARSIGN interrupt occurs when reactive power changes from positive to negative. If set to 1, a  
VARSIGN interrupt occurs when reactive power changes from negative to positive.  
Configuration bit to select event that triggers an active power sign interrupt. If cleared to 0, an  
APSIGN interrupt occurs when active power changes from positive to negative. If set to 1, an  
APSIGN interrupt occurs when active power changes from negative to positive.  
3
2
ABSVARM2  
SAVARM2  
0
0
Logic 1 enables absolute value accumulation of reactive power in energy register and pulse  
output.  
Logic 1 enables reactive power accumulation depending on the sign of the active power. If  
active power is positive, var is accumulated as it is. If active power is negative, the sign of the var  
is reversed for the accumulation. This accumulation mode affects both the var registers (VARHR,  
RVARHR, LVARHR) and the pulse output when connected to var.2  
1
0
POAM  
0
0
Logic 1 enables positive-only accumulation of active power in energy register and pulse output.  
ABSAM  
Logic 1 enables absolute value accumulation of active power in energy register and pulse  
output.  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
2 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 38. Gain Register (GAIN, Address 0x1B)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:5]  
PGA2  
000  
These bits define the voltage channel input gain.  
PGA2  
000  
001  
010  
011  
Result  
Gain = 1  
Gain = 2  
Gain = 4  
Gain = 8  
Gain = 16  
100  
4
Reserved  
0
Reserved.  
Rev. B | Page 46 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
3
CFSIGN_OPT  
0
This bit defines where the CF change of sign detection (APSIGN or VARSIGN) is  
implemented.  
CFSIGN_OPT  
Result  
0
1
Filtered power signal  
On a per-CF basis  
[2:0]  
PGA1  
000  
These bits define the current channel input gain.  
PGA1  
000  
001  
010  
011  
Result  
Gain = 11  
Gain = 2  
Gain = 4  
Gain = 8  
Gain = 16  
100  
1 This gain is not recommended in the ADE7166 or ADE7169 because it can create an overranging of the ADC when both current inputs are in opposite phase.  
Table 39. Calibration Mode Register (CALMODE, Address 0x3D)1  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
SEL_I_CH  
Default  
Description  
[7:6]  
[5:4]  
0
0
These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
These bits define the current channel used for energy measurements.  
SEL_I_CH  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Current channel automatically selected by the tampering condition  
Current channel connected to IPA  
Current channel connected to IPB  
Current channel automatically selected by the tampering condition  
3
V_CH_SHORT  
I_CH_SHORT  
Reserved  
0
0
Logic 1 shorts the voltage channel to ground.  
Logic 1 shorts the current channel to ground.  
These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
2
[1:0]  
1 This register is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
INTERRUPT STATUS/ENABLE SFRs  
Table 40. Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC)  
Bit  
Interrupt Flag  
Description  
7
ADEIRQFLAG  
This bit is set if any of the ADE status flags that are enabled to generate an ADE interrupt is set. This bit is  
automatically cleared when all of the enabled ADE status flags are cleared.  
6
5
4
Reserved  
Reserved.  
FAULTSIGN1  
VARSIGN2  
Logic 1 indicates that the fault mode has changed according to the configuration of the ACCMODE register.  
Logic 1 indicates that the reactive power sign has changed according to the configuration of the ACCMODE  
register.  
3
2
APSIGN  
Logic 1 indicates that the active power sign has changed according to the configuration of the ACCMODE register.  
VANOLOAD  
Logic 1 indicates that an interrupt has been caused by apparent power no load detection. This interrupt is  
also used to reflect that the part is entering the Irms no load mode.  
1
0
RNOLOAD2  
APNOLOAD  
Logic 1 indicates that an interrupt has been caused by reactive power no load detection.  
Logic 1 indicates that an interrupt has been caused by active power no load detection.  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
2 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Rev. B | Page 47 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 41. Interrupt Status 2 SFR (MIRQSTM, Address 0xDD)  
Bit  
Interrupt Flag  
Description  
7
CF2  
Logic 1 indicates that a pulse on CF2 has been issued. The flag is set even if the CF2 pulse output is not  
enabled by clearing Bit 2 of the MODE1 register.  
6
CF1  
Logic 1 indicates that a pulse on CF1 has been issued. The flag is set even if the CF1 pulse output is not  
enabled by clearing Bit 1 of the MODE1 register.  
5
4
3
2
1
0
VAEOF  
REOF1  
AEOF  
Logic 1 indicates that the VAHR register has overflowed.  
Logic 1 indicates that the VARHR register has overflowed.  
Logic 1 indicates that the WATTHR register has overflowed.  
Logic 1 indicates that the VAHR register is half full.  
Logic 1 indicates that the VARHR register is half full.  
Logic 1 indicates that the WATTHR register is half full.  
VAEHF  
REHF1  
AEHF  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 42. Interrupt Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE)  
Bit  
Interrupt Flag  
RESET  
Reserved  
WFSM  
PKI  
PKV  
CYCEND  
ZXTO  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Indicates the end of a reset (for both software and hardware reset).  
Reserved.  
Logic 1 indicates that new data is present in the waveform registers (Address 0xE2 to Address 0xE7).  
Logic 1 indicates that the current channel has exceeded the IPKLVL value.  
Logic 1 indicates that the voltage channel has exceeded the VPKLVL value.  
Logic 1 indicates the end of the energy accumulation over an integer number of half-line cycles.  
Logic 1 indicates that no zero crossing on the line voltage happened for the last ZXTOUT half-line cycles.  
Logic 1 indicates detection of a zero crossing in the voltage channel.  
ZX  
Table 43. Interrupt Enable 1 SFR (MIRQENL, Address 0xD9)  
Bit  
[7:6]  
5
4
3
2
1
0
Interrupt Enable Bit  
Description  
Reserved  
FAULTSIGN1  
VARSIGN2  
Reserved.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the FAULTSIGN bit set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the VARSIGN flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the APSIGN flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the VANOLOAD flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the RNOLOAD flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the APNOLOAD flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
APSIGN  
VANOLOAD  
RNOLOAD2  
APNOLOAD  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7566 or ADE7569.  
2 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Table 44. Interrupt Enable 2 SFR (MIRQENM, Address 0xDA)  
Bit  
Interrupt Enable Bit  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CF2  
CF1  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, a CF2 pulse creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, a CF1 pulse creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the VAEOF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the REOF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the AEOF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the VAEHF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the REHF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the AEHF flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
VAEOF  
REOF1  
AEOF  
VAEHF  
REHF1  
AEHF  
1 This function is not available in the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, or ADE7566.  
Rev. B | Page 48 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 45. Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB)  
Bit  
[7:6]  
5
4
3
2
1
0
Interrupt Enable Bit  
Description  
Reserved  
WFSM  
PKI  
Reserved.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the WFSM flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the PKI flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the PKV flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the CYCEND flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the ZXTO flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the ZX flag set creates a pending ADE interrupt to the 8052 core.  
PKV  
CYCEND  
ZXTO  
ZX  
ANALOG INPUTS  
GAIN REGISTER*  
CURRENT AND VOLTAGE CHANNELS PGA CONTROL  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has two fully differential voltage input channels. The  
maximum differential input voltage for the VP/VN and IP/IN  
input pairs is 0.4 V.  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
0
0
ADDR:  
0x1B  
PGA2 GAIN SELECT  
000 = × 1  
PGA1 GAIN SELECT  
000 = × 1  
For the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169, PGA1 = 1 is not  
recommended because, at full scale, when both IPA and IPB are  
180° out of phase, the ADC can be overranged. It is recom-  
mended, for these products, that PGA1 = 2, 4, 8, or 16 be used.  
001 = × 2  
001 = × 2  
010 = × 4  
010 = × 4  
011 = × 8  
100 = × 16  
011 = × 8  
100 = × 16  
CFSIGN_OPT  
RESERVED  
Each analog input channel has a programmable gain amplifier  
(PGA) with possible gain selections of 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16. The  
gain selections are made by writing to the GAIN register (see  
Table 38 and Figure 41). Bit 2 to Bit 0 select the gain for the PGA  
in the current channel, and Bit 7 to Bit 5 select the gain for the  
PGA in the voltage channel. Figure 42 shows how a gain selec-  
tion for the current channel is made using the gain register.  
*REGISTER CONTENTS SHOW POWER-ON DEFAULTS.  
Figure 41. Analog Gain Register  
GAIN[7:0]  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
0
0
GAIN (K)  
SELECTION  
I
P
K × V  
IN  
V
IN  
I
N
Figure 42. PGA in Current Channel  
Rev. B | Page 49 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has two Σ-Δ analog-to-digital converters (ADCs). The  
outputs of these ADCs are mapped directly to waveform sampling  
SFRs (Address 0xE2 to Address 0xE7) and are used for energy  
measurement internal digital signal processing. In PSM1 (battery  
mode) and PSM2 (sleep mode), the ADCs are powered down to  
minimize power consumption.  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
is 4.096 MHz/5 (819.2 kHz), and the band of interest is 40 Hz to  
2 kHz. Oversampling has the effect of spreading the quantization  
noise (noise due to sampling) over a wider bandwidth. With the  
noise spread more thinly over a wider bandwidth, the quantiza-  
tion noise in the band of interest is lowered (see Figure 43).  
However, oversampling alone is not efficient enough to improve  
the signal-to-noise ratio (SNR) in the band of interest. For example,  
an oversampling ratio of four is required to increase the SNR by  
only 6 dB (1 bit). To keep the oversampling ratio at a reasonable  
level, it is possible to shape the quantization noise so that the  
majority of the noise lies at the higher frequencies. In the Σ-ꢀ  
modulator, the noise is shaped by the integrator, which has a  
high-pass-type response for the quantization noise. The result is  
that most of the noise is at the higher frequencies where it can  
be removed by the digital LPF. This noise shaping is shown in  
Figure 43.  
For simplicity, the block diagram in Figure 44 shows a first-  
order Σ-ꢀ ADC. The converter is made up of the Σ-ꢀ modulator  
and the digital low-pass filter (LPF).  
A Σ-ꢀ modulator converts the input signal into a continuous  
serial stream of 1s and 0s at a rate determined by the sampling  
clock. In the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569, the sampling clock is equal to 4.096 MHz/5. The  
1-bit DAC in the feedback loop is driven by the serial data  
stream. The DAC output is subtracted from the input signal. If  
the loop gain is high enough, the average value of the DAC  
output (and, therefore, the bit stream) can approach that of the  
input signal level.  
ANTIALIAS  
FILTER (RC)  
DIGITAL  
FILTER  
SAMPLING  
FREQUENCY  
SIGNAL  
SHAPED  
NOISE  
For any given input value in a single sampling interval, the data  
from the 1-bit ADC is virtually meaningless. Only when a large  
number of samples are averaged is a meaningful result obtained.  
This averaging is carried into the second part of the ADC, the  
digital LPF. By averaging a large number of bits from the  
modulator, the low-pass filter can produce 24-bit data-words  
that are proportional to the input signal level.  
NOISE  
0
2
409.6  
FREQUENCY (kHz)  
819.2  
HIGH RESOLUTION  
SIGNAL  
OUTPUT FROM DIGITAL  
LPF  
The Σ-ꢀ converter uses two techniques to achieve high  
NOISE  
resolution from what is essentially a 1-bit conversion technique.  
The first is oversampling. Oversampling means that the signal is  
sampled at a rate (frequency) that is many times higher than the  
bandwidth of interest. For example, the sampling rate in the  
0
2
409.6  
FREQUENCY (kHz)  
819.2  
Figure 43. Noise Reduction Due to Oversampling and  
Noise Shaping in the Analog Modulator  
MCLK/5  
ANALOG  
LOW-PASS FILTER  
DIGITAL  
INTEGRATOR  
LOW-PASS  
LATCHED  
COMPARATOR  
FILTER  
+
R
C
24  
V
REF  
... 10100101 ...  
1-BIT DAC  
Figure 44. First-Order Σ-∆ ADC  
Rev. B | Page 50 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ALIASING EFFECTS  
Antialiasing Filter  
Figure 44 also shows an analog LPF (RC) on the input to the  
modulator. This filter is present to prevent aliasing, an artifact  
of all sampled systems. Aliasing means that frequency com-  
ponents in the input signal to the ADC that are higher than half  
the sampling rate of the ADC appear in the sampled signal at a  
frequency below half the sampling rate. Figure 45 illustrates the  
effect. Frequency components (the black arrows) above half the  
sampling frequency (also known as the Nyquist frequency, that  
is, 409.6 kHz) are imaged or folded back down below 409.6 kHz.  
This happens with all ADCs, regardless of the architecture. In  
the example shown, only frequencies near the sampling  
frequency (819.2 kHz) move into the band of interest for  
metering (40 Hz to 2 kHz). This allows the use of a very simple  
LPF (low-pass filter) to attenuate high frequency (at  
SAMPLING  
FREQUENCY  
IMAGE  
FREQUENCIES  
0
2
409.6  
819.2  
FREQUENCY (kHz)  
Figure 45. ADC and Signal Processing in Current Channel Outline Dimensions  
ADC Transfer Function  
Both ADCs in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 are designed to produce the same output  
code for the same input signal level. With a full-scale signal on  
the input of 0.4 V and an internal reference of 1.2 V, the ADC  
output code is nominally 2,147,483 or 0x20C49B. The maximum  
code from the ADC is 4,194,304; this is equivalent to an input  
signal level of 0.794 V. However, for specified performance, it  
is recommended that the full-scale input signal level of 0.4 V  
not be exceeded.  
approximately 819.2 kHz) noise and prevents distortion in the  
band of interest.  
For conventional current sensors, a simple RC filter (single-pole  
LPF) with a corner frequency of 10 kHz produces an attenuation  
of approximately 40 dB at 819.2 kHz (see Figure 45). The 20 dB  
per decade attenuation is usually sufficient to eliminate the effects  
of aliasing for conventional current sensors. However, for a  
di/dt sensor such as a Rogowski coil, the sensor has a 20 dB per  
decade gain. This neutralizes the −20 dB per decade attenuation  
produced by one simple LPF. Therefore, when using a di/dt  
sensor, care should be taken to offset the 20 dB per decade gain.  
One simple approach is to cascade two RC filters to produce the  
−40 dB per decade attenuation needed.  
Current Channel ADC  
Figure 46 and Figure 47 show the ADC and signal processing  
chain for the current channel. In waveform sampling mode, the  
ADC outputs a signed, twos complement, 24-bit data-word at a  
maximum of 25.6 kSPS (4.096 MHz/160).  
With the specified full-scale analog input signal of 0.4 V and  
PGA1 = 1, the ADC produces an output code that is approximately  
between 0x20C49B (+2,147,483d) and 0xDF3B65 (−2,147,483d).  
For inputs of 0.25 V, 0.125 V, 62.5 mV, and 31.3 mV with PGA1 = 2,  
4, 8, and 16, respectively, the ADC produces an output code that  
is approximately between 0x28F5C2 (+2,684,354d) and 0xD70A3E  
(−2,684,354d).  
Rev. B | Page 51 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
MODE1[5]  
×1, ×2, ×4  
×8, ×16  
{GAIN[2:0]}  
CURRENT RMS (I  
CALCULATION  
)
rms  
REFERENCE  
WAVEFORM SAMPLE  
REGISTER  
DIGITAL  
INTEGRATOR*  
I
P
ACTIVE AND REACTIVE  
POWER CALCULATION  
PGA1  
ADC  
I
dt  
HPF  
I
N
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE AFTER  
INTEGRATOR (50Hz)  
50Hz  
0x342CD0  
V1  
0.25V, 0.125V,  
62.5mV, 31.3mV  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE  
0x000000  
0V  
0x28F5C2  
60Hz  
0xCBD330  
0x000000  
ANALOG  
INPUT  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
RANGE  
DATA RANGE AFTER  
INTEGRATOR (60Hz)  
0xD70A3E  
0x2B7850  
0x000000  
0xD487B0  
*WHEN DIGITAL INTEGRATOR IS ENABLED, FULL-SCALE OUTPUT DATA IS ATTENUATED  
DEPENDING ON THE SIGNAL FREQUENCY BECAUSE THE INTEGRATOR HAS A –20dB/DECADE  
FREQUENCY RESPONSE. WHEN DISABLED, THE OUTPUT IS NOT FURTHER ATTENUATED.  
NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7566.  
Figure 46. ADC and Signal Processing in Current Channel with PGA1 = 1, 2, 4, 8, or 16 for the ADE7566 and ADE7569  
MODE1[5]  
×1, ×2, ×4  
×8, ×16  
{GAIN[2:0]}  
CURRENT RMS (I  
CALCULATION  
)
rms  
REFERENCE  
ADC  
WAVEFORM SAMPLE  
REGISTER  
DIGITAL  
INTEGRATOR*  
I
PA  
ACTIVE AND REACTIVE  
POWER CALCULATION  
PGA1  
PGA1  
I
dt  
HPF  
I
N
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE AFTER  
INTEGRATOR (50Hz)  
ADC  
50Hz  
0x342CD0  
HPF  
I
PB  
V1  
0.25V, 0.125V,  
62.5mV, 31.3mV  
IBGAIN  
0x000000  
0V  
60Hz  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
0xCBD330  
WAVEFORM  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE AFTER  
INTEGRATOR (60Hz)  
DATA RANGE  
ANALOG  
INPUT  
RANGE  
0x28F5C2  
0x000000  
0xD70A3E  
0x2B7850  
0x000000  
0xD487B0  
*WHEN DIGITAL INTEGRATOR IS ENABLED, FULL-SCALE OUTPUT DATA IS ATTENUATED  
DEPENDING ON THE SIGNAL FREQUENCY BECAUSE THE INTEGRATOR HAS A –20dB/DECADE  
FREQUENCY RESPONSE. WHEN DISABLED, THE OUTPUT IS NOT FURTHER ATTENUATED.  
NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7116, ADE7156, OR ADE7166.  
Figure 47. ADC and Signal Processing in Current Channel with PGA1 = 2, 4, 8, or 16 for the ADE7116, ADE7156, ADE7166, and ADE7169  
Rev. B | Page 52 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Voltage Channel ADC  
When in waveform sampling mode, one of four output sample  
rates can be chosen by using the DTRT[1:0] bits of the  
Figure 48 shows the ADC and signal processing chain for the  
voltage channel. In waveform sampling mode, the ADC outputs  
a signed, twos complement, 24-bit data-word at a maximum  
of 25.6 kSPS (MCLK/160). The ADC produces an output code  
that is approximately between 0x28F5 (+10,485d) and 0xD70B  
(−10,485d).  
WAVMODE register (see Table 35). The output sample rate can  
be 25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS, 6.4 kSPS, or 3.2 kSPS. If the WFSM  
enable bit is set in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH,  
Address 0xDB), the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt.  
The sampled signals selected in the WAVMODE register are  
latched into the waveform SFRs when the waveform high byte  
(WAV1H or WAV2H) is read.  
Channel Sampling  
The waveform samples of the current ADC and voltage ADC  
can also be routed to the waveform registers to be read by the  
MCU core. The active, reactive, and apparent power and energy  
calculation remain uninterrupted during waveform sampling.  
The ADE interrupt stays active until the WFSM status bit is  
cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
ACTIVE AND REACTIVE  
POWER CALCULATION  
×1, ×2, ×4,  
×8, ×16  
{GAIN[7:5]}  
REFERENCE  
ADC  
VOLTAGE RMS (V  
)
rms  
V
V
P
N
CALCULATION  
HPF  
WAVEFORM SAMPLE  
REGISTER  
PGA2  
V2  
VOLTAGE PEAK DETECT  
V2  
0.5V, 0.25V,  
0.125V, 62.5mV,  
31.3mV  
ZX DETECTION  
LPF1  
f–3dB = 63.7Hz  
0V  
VOLTAGE CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE  
ZX SIGNAL  
DATA RANGE FOR 60Hz SIGNAL  
0x1DD0  
ANALOG  
MODE 1[6]  
0x28F5  
INPUT  
RANGE  
0x0000  
0xE230  
0x0000  
0xD70B  
ZX SIGNAL  
DATA RANGE FOR 50Hz SIGNAL  
0x2037  
0x0000  
0xDFC9  
Figure 48. ADC and Signal Processing in Voltage Channel  
Rev. B | Page 53 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Fault Indication  
FAULT DETECTION  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 provide an  
indication of the part going in or out of a fault condition. The  
new fault condition is indicated by the FAULTSIGN flag (Bit 5)  
in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC).  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 incorporate a  
fault detection scheme that warns of fault conditions and allows  
the part to continue accurate measurement during a fault event.  
(This function is not available in the ADE7566/ ADE7569.) The  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 do this by continu-  
ously monitoring both current inputs (IPA and IPB). For ease of  
understanding, these currents are referred to as phase and  
neutral (return) currents. A fault condition is defined when the  
difference between IPA and IPB is greater than 6.25% of the active  
channel. If a fault condition is detected and the inactive channel  
is larger than the active channel, the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169 automatically switch current measurement to  
the inactive channel. During a fault, the active, reactive, and  
apparent power and the Irms are generated using the larger of the  
two currents. On power-up, IPA is the current input selected for  
active, reactive, and apparent power and Irms calculations.  
When the FAULTSIGN bit (Bit 6) of the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F) is cleared, the FAULTSIGN flag in the Interrupt  
Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set when the part is  
entering a fault condition or a normal condition.  
When the FAULTSIGN bit (Bit 5) is set in the Interrupt Enable  
1 SFR (MIRQENL, Address 0xD9), and the FAULTSIGN flag  
(Bit 5) in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC)  
is set, the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt.  
Fault with Active Input Greater Than Inactive Input  
If IPA is the active current input (that is, being used for billing),  
and the voltage signal on IPB (the inactive input) falls below  
93.75% of IPA, and the FAULTSIGN bit (Bit 6) of the ACCMODE  
register (Address 0x0F) is cleared, the FAULTSIGN flag (Bit 5)  
in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set.  
Both analog inputs are filtered and averaged to prevent false  
triggering of this logic output. As a consequence of the filtering,  
there is a time delay of approximately 3 seconds on the logic  
output after the fault event. The FAULTSIGN flag is indepen-  
dent of any activity. Because IPA is the active input and it is still  
greater than IPB, billing is maintained on IPA; that is, no swap to  
the IPB input occurs. IPA remains the active input.  
To prevent a false alarm, averaging is done for the fault  
detection, and a fault condition is detected approximately  
1 second after the event. Fault detection is automatically  
disabled when the voltage signal is less than 0.3% of the full-  
scale input range. This eliminates false detection of a fault due  
to noise at light loads.  
Because the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 look for  
a difference between the voltage signals on IPA and IPB, it is  
important that both current transducers be closely matched.  
Channel Selection Indication  
The current channel selected for measurement is indicated by  
Bit 7 (ICHANNEL) in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F).  
When this bit is cleared, IPA is selected and, when it is set, IPB is  
selected. The ADE7166/ADE7169 automatically switch from  
one channel to the other and report the channel configuration  
in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F).  
The current channel selected for measurement can also be  
forced. Setting the SEL_I_CH[1:0] bits in the CALMODE  
register (Address 0x3D) selects IPA and IPB, respectively. When  
both bits are cleared or set, the current channel used for  
measurement is selected automatically based on the fault  
detection.  
Rev. B | Page 54 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
I
R
F
Fault with Inactive Input Greater Than Active Input  
PA  
I
PB  
CT  
0
If the difference between IPB, the inactive input, and IPA, the  
active input (that is, being used for billing), becomes greater  
than 6.25% of IPB, and the FAULTSIGN bit (Bit 6) of the  
ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F) is cleared, the FAULTSIGN  
flag (Bit 5) in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address  
0xDC) is set. The IPB analog input becomes the active input.  
Again, a time constant of about 3 seconds is associated with this  
swap. IPA does not become the active channel again until IPA is  
greater than IPB and the difference between IPA and IPB—in this  
order—becomes greater than 6.25% of IPB. However, if the  
FAULTSIGN bit (Bit 6) of the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F)  
is set, the FAULTSIGN flag (Bit 5) in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR  
(MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set as soon as IPA is within 6.25%  
of IPB. This threshold eliminates potential chatter between IPA  
and IPB.  
R
B
C
C
V
F
A
AGND  
I
N
0V  
R
B
F
TEST  
CURRENT  
CT  
R
F
I
PB  
R
A
V
P
C
R
F
F
V
N
R
C
F
T
V
240V rms  
Figure 49. Fault Conditions for Inactive Input Greater Than Active Input  
di/dt CURRENT SENSOR AND DIGITAL  
INTEGRATOR FOR THE ADE7169/ADE7569  
Calibration Concerns  
A di/dt sensor, a feature available for the AD7169/ADE7569 but  
not for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169, detects  
changes in the magnetic field caused by ac currents. Figure 50  
shows the principle of a di/dt current sensor.  
Typically, when a meter is calibrated, the voltage and current  
circuits are separated, as shown in Figure 49. Current passes  
through only the phase circuit or the neutral circuit. Figure 49  
shows current being passed through the phase circuit. This is  
the preferred option because the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169 start billing on the IPA input on power-up.  
The phase circuit CT is connected to IPA in the diagram.  
Because the current sensors are not perfectly matched, it is  
important to match current inputs. The ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 provide a gain calibration  
register for IPB, IBGAIN (Address 0x1C). IBGAIN is a 12-bit,  
signed, twos complement register that provides a gain  
resolution of 0.0244%/LSB.  
MAGNETIC FIELD CREATED BY CURRENT  
(DIRECTLY PROPORTIONAL TO CURRENT)  
+
EMF (ELECTROMOTIVE FORCE)  
INDUCED BY CHANGES IN  
MAGNETIC FLUX DENSITY (di/dt)  
Figure 50. Principle of a di/dt Current Sensor  
The flux density of a magnetic field induced by a current is  
directly proportional to the magnitude of the current. The  
changes in the magnetic flux density passing through a conductor  
loop generate an electromotive force (EMF) between the two  
ends of the loop. The EMF is a voltage signal that is proportional  
to the di/dt of the current. The voltage output from the di/dt  
current sensor is determined by the mutual inductance between  
the current-carrying conductor and the di/dt sensor. The current  
signal needs to be recovered from the di/dt signal before it can  
be used. An integrator is, therefore, necessary to restore the  
signal to its original form.  
For calibration, a first measurement should be done on IPA by  
setting the SEL_I_CH bits to 0b01 in the CALMODE register  
(Address 0x3D). This measurement should be compared to the  
measurement on IPB. Measuring IPB can be forced by setting the  
SEL_I_CH bits to 0b10 in the CALMODE register (Address 0x3D).  
The gain error between these two measurements can be evaluated  
using the following equation:  
Measurement  
(
I B  
)
Measurement  
I A  
(
I A  
)
(2)  
Error  
(
% =  
)
Measurement  
(
)
The two channels, IPA and IPB, can then be matched by writing  
−Error(%)/(1 + Error (%)) × 212 to the IBGAIN register  
(Address 0x1C). This matching adjustment is valid for all  
energy measurements made by the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169, including active power, reactive power  
(ADE7169 only), apparent power, and Irms  
.
Rev. B | Page 55 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
–1.0  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 have a built-in digital integrator to  
–1.5  
recover the current signal from the di/dt sensor. The digital  
integrator on the current channel is switched off by default when  
–2.0  
the ADE7169/ADE7569 are powered up. Setting the INTE bit  
–2.5  
(Bit 5) in the MODE1 register (Address 0x0B) turns on the  
–3.0  
integrator. Figure 51 to Figure 54 show the gain and phase  
response of the digital integrator.  
–3.5  
–4.0  
10  
–4.5  
0
–5.0  
–5.5  
–10  
–6.0  
40  
45  
50  
55  
60  
65  
70  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
–20  
–30  
Figure 53. Combined Gain Response of the Digital Integrator and  
Phase Compensator (40 Hz to 70 Hz)  
–89.70  
–89.75  
–89.80  
–89.85  
–89.90  
–89.95  
–90.00  
–40  
–50  
100  
1000  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
Figure 51. Combined Gain Response of the Digital Integrator and  
Phase Compensator  
–88.0  
–88.5  
–89.0  
–90.05  
40  
45  
50  
55  
60  
65  
70  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
Figure 54. Combined Phase Response of the Digital Integrator and  
Phase Compensator (40 Hz to 70 Hz)  
–89.5  
–90.0  
–90.5  
Note that the integrator has a −20 dB/dec attenuation and an  
approximately −90° phase shift. When combined with a di/dt  
sensor, the resulting magnitude and phase response should be a  
flat gain over the frequency band of interest. The di/dt sensor  
has a 20 dB/dec gain associated with it. It also generates  
significant high frequency noise. Therefore, a more effective  
antialiasing filter is needed to avoid noise due to aliasing (see  
the Antialiasing Filter section).  
2
3
10  
10  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
Figure 52. Combined Phase Response of the Digital Integrator and  
Phase Compensator  
When the digital integrator is switched off, the ADE7169/ADE7569  
can be used directly with a conventional current sensor, such as a  
current transformer (CT), or with a low resistance current  
shunt.  
Rev. B | Page 56 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
crossing is detected on the voltage channel. The default power-on  
value in this register is 0xFFF. If the internal register decrements  
to 0 before a zero crossing is detected in the Interrupt Status 3  
SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE), and the ZXTO bit (Bit 1) in  
the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB) is set,  
the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt.  
POWER QUALITY MEASUREMENTS  
Zero-Crossing Detection  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has a zero-crossing detection circuit on the voltage  
channel. This zero crossing is used to produce a zero-crossing  
internal signal (ZX) and is used in calibration mode.  
The ADE interrupt stays active until the ZXTO status bit is  
cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section). The  
ZXTOUT register (Address 0x11) can be written to or read by  
the user (see the Energy Measurement Register List section).  
The resolution of the register is 160/MCLK seconds per LSB.  
Thus, the maximum delay for an interrupt is 0.16 seconds  
(1/MCLK × 212) when MCLK = 4.096 MHz.  
The zero crossing is generated by default from the output of  
LPF1. This filter has a low cutoff frequency and is intended for  
50 Hz and 60 Hz systems. If needed, this filter can be disabled  
to allow a higher frequency signal to be detected or to limit the  
group delay of the detection. If the voltage input fundamental  
frequency is below 60 Hz, and a time delay in ZX detection is  
acceptable, it is recommended that LPF1 be enabled. Enabling  
LPF1 limits the variability in the ZX detection by eliminating  
the high frequency components. Figure 55 shows how the zero-  
crossing signal is generated.  
Figure 56 shows the mechanism of the zero-crossing timeout  
detection when the line voltage stays at a fixed dc level for more  
than MCLK/160 × ZXTOUT seconds.  
12-BIT INTERNAL  
REGISTER VALUE  
ZXTOUT  
×1, ×2, ×4,  
REFERENCE  
×8, ×16  
V
{GAIN [7:5]}  
PGA2  
P
N
HPF  
ADC 2  
V
ZERO  
CROSSING  
ZX  
VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL  
LPF1  
f–3dB = 63.7Hz  
MODE 1[6]  
ZXTO  
FLAG  
BIT  
43.24° @ 60Hz  
1.0  
0.73  
ZX  
Figure 56. Zero-Crossing Timeout Detection  
Period or Frequency Measurements  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide the period or frequency measurement of the  
line. The period or frequency measurement is selected by clearing  
or setting the FREQSEL bit (Bit 1) in the MODE2 register  
(Address 0x0C). The period/frequency register, PER_FREQ  
(Address 0x0A), is an unsigned 16-bit register that is updated  
every period. If LPF1 is enabled, a settling time of 1.8 sec is  
associated with this filter before the measurement is stable.  
LPF1  
V2  
Figure 55. Zero-Crossing Detection on the Voltage Channel  
The zero-crossing signal, ZX, is generated from the output of  
LPF1 (bypassed or not). LPF1 has a single pole at 63.7 Hz (at  
MCLK = 4.096 MHz). As a result, there is a phase lag between  
the analog input signal V2 and the output of LPF1. The phase  
lag response of LPF1 results in a time delay of approximately  
2 ms (@ 60 Hz) between the zero crossing on the analog inputs  
of the voltage channel and ZX detection.  
When the period measurement is selected, the measurement has a  
2.44 μs/LSB (4.096 MHz/10) resolution, which represents 0.014%  
when the line frequency is 60 Hz. When the line frequency is  
60 Hz, the value of the period register is approximately 0d6827.  
The length of the register enables the measurement of line  
frequencies as low as 12.5 Hz. The period register is stable at  
1 LSB when the line is established, and the measurement does  
not change.  
The zero-crossing detection also drives the ZX flag in the  
Interrupt Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE). If the ZX  
bit in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB)  
is set, the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. The ADE  
interrupt stays active until the ZX status bit is cleared (see the  
Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
Zero-Crossing Timeout  
When the frequency measurement is selected, the measurement  
has a 0.0625 Hz/LSB resolution when MCLK = 4.096 MHz,  
which represents 0.104% when the line frequency is 60 Hz.  
When the line frequency is 60 Hz, the value of the frequency  
register is 0d960. The frequency register is stable at 4 LSB when  
the line is established, and the measurement does not change.  
The zero-crossing detection also has an associated timeout  
register, ZXTOUT (Address 0x11). This unsigned, 12-bit register is  
decremented (1 LSB) every 160/MCLK seconds. The register is  
reset to its user programmed, full-scale value every time a zero  
Rev. B | Page 57 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
V
2
Line Voltage SAG Detection  
VPKLVL[15:0]  
In addition to detection of the loss of the line voltage signal  
(zero crossing), the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 can also be programmed to detect when  
the absolute value of the line voltage drops below a certain peak  
value for a number of line cycles. This condition is illustrated in  
Figure 57.  
PKV RESET  
LOW WHEN  
MIRQSTH SFR  
IS READ  
VOLTAGE CHANNEL  
FULL SCALE  
PKV INTERRUPT  
FLAG  
SAGLVL [15:0]  
RESET BIT PKV  
IN MIRQSTH SFR  
Figure 58. Peak Level Detection  
SAG RESET LOW  
WHEN VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL EXCEEDS  
Figure 58 shows a line voltage exceeding a threshold that is set  
in the voltage peak register (VPKLVL, Address 0x16). The voltage  
peak event is recorded by setting the PKV flag in the Interrupt  
Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE). If the PKV enable bit  
(Bit 3) is set in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address  
0xDB), the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. Similarly,  
the current peak event is recorded by setting the PKI flag (Bit 4)  
in the Interrupt Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE). The  
ADE interrupt stays active until the PKV or PKI status bit is  
cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
SAGLVL [15:0] AND  
SAGCYC [7:0] = 0x04  
SAG FLAG RESET  
3 LINE CYCLES  
SAG FLAG  
Figure 57. SAG Detection  
Figure 57 shows the line voltage falling below a threshold that is  
set in the SAG level register (SAGLVL[15:0], Address 0x14) for  
three line cycles. The quantities 0 and 1 are not valid for the  
SAGCYC register, and the contents represent one more than the  
desired number of full line cycles. For example, when the SAG  
cycle (SAGCYC[7:0], Address 0x13) contains 0x04, FSAG (Bit 5) in  
the power management interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8)  
is set at the end of the third line cycle after the line voltage falls  
below the threshold. If the SAG enable bit (ESAG, Bit 5) in the  
power management interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC)  
is set, the 8052 core has a pending power supply management  
interrupt. The PSM interrupt stays active until the ESAG bit is  
cleared (see the Power Supply Management (PSM) Interrupt  
section).  
Peak Level Set  
The contents of the VPKLVL (Address 0x16) and IPKLVL  
(Address 0x15) registers are compared to the absolute value of the  
voltage and 2 MSBs of the current channel, respectively. Thus, for  
example, the nominal maximum code from the current channel  
ADC with a full-scale signal is 0x28F5C2 (see the Current  
Channel ADC section). Therefore, writing 0x28F5 to the IPKLVL  
register puts the current channel peak detection level at full  
scale and sets the current peak detection to its least sensitive  
value. Writing 0x00 puts the current channel detection level at 0.  
The detection is done by comparing the contents of the IPKLVL  
register to the incoming current channel sample. The PKI flag  
indicates that the peak level is exceeded. If the PKI or PKV bit is set  
in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB), the  
8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt.  
In Figure 57, the SAG flag (FSAG) is set on the fifth line cycle  
after the signal on the voltage channel first dropped below the  
threshold level.  
SAG Level Set  
The 2-byte contents of the SAG level register (SAGLVL, Address  
0x14) are compared to the absolute value of the output from LPF1.  
Peak Level Record  
Therefore, when LPF1 is enabled, writing 0x2038 to the SAG  
level register puts the SAG detection level at full scale (see  
Figure 57). Writing 0x00 or 0x01 puts the SAG detection level at  
0. The SAG level register is compared to the input of the ZX  
detection, and detection is made when the ZX input falls below  
the contents of the SAG level register.  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 records the maximum absolute value reached by the  
current and voltage channels in two different registers, IPEAK  
(Address 0x17) and VPEAK (Address 0x19), respectively. Each  
register is a 24-bit unsigned register that is updated each time the  
absolute value of the waveform sample from the corresponding  
channel is above the value stored in the IPEAK or VPEAK  
register. The contents of the VPEAK register correspond to the  
maximum absolute value observed on the voltage channel input.  
The contents of IPEAK and VPEAK represent the maximum  
absolute value observed on the current and voltage input,  
respectively. Reading the RSTIPEAK (Address 0x18) and  
RSTVPEAK (Address 0x1A) registers clears their respective  
contents after the read operation.  
Peak Detection  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can also be programmed to detect when the absolute  
value of the voltage or current channel exceeds a specified peak  
value. Figure 58 illustrates the behavior of the peak detection  
for the voltage channel. Both voltage and current channels are  
monitored at the same time.  
Rev. B | Page 58 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PHASE COMPENSATION  
RMS CALCULATION  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 must work with transducers that can have inherent  
phase errors. For example, a phase error of 0.1° to 0.3° is not  
uncommon for a current transformer (CT). These phase errors  
can vary from part to part, and they must be corrected to perform  
accurate power calculations. The errors associated with phase  
mismatch are particularly noticeable at low power factors. The  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
provide a means of digitally calibrating these small phase errors.  
The part allows a small time delay or time advance to be intro-  
duced into the signal processing chain to compensate for small  
phase errors. Because the compensation is in time, this technique  
should be used only for small phase errors in the range of 0.1°  
to 0.5°. Correcting large phase errors using a time shift technique  
can introduce significant phase errors at higher harmonics.  
The root mean square (rms) value of a continuous signal V(t) is  
defined as  
T
1
Vrms  
=
× V 2 (t)dt  
(3)  
T
0
For time sampling signals, rms calculation involves squaring the  
signal, taking the average, and obtaining the square root. The  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
implement this method by serially squaring the inputs, averaging  
them, and then taking the square root of the average. The averaging  
part of this signal processing is done by implementing a low-pass  
filter (LPF3 in Figure 60, Figure 62, and Figure 63). This LPF  
has a −3 dB cutoff frequency of 2 Hz when MCLK = 4.096 MHz.  
V
(
t
)
=
2 ×V sin(ωt)  
where V is the rms voltage.  
V 2 (t) =V 2 V 2 cos  
2ωt  
(4)  
The phase calibration register (PHCAL[7:0], Address 0x10) is a  
twos complement, signed, single-byte register that has values  
ranging from 0x82 (−126d) to 0x68 (+104d).  
(
)
(5)  
The PHCAL register is centered at 0x40, meaning that writing  
0x40 to the register gives 0 delay. By changing this register, the  
time delay in the voltage channel signal path can change from  
−231.93 μs to +48.83 μs (MCLK = 4.096 MHz). One LSB is  
equivalent to a 1.22 μs (4.096 MHz/5) time delay or advance.  
A line frequency of 60 Hz gives a phase resolution of 0.026° at  
the fundamental (that is, 360° × 1.22 μs × 60 Hz).  
When this signal goes through LPF3, the cos(2ωt) term is attenu-  
ated and only the dc term, Vrms2 (shown as V2 in Figure 60) goes  
through.  
2
2
2
V
(t) = V V cos(2ωt)  
V(t) = 2 × V sin(ωt)  
LPF3  
INPUT  
V
Figure 59 illustrates how the phase compensation is used to  
remove a 0.1° phase lead in the current channel due to the  
external transducer. To cancel the lead (0.1°) in the current  
channel, a phase lead must also be introduced into the voltage  
channel. The resolution of the phase adjustment allows the  
introduction of a phase lead in increments of 0.026°. The phase  
lead is achieved by introducing a time advance into the voltage  
channel. A time advance of 4.88 μs is made by writing −4 (0x3C)  
to the time delay block, thus reducing the amount of time delay  
by 4.88 μs or, equivalently, a phase lead of approximately 0.1° at a  
line frequency of 60 Hz (0x3C represents −4 because the register is  
centered with 0 at 0x40).  
2
2
(t) = V  
V
Figure 60. RMS Signal Processing  
The Irms signal can be read from the waveform register by setting  
the WAVMODE register (Address 0x0D) and setting the WFSM  
bit (Bit 5) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address  
0xDB). Like the current and voltage channel waveform sampling  
modes, the waveform data is available at sample rates of  
25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS, 6.4 kSPS, and 3.2 kSPS.  
It is important to note that when the current input is larger than  
40% of full scale, the Irms waveform sample register does not  
represent the true processed rms value. The rms value processed  
with this level of input is larger than the 24-bit read by the wave-  
form register, making the value read truncated on the high end.  
I
HPF  
PA  
24  
PGA1  
ADC 1  
I
I
N
LPF2  
24  
V
P
Current Channel RMS Calculation  
CHANNEL 2 DELAY  
REDUCED BY 4.88µs  
(0.1°LEAD AT 60Hz)  
0x0B IN PHCAL[7:0]  
1
DELAY BLOCK  
1.22µs/LSB  
PGA2  
V
V
ADC 2  
0.1°  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 simultaneously calculates the rms values for the current  
and voltage channels in different registers. Figure 61 and Figure 62  
show the details of the signal processing chain for the rms  
calculation on the current channel. The current channel rms  
value is processed from the samples used in the current channel  
waveform sampling mode and is stored in an unsigned 24-bit  
register (Irms). One LSB of the current channel rms register is  
equivalent to 1 LSB of a current channel waveform sample.  
V
N
7
1
0
V
I
0
0 1 0 1 1 1  
PHCAL[7:0]  
–231.93µs TO +48.83µs  
I
60Hz  
60Hz  
Figure 59. Phase Calibration  
Rev. B | Page 59 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The update rate of the current channel rms measurement is  
4.096 MHz/5. To minimize noise in the reading of the register,  
the Irms register can also be configured to update only with the  
zero crossing of the voltage input. This configuration is done by  
setting the ZXRMS bit (Bit 2) in the MODE2 register (Address  
0x0C).  
Current Channel RMS Offset Compensation  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 incorporate a current channel rms offset compensa-  
tion register (IRMSOS). This is a 12-bit signed register that can  
be used to remove offset in the current channel rms calculation.  
An offset can exist in the rms calculation due to input noises  
that are integrated into the dc component of V2(t).  
With the different specified full-scale analog input signal PGA1  
values, the ADC produces an output code that is approximately  
0d2,147,483 (PGA1 = 1) or 0d2,684,354 (PGA1 = 2, 4, 8, or 16);  
see the Current Channel ADC section. Similarly, the equivalent  
rms value of a full-scale ac signal is 0d1,518,499 (0x172BA3) when  
PGA = 1 and 0d1,898,124 (0x1CF68C) when PGA1 = 2, 4, 8, or 16.  
One LSB of the current channel rms offset is equivalent to  
16,384 LSBs of the square of the current channel rms register.  
Assuming that the maximum value from the current channel  
rms calculation is 0d1,898,124 with full-scale ac inputs, then  
1 LSB of the current channel rms offset represents 0.23% of  
measurement error at −60 dB down from full scale.  
The current rms measurement provided in the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 is accurate  
to within 0.5% for signal inputs between full scale and full  
scale/500. The conversion from the register value to amps must  
be done externally in the microprocessor using an amps/LSB  
constant.  
2
(6)  
Irms  
=
Irms + IRMSOS ×32,768  
0
where Irms0 is the rms measurement without offset correction.  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
60Hz  
DATA RANGE WITH  
INTEGRATOR ON (60Hz)  
0x2B7850  
0x000000  
0xD487B0  
IRMSOS[11:0]  
I
(t)  
rms  
MODE1[5]  
25 26 27  
18 17 16  
2 2  
sgn 2  
LPF3  
2
2
2
HPF  
I
0x00  
DIGITAL  
INTEGRATOR*  
P
HPF1  
24  
+
24  
I
[23:0]  
rms  
dt  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE WITH  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
0x28F5C2  
0x000000  
0xD70A3E  
*NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7566.  
Figure 61. ADE7566/ADE7569 Current Channel RMS Signal Processing with PGA1 = 1, 2, 4, 8, or 16  
Rev. B | Page 60 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
60Hz  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE WITH  
INTEGRATOR ON (60Hz)  
0x2B7850  
0x000000  
0xD487B0  
IRMSOS[11:0]  
I
(t)  
rms  
MODE1[5]  
25 26 27  
18 17 16  
2 2  
sgn 2  
LPF3  
2
2
2
HPF  
HPF  
I
0x00  
DIGITAL  
PA  
INTEGRATOR*  
HPF1  
+
24  
24  
I
[23:0]  
rms  
dt  
I
PB  
CURRENT CHANNEL  
WAVEFORM  
DATA RANGE WITH  
INTEGRATOR OFF  
IBGAIN  
0x28F5C2  
0x000000  
0xD70A3E  
*NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7116, ADE7156, OR ADE7166.  
Figure 62. ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169 Current Channel RMS Signal Processing with PGA1 = 2, 4, 8, or 16  
VOLTAGE SIGNAL (V(t))  
VRMSOS[11:0]  
0x28F5  
0x0  
16 15  
8
7
6
2
sgn 2  
2
2
2
V
(t)  
rmsx  
0xD70B  
0x28F5C2  
0x00  
LPF3  
LPF1  
+
+
|
|
X
VOLTAGE CHANNEL  
V
[23:0]  
rmsx  
Figure 63. Voltage Channel RMS Signal Processing  
Rev. B | Page 61 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Voltage Channel RMS Calculation  
The unit of power is the watt or joules/second. Equation 8 gives an  
expression for the instantaneous power signal in an ac system.  
Figure 63 shows details of the signal processing chain for the rms  
calculation on the voltage channel. This voltage rms estimation is  
done in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 using the mean absolute value calculation,  
as shown in Figure 63. The voltage channel rms value is processed  
from the samples used in the voltage channel waveform sampling  
mode and is stored in the unsigned 24-bit Vrms register.  
v
(
t
)
=
2 ×V sin(ωt)  
(8)  
(9)  
( )  
i t = 2 × I sin(ωt)  
where:  
v is the rms voltage.  
i is the rms current.  
The update rate of the voltage channel rms measurement is  
MCLK/5. To minimize noise in the reading of the register, the  
p(t) = v(t)× i(t)  
V
rms register can also be configured to update only with the zero  
p(t) = VI VI cos(2ωt)  
(10)  
crossing of the voltage input. This configuration is done by setting  
the ZXRMS bit (Bit 2) in the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C).  
The average power over an integral number of line cycles (n) is  
given by the expression in Equation 11.  
With the specified full-scale ac analog input signal of 0.4 V, the  
output from LPF1 in Figure 63 swings between 0x28F5 and  
0xD70B at 60 Hz (see the Voltage Channel ADC section). The  
equivalent rms value of this full-scale ac signal is approximately  
0d1,898,124 (0x1CF68C) in the Vrms register. The voltage rms  
measurement provided in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 is accurate to within 0.5% for  
signal input between full scale and full scale/20. The conversion  
from the register value to volts must be done externally in the  
microprocessor using a V/LSB constant.  
1
nT  
P =  
nT p(t)dt = VI  
(11)  
0
where:  
T is the line cycle period.  
P is referred to as the active or real power.  
Note that the active power is equal to the dc component of the  
instantaneous power signal p(t) in Equation 11, that is, VI. This  
is the relationship used to calculate active power in the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569. The instan-  
taneous power signal p(t) is generated by multiplying the current  
and voltage signals. The dc component of the instantaneous power  
signal is then extracted by LPF2 (low-pass filter) to obtain the  
active power information. This process is illustrated in Figure 64.  
INSTANTANEOUS  
Voltage Channel RMS Offset Compensation  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 incorporate a voltage channel rms offset compensation  
register (VRMSOS). This is a 12-bit signed register that can be  
used to remove offset in the voltage channel rms calculation. An  
offset can exist in the rms calculation due to input noises and dc  
offset in the input samples. One LSB of the voltage channel rms  
offset is equivalent to 64 LSBs of the rms register. Assuming that  
the maximum value from the voltage channel rms calculation is  
0d1,898,124 with full-scale ac inputs, then 1 LSB of the voltage  
channel rms offset represents 3.37% of measurement error at  
−60 dB down from full scale.  
p(t) = v × i – v × i × cos(2ωt)  
POWER SIGNAL  
0x19999A  
ACTIVE REAL POWER  
SIGNAL = v × i  
VI  
0xCCCCD  
V
rms = Vrms0 + 64 × VRMSOS  
(7)  
0x00000  
where Vrms0 is the rms measurement without offset correction.  
CURRENT  
i(t) = 2 × i × sin(ωt)  
ACTIVE POWER CALCULATION  
VOLTAGE  
v(t) = 2 × v × sin(ωt)  
Active power is defined as the rate of energy flow from source  
to load. It is the product of the voltage and current waveforms.  
The resulting waveform is called the instantaneous power signal  
and is equal to the rate of energy flow at every instant of time.  
Figure 64. Active Power Calculation  
Because LPF2 does not have an ideal brick wall frequency  
response (see Figure 65), the active power signal has some  
ripple due to the instantaneous power signal. This ripple is  
sinusoidal and has a frequency equal to twice the line frequency.  
Because of its sinusoidal nature, the ripple is removed when the  
active power signal is integrated to calculate energy (see the  
Active Energy Calculation section).  
Rev. B | Page 62 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
0
–4  
–8  
register. Assuming the average value, output from LPF2 is  
0xCCCCD (838,861d) when inputs on the voltage and current  
channels are both at full scale. At −60 dB down on the current  
channel (1/1000 of the current channel full-scale input), the  
average word value output from LPF2 is 838.861 (838,861/1000).  
One LSB in the LPF2 output has a measurement error of  
1/838.861 × 100% = 0.119% of the average value. The active  
power offset register has a resolution equal to 1/256 LSB of the  
waveform register. Therefore, the power offset correction  
resolution is 0.000464%/LSB (0.119%/256) at −60 dB.  
–12  
–16  
–20  
Active Power Sign Detection  
–24  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
1
3
10  
30  
100  
ADE7569 detect a change of sign in the active power. The  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
APSIGN flag (Bit 3) in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL,  
Figure 65. Frequency Response of LPF2  
Address 0xDC) records when a change of sign has occurred  
according to the APSIGN bit (Bit 4) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). If the APSIGN flag (Bit 3) is set in the Interrupt  
Enable 1 SFR (MIRQENL, Address 0xD9), the 8052 core has a  
pending ADE interrupt. The ADE interrupt stays active until  
the APSIGN status bit is cleared (see the Energy Measurement  
Interrupts section).  
Active Power Gain Calibration  
Figure 66 shows the signal processing chain for the active power  
calculation in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569. The active power is calculated by filtering  
the output of the multiplier with a low-pass filter. Note that,  
when reading the waveform samples from the output of LPF2,  
the gain of the active energy can be adjusted by using the multi-  
plier and watt gain register (WGAIN[11:0], Address 0x1D). The  
gain is adjusted by writing a twos complement 12-bit word to  
the watt gain register. Equation 12 shows how the gain  
When APSIGN (Bit 4) in the ACCMODE register (Address  
0x0F) is cleared (default), the APSIGN flag (Bit 3) in the  
Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set when a  
transition from positive to negative active power occurs.  
adjustment is related to the contents of the watt gain register.  
When the APSIGN bit (Bit 4) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F) is set, the APSIGN flag (Bit 3) in the MIRQSTL  
SFR (Address 0xDC) is set when a transition from negative to  
positive active power occurs.  
WGAIN  
212  
Output WGAIN = Active Power × 1+  
(12)  
For example, when 0x7FF is written to the watt gain register, the  
power output is scaled up by 50% (0x7FF = 2047d, 2047/212 = 0.5).  
Similarly, 0x800 = −2048d (signed, twos complement) and  
power output is scaled by −50%. Each LSB scales the power  
output by 0.0244%. The minimum output range is given when  
the watt gain register contents are equal to 0x800, and the  
maximum range is given by writing 0x7FF to the watt gain  
register. This can be used to calibrate the active power (or  
energy) calculation in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
Active Power No Load Detection  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 include a no load threshold feature on the active  
energy that eliminates any creep effects in the meter. The part  
accomplishes this by not accumulating energy if the multiplier  
output is below the no load threshold. When the active power is  
below the no load threshold, the APNOLOAD flag (Bit 0) in the  
Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set. If the  
APNOLOAD bit (Bit 0) is set in the Interrupt Enable 1 SFR  
(MIRQENL, Address 0xD9), the 8052 core has a pending ADE  
interrupt. The ADE interrupt stays active until the APNOLOAD  
status bit is cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts  
section).  
Active Power Offset Calibration  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 also incorporate an active power offset register  
(WATTOS[15:0], Address 0x20). It is a signed, twos complement,  
16-bit register that can be used to remove offsets in the active  
power calculation (see Figure 64). An offset can exist in the  
power calculation due to crosstalk between channels on the  
PCB or in the IC itself. The offset calibration allows the contents  
of the active power register to be maintained at 0 when no power  
is being consumed.  
The no load threshold level is selectable by setting the  
APNOLOAD bits (Bits[1:0]) in the NLMODE register (Address  
0x0E). Setting these bits to 0b00 disables the no load detection,  
and setting them to 0b01, 0b10, or 0b11 sets the no load  
detection threshold to 0.015%, 0.0075%, or 0.0037% of the  
multipliers full-scale output frequency, respectively. The IEC  
62053-21 specification states that the meter must start up with a  
load of ≤0.4% IPB, which translates to 0.0167% of the full-scale  
output frequency of the multiplier.  
The 256 LSBs (WATTOS = 0x0100) written to the active power  
offset register are equivalent to 1 LSB in the waveform sample  
Rev. B | Page 63 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
power signal in the waveform register is continuously added to  
the internal active energy register.  
ACTIVE ENERGY CALCULATION  
As stated in the Active Power Calculation section, power is  
defined as the rate of energy flow. This relationship can be  
expressed mathematically, as shown in Equation 13.  
The active energy accumulation depends on the setting of  
POAM (Bit 1) and ABSAM (Bit 0) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). When both bits are cleared, the addition is  
signed and, therefore, negative energy is subtracted from the  
active energy contents. When both bits are set, the ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 are set to be in the more  
restrictive mode, the positive-only accumulation mode.  
dE  
P =  
(13)  
dt  
where:  
P is power.  
E is energy.  
When POAM (Bit 1) in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F)  
is set, only positive power contributes to the active energy  
accumulation. When ABSAM (Bit 0) in the ACCMODE  
register (Address 0x0F) is set, the absolute active power is used  
for the active energy accumulation (see the Watt-Absolute  
Accumulation Mode section).  
Conversely, energy is given as the integral of power.  
E = P(t)dt  
(14)  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 achieve the integration of the active power signal by  
continuously accumulating the active power signal in an  
internal, nonreadable, 49-bit energy register. The register  
(WATTHR[23:0], Address 0x01) represents the upper 24 bits  
of this internal register. This discrete time accumulation or  
summation is equivalent to integration in continuous time.  
Equation 15 expresses the relationship.  
The output of the multiplier is divided by the value in the WDIV  
register (Address 0x24). If the value in the WDIV register is  
equal to 0, the internal active energy register is divided by 1.  
WDIV is an 8-bit, unsigned register. After dividing by WDIV,  
the active energy is accumulated in a 49-bit internal energy  
accumulation register. The upper 24 bits of this register are  
accessible through a read to the active energy register  
(WATTHR[23:0], Address 0x01). A read to the RWATTHR  
register (Address 0x02) returns the contents of the WATTHR  
register, and the upper 24 bits of the internal register are cleared.  
As shown in Figure 66, the active power signal is accumulated  
in an internal 49-bit signed register. The active power signal can  
be read from the waveform register by setting the WAVMODE  
register (Address 0x0D) and setting the WFSM bit (Bit 5) in the  
Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB). Like the  
current and voltage channels waveform sampling modes, the  
waveform data is available at sample rates of 25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS,  
6.4 kSPS, and 3.2 kSPS.  
(15)  
E = p(t)dt = lim  
p(nT)×T  
t0 ∑  
n=1  
where:  
n is the discrete time sample number.  
T is the sample period.  
The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation  
register in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 is 1.22 μs (5/MCLK). In addition to  
calculating the energy, this integration removes any sinusoidal  
components that may be in the active power signal. Figure 66  
shows this discrete time integration or accumulation. The active  
UPPER 24 BITS ARE  
ACCESSIBLE THROUGH  
WATTHR[23:0] REGISTER  
FOR WAVEFORM  
SAMPLING  
WATTHR[23:0]  
23  
0
WATTOS[15:0]  
–6 –7 –8  
6
5
sgn  
2
2
2
2
2
WDIV[7:0]  
CURRENT  
CHANNEL  
LPF2  
48  
0
+
+
+
%
+
VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL  
WGAIN[11:0]  
OUTPUTS FROM THE LPF2 ARE  
ACCUMULATED (INTEGRATED) IN  
ACTIVE POWER  
SIGNAL  
THE INTERNAL ACTIVE ENERGY REGISTER  
TO  
DIGITAL-TO-FREQUENCY  
CONVERTER  
5
T
CLKIN  
WAVEFORM  
REGISTER  
VALUES  
TIME (nT)  
Figure 66. Active Energy Calculation  
Rev. B | Page 64 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
When WDIV is set to a value other than 0, the integration time  
varies, as shown in Equation 17.  
Figure 67 shows this energy accumulation for full-scale signals  
(sinusoidal) on the analog inputs. The three displayed curves  
illustrate the minimum period of time it takes the energy register  
to roll over when the active power gain register contents are  
0x7FF, 0x000, and 0x800. The watt gain register is used to carry  
out power calibration in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569. As shown, the fastest  
integration time occurs when the watt gain register is set to  
maximum full scale, that is, 0x7FF.  
Time = TimeWDIV = 0 × WDIV  
(17)  
Active Energy Accumulation Modes  
Watt-Signed Accumulation Mode  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 active energy default accumulation mode is a watt-  
signed accumulation based on the active power information.  
WATTHR[23:0]  
Watt Positive-Only Accumulation Mode  
0x7F,FFFF  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 are placed in watt positive-only accumulation mode  
by setting the POAM bit (Bit 1) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). In this mode, the energy accumulation is done  
only for positive power, ignoring any occurrence of negative  
power above or below the no load threshold (see Figure 68).  
The CF pulse also reflects this accumulation method when in  
this mode. The default setting for this mode is off. Detection of  
the transitions in the direction of power flow and detection of  
no load threshold are active in this mode.  
WGAIN = 0x7FF  
WGAIN = 0x000  
WGAIN = 0x800  
0x3F,FFFF  
0x00,0000  
0x40,0000  
TIME (Minutes)  
13.7  
3.41  
6.82  
10.2  
0x80,0000  
Figure 67. Energy Register Rollover Time for Full-Scale Power  
(Minimum and Maximum Power Gain)  
Note that the energy register contents roll over to full-scale  
negative (0x800000) and continue to increase in value when the  
power or energy flow is positive (see Figure 67). Conversely, if  
the power is negative, the energy register underflows to full-  
scale positive (0x7FFFFF) and continues to decrease in value.  
ACTIVE ENERGY  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
Using the interrupt enable register (MIRQENM, Address 0xDA),  
the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can be configured to issue an ADE interrupt to the  
8052 core when the active energy register is half full (positive  
or negative) or when an overflow or underflow occurs.  
ACTIVE POWER  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
APSIGN FLAG  
Integration Time Under Steady Load: Active Energy  
POS NEG POS  
INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTERS  
As mentioned in the Active Energy Calculation section, the  
discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is  
1.22 μs (5/MCLK). With full-scale sinusoidal signals on the  
analog inputs and the WGAIN register (Address 0x1D) set to  
0x000, the average word value from each LPF2 is 0xCCCCD  
(see Figure 64). The maximum positive value that can be stored  
in the internal 49-bit register is 248 (or 0xFFFF,FFFF,FFFF)  
before it overflows. The integration time under these conditions  
when WDIV = 0 is calculated in the following equation:  
Figure 68. Energy Accumulation in Positive-Only Accumulation Mode  
Watt-Absolute Accumulation Mode  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 are placed in watt-absolute accumulation mode by  
setting the ABSAM bit (Bit 0) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). In this mode, the energy accumulation is done  
using the absolute active power, ignoring any occurrence of  
power below the no load threshold (see Figure 69). The CF  
pulse also reflects this accumulation method when in this  
mode. The default setting for this mode is off. Detection of the  
transitions in the direction of power flow, and detection of no  
load threshold are active in this mode.  
Time =  
0 xFFFF, FFFF, FFFF  
×1.22μs = 409.6sec = 6.82 min (16)  
0 xCCCCD  
Rev. B | Page 65 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ADE7566/ADE7569 can be synchronized to the voltage channel  
zero crossing so that active energy can be accumulated over an  
integral number of half-line cycles. The advantage of summing  
the active energy over an integer number of line cycles is that the  
sinusoidal component in the active energy is reduced to 0. This  
eliminates any ripple in the energy calculation. Energy is  
ACTIVE ENERGY  
calculated more accurately and more quickly because the  
integration period can be shortened. By using this mode, the  
energy calibration can be greatly simplified, and the time  
required to calibrate the meter can be significantly reduced.  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
In the line cycle active energy accumulation mode, the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
accumulate the active power signal in the LWATTHR register  
(Address 0x03) for an integral number of line cycles, as shown in  
Figure 70. The number of half-line cycles is specified in the  
LINCYC register.  
ACTIVE POWER  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
APSIGN FLAG  
APNOLOAD  
POS  
NEG POS  
APNOLOAD  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can accumulate active power for up to 65,535 half-  
line cycles. Because the active power is integrated on an integral  
number of line cycles, the CYCEND flag (Bit 2) in the Interrupt  
Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE) is set at the end of an  
active energy accumulation line cycle. If the CYCEND enable  
bit (Bit 2) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address  
0xDB) is set, the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. The  
ADE interrupt stays active until the CYCEND status bit is  
cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
Another calibration cycle starts as soon as the CYCEND flag is  
set. If the LWATTHR register (Address 0x03) is not read before a  
new CYCEND flag is set, the LWATTHR register is overwritten  
by a new value.  
INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTERS  
Figure 69. Energy Accumulation in Absolute Accumulation Mode  
Active Energy Pulse Output  
All of the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 circuitry has a pulse output whose frequency is  
proportional to active power (see the Active Power Calculation  
section). This pulse frequency output uses the calibrated signal  
from the WGAIN register (Address 0x1D) output, and its  
behavior is consistent with the setting of the active energy  
accumulation mode in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F).  
The pulse output is active low and should preferably be  
connected to an LED, as shown in Figure 80.  
Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode  
In line cycle active energy accumulation mode, the energy accumu-  
lation of the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
TO  
DIGITAL-TO-FREQUENCY  
CONVERTER  
WGAIN[11:0]  
48  
0
+
OUTPUT  
FROM  
LPF2  
+
%
WATTOS[15:0]  
WDIV[7:0]  
ACTIVE ENERGY  
IS ACCUMULATED IN  
THE INTERNAL REGISTER,  
AND THE LWATTHR  
REGISTER IS UPDATED  
AT THE END OF THE LINCYC  
HALF-LINE CYCLES  
23  
0
LPF1  
LWATTHR[23:0]  
FROM VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL  
ADC  
ZERO-CROSSING  
DETECTION  
CALIBRATION  
CONTROL  
LINCYC[15:0]  
Figure 70. Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation  
Rev. B | Page 66 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
v(t) = 2 V sin(ωt +θ)  
i(t) = 2 I sin(ωt)  
(21)  
When a new half-line cycle is written in the LINCYC register  
(Address 0x12), the LWATTHR register (Address 0x03) is reset,  
and a new accumulation starts at the next zero crossing. The  
number of half-line cycles is then counted until LINCYC is  
reached. This implementation provides a valid measurement at  
the first CYCEND interrupt after writing to the LINCYC  
register (see Figure 71). The line active energy accumulation  
uses the same signal path as the active energy accumulation.  
The LSB size of these two registers is equivalent.  
π
2
i (t) = 2 I sin ωt +  
(22)  
where:  
θ is the phase difference between the voltage and current channel.  
v is the rms voltage.  
i is the rms current.  
q(t) = v(t) × i’(t)  
(23)  
LWATTHR REGISTER  
CYCEND IRQ  
q(t) = VI sin (θ) + VI sin (2ωt + θ)  
The average reactive power over an integral number of lines (n)  
is given in Equation 24.  
nT  
1
nT  
Q =  
q(t)dt = VI sin(θ)  
(24)  
LINCYC  
VALUE  
0
where:  
Figure 71. Energy Accumulation When LINCYC Changes  
T is the line cycle period.  
q is referred to as the reactive power.  
Using the information from Equation 10 and Equation 11,  
Note that the reactive power is equal to the dc component of  
the instantaneous reactive power signal q(t) in Equation 23.  
nT  
nT  
VI  
E
(
t
)
= VIdt −  
cos  
(
2πft  
)
dt  
(18)  
2
The instantaneous reactive power signal q(t) is generated by  
0
0
f
1+  
multiplying the voltage and current channels. In this case, the  
phase of the current channel is shifted by 90°. The dc component of  
the instantaneous reactive power signal is then extracted by a  
low-pass filter to obtain the reactive power information (see  
Figure 72).  
8.9  
where:  
n is an integer.  
T is the line cycle period.  
Because the sinusoidal component is integrated over an integer  
number of line cycles, its value is always 0. Therefore,  
In addition, the phase-shifting filter has a nonunity magnitude  
response. Because the phase-shifted filter has a large attenuation  
at high frequency, the reactive power is primarily for calculation  
at line frequency. The effect of harmonics is largely ignored in  
the reactive power calculation. Note that, because of the mag-  
nitude characteristic of the phase shifting filter, the weight of  
the reactive power is slightly different from the active power  
calculation (see the Energy Register Scaling section).  
nT  
E = VIdt + 0  
(19)  
0
E(t) = VInT  
(20)  
Note that in this mode, the 16-bit LINCYC register can hold a  
maximum value of 65,535. In other words, the line energy  
accumulation mode can be used to accumulate active energy for  
a maximum duration of over 65,535 half-line cycles. At a 60 Hz  
line frequency, it translates to a total duration of 65,535/120 Hz  
= 546 sec.  
The frequency response of the LPF in the reactive signal path is  
identical to the one used for LPF2 in the average active power  
calculation. Because LPF2 does not have an ideal brick wall  
frequency response (see Figure 65), the reactive power signal has  
some ripple due to the instantaneous reactive power signal. This  
ripple is sinusoidal and has a frequency equal to twice the line  
frequency. Because the ripple is sinusoidal in nature, it is removed  
when the reactive power signal is integrated to calculate energy.  
REACTIVE POWER CALCULATION  
(ADE7169/ADE7569)  
Reactive power, a function available for the ADE7169/ADE7569  
only, is defined as the product of the voltage and current wave-  
forms when one of these signals is phase-shifted by 90°. The  
resulting waveform is called the instantaneous reactive power  
signal. Equation 23 gives an expression for the instantaneous  
reactive power signal in an ac system when the phase of the  
current channel is shifted by 90°.  
The reactive power signal can be read from the waveform register  
by setting the WAVMODE register (Address 0x0D) and the  
WFSM bit (Bit 5) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH,  
Address 0xDB). Like the current and voltage channels waveform  
sampling modes, the waveform data is available at sample rates of  
25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS, 6.4 kSPS, and 3.2 kSPS.  
Rev. B | Page 67 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Reactive Power Gain Calibration  
(MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) records when a change of sign has  
occurred according to the VARSIGN bit (Bit 5) in the  
ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F). If the VARSIGN bit is set  
in the Interrupt Enable 1 SFR (MIRQENL, Address 0xD9), the  
8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. The ADE interrupt stays  
active until the VARSIGN status bit is cleared (see the Energy  
Measurement Interrupts section).  
Figure 72 shows the signal processing chain for the ADE7169/  
ADE7569 reactive power calculation. As explained in the  
Reactive Power Calculation (ADE7169/ADE7569) section, the  
reactive power is calculated by applying a low-pass filter to the  
instantaneous reactive power signal. Note that, when reading  
the waveform samples from the output of LPF2, the gain of the  
reactive energy can be adjusted by using the multiplier and by  
writing a twos complement, 12-bit word to the var gain register  
(VARGAIN[11:0], Address 0x1E). Equation 25 shows how the  
gain adjustment is related to the contents of the var gain register.  
When VARSIGN (Bit 5) in the ACCMODE register (Address  
0x0F) is cleared (default), the VARSIGN flag (Bit 4) in the  
Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set when  
a transition from positive to negative reactive power occurs.  
Output VARGAIN =  
When VARSIGN in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F) is  
set, the VARSIGN flag in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL,  
Address 0xDC) is set when a transition from negative to positive  
reactive power occurs.  
VARGAIN  
Reactive Power× 1+  
(25)  
212  
The resolution of the VARGAIN register is the same as the  
WGAIN register (see the Active Power Gain Calibration  
section). VARGAIN can be used to calibrate the reactive  
power (or energy) calculation in the ADE7169/ADE7569.  
Reactive Power No Load Detection  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 include a no load threshold feature on  
the reactive energy that eliminates any creep effects in the  
meter. The ADE7169/ADE7569 accomplish this by not  
accumulating reactive energy when the multiplier output is  
below the no load threshold. When the reactive power is below  
the no load threshold, the RNOLOAD flag (Bit 1) in the Interrupt  
Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set. If the RNOLOAD  
bit (Bit 1) is set in the Interrupt Enable 1 SFR (MIRQENL,  
Address 0xD9), the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. The  
ADE interrupt stays active until the RNOLOAD status bit is  
cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
Reactive Power Offset Calibration  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 also incorporate a reactive power  
offset register (VAROS[15:0], Address 0x21). This signed, twos  
complement, 16-bit register can be used to remove offsets in the  
reactive power calculation (see Figure 72). An offset can exist in  
the reactive power calculation due to crosstalk between channels  
on the PCB or in the IC itself. The offset calibration allows the  
contents of the reactive power register to be maintained at 0  
when no power is being consumed.  
The no load threshold level is selectable by setting the  
The 256 LSBs (VAROS = 0x100) written to the reactive power  
offset register are equivalent to 1 LSB in the WAVMODE register  
(Address 0x0D).  
VARNOLOAD bits (Bits[3:2]) in the NLMODE register  
(Address 0x0E). Setting these bits to 0b00 disables the no load  
detection, and setting them to 0b01, 0b10, or 0b11 sets the no  
load detection threshold to 0.015%, 0.0075%, and 0.0037% of  
the full-scale output frequency of the multiplier, respectively.  
Sign of Reactive Power Calculation  
Note that the average reactive power is a signed calculation.  
The phase shift filter has −90° phase shift when the integrator  
is enabled, and +90° phase shift when the integrator is disabled.  
Table 46 summarizes the relationship of the phase difference  
between the voltage and the current and the sign of the resulting  
var calculation.  
REACTIVE ENERGY CALCULATION  
(ADE7169/ADE7569)  
As for active energy, the ADE7169/ADE7569 achieve the  
integration of the reactive power signal by continuously  
accumulating the reactive power signal in an internal, nonreadable,  
49-bit energy register. The reactive energy register (VARHR[23:0],  
Address 0x04) represents the upper 24 bits of this internal  
register. The VARHR register and its function are available for  
the ADE7169/ADE7569 only.  
Table 46. Sign of Reactive Power Calculation  
Angle  
Integrator  
Sign  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
Positive  
Negative  
Positive  
Negative  
Between 0° to +90°  
Between −90° to 0°  
Between 0° to +90°  
Between −90° to 0°  
The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register  
in the ADE7169/ADE7569 is 1.22 μs (5/MCLK). As well as  
calculating the energy, this integration removes any sinusoidal  
components that may be in the active power signal. Figure 72  
shows this discrete time integration or accumulation. The  
reactive power signal in the waveform register is continuously  
added to the internal reactive energy register.  
Reactive Power Sign Detection  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 detect a change of sign in the reactive  
power. The VARSIGN flag (Bit 4) in the Interrupt Status 1 SFR  
Rev. B | Page 68 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The reactive energy accumulation depends on the setting of the  
content of the VARHR register, and the upper 24 bits of the  
internal register are cleared.  
SAVARM and ABSVARM bits in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). When both bits are cleared, the addition is  
signed and, therefore, negative energy is subtracted from the  
reactive energy contents. When both bits are set, the  
ADE7169/ADE7569 are set to be in the more restrictive mode,  
which is the absolute accumulation mode. When the SAVARM  
bit (Bit 2) in the ACCMODE register (Address 0x0F) is set, the  
reactive power is accumulated depending on the sign of the  
active power. When the active power is positive, the reactive  
power is added as it is to the reactive energy register. When the  
active power is negative, the reactive power is subtracted from  
the reactive energy accumulator (see the Var Antitamper  
Accumulation Mode section).  
As shown in Figure 72, the reactive power signal is accumulated  
in an internal 49-bit, signed register. The reactive power signal  
can be read from the waveform register by setting the WAVMODE  
register (Address 0x0D) and setting the WFSM bit (Bit 5) in the  
Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB). Like the  
current and voltage channel waveform sampling modes, the wave-  
form data is available at sample rates of 25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS,  
6.4 kSPS, and 3.2 kSPS.  
Figure 67 shows this energy accumulation for full-scale signals  
(sinusoidal) on the analog inputs. These curves also apply for  
the reactive energy accumulation.  
Note that the energy register contents roll over to full-scale  
negative (0x800000) and continue to increase in value when the  
power or energy flow is positive. Conversely, if the power is  
negative, the energy register underflows to full-scale positive  
(0x7FFFFF) and continues to decrease in value.  
When the ABSVARM bit (Bit 3) in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F) is set, the absolute reactive power is used for  
the reactive energy accumulation (see the Var Absolute  
Accumulation Mode section).  
The output of the multiplier is divided by VARDIV. If the value  
in the VARDIV register (Address 0x25) is equal to 0, the internal  
reactive energy register is divided by 1. VARDIV is an 8-bit,  
unsigned register. After dividing by VARDIV, the reactive  
energy is accumulated in a 49-bit internal energy accumulation  
register. The upper 24 bits of this register are accessible through  
a read to the reactive energy register (VARHR[23:0], Address  
0x04). A read to the RVAHR register (Address 0x08) returns the  
Using the Interrupt Enable 2 SFR (MIRQENM, Address 0xDA),  
the ADE7169/ADE7569 can be configured to issue an ADE  
interrupt to the 8052 core when the reactive energy register is  
half-full (positive or negative) or when an overflow or  
underflow occurs.  
UPPER 24 BITS ARE  
ACCESSIBLE THROUGH  
VARHR[23:0] REGISTER  
FOR WAVEFORM  
SAMPLING  
VARHR[23:0]  
23  
0
VAROS[15:0]  
90° PHASE  
SHIFTING FILTER  
HPF  
CURRENT  
CHANNEL  
6
5
–6 –7 –8  
2 2 2  
sgn  
2
2
VARDIV[7:0]  
Π
2
LPF2  
48  
0
+
+
+
%
+
VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL  
PHCAL[7:0]  
VARGAIN[11:0]  
OUTPUTS FROM THE LPF2 ARE  
ACCUMULATED (INTEGRATED) IN  
THE INTERNAL REACTIVE ENERGY  
REGISTER  
REACTIVE POWER  
SIGNAL  
TO  
DIGITAL-TO-FREQUENCY  
CONVERTER  
5
T
CLKIN  
WAVEFORM  
REGISTER  
VALUES  
TIME (nT)  
Figure 72. Reactive Energy Calculation  
Rev. B | Page 69 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Integration Time Under Steady Load: Reactive Energy  
As mentioned in the Active Energy Calculation section, the  
discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is  
1.22 μs (5/MCLK). With full-scale sinusoidal signals on the  
analog inputs and the VARGAIN register (Address 0x1E) and  
the VARDIV register (Address 0x25) set to 0x000, the  
REACTIVE ENERGY  
integration time before the reactive energy register overflows is  
calculated in Equation 26.  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
Time =  
0xFFFF, FFFF, FFFF  
×1.22μs = 409.6 sec = 6.82 min (26)  
REACTIVE POWER  
0xCCCCD  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
When VARDIV is set to a value different from 0, the integration  
time varies, as shown in Equation 27.  
Time =TimeWDIV =0 ×VARDIV  
(27)  
Reactive Energy Accumulation Modes  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
Var Signed Accumulation Mode  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 reactive energy default accumulation  
mode is a signed accumulation based on the reactive power  
information.  
ACTIVE POWER  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
Var Antitamper Accumulation Mode  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 are placed in var antitamper  
accumulation mode by setting the SAVARM bit in the ACCMODE  
register (Address 0x0F). In this mode, the reactive power is  
accumulated depending on the sign of the active power. When  
the active power is positive, the reactive power is added as it is  
to the reactive energy register. When the active power is  
negative, the reactive power is subtracted from the reactive  
energy accumulator (see Figure 73). The CF pulse also reflects  
this accumulation method when in this mode. The default setting  
for this mode is off. Transitions in the direction of power flow and  
no load threshold are active in this mode.  
APSIGN FLAG  
POS  
NEG  
POS  
INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTERS  
Figure 73. Reactive Energy Accumulation in  
Antitamper Accumulation Mode  
Rev. B | Page 70 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Line Cycle Reactive Energy Accumulation Mode  
Var Absolute Accumulation Mode  
In line cycle reactive energy accumulation mode, the energy  
accumulation of the ADE7169/ADE7569 can be synchronized  
to the voltage channel zero crossing so that reactive energy can  
be accumulated over an integral number of half-line cycles. The  
advantages of this mode are similar to the ones described in the  
Line Cycle Active Energy Accumulation Mode section.  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 are placed in absolute accumulation  
mode by setting the ABSVARM bit (Bit 3) in the ACCMODE  
register (Address 0x0F). In absolute accumulation mode, the  
reactive energy accumulation is done by using the absolute  
reactive power and ignoring any occurrence of power below the  
no load threshold for the reactive energy (see Figure 74). The CF  
pulse also reflects this accumulation method when in the  
absolute accumulation mode. The default setting for this mode is  
off. Transitions in the direction of power flow and no load  
threshold are active in this mode.  
In line cycle active energy accumulation mode, the  
ADE7169/ADE7569 accumulate the reactive power signal in  
the LVARHR register (Address 0x06) for an integral number of  
line cycles, as shown in Figure 75. The number of half-line cycles  
is specified in the LINCYC register (Address 0x12). The  
ADE7169/ADE7569 can accumulate active power for up to  
65,535 half-line cycles.  
Because the reactive power is integrated on an integral number  
of line cycles, the CYCEND flag (Bit 2) in the Interrupt Status 3  
SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE) is set at the end of an active  
energy accumulation line cycle. If the CYCEND enable bit  
(Bit 2) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH, Address 0xDB)  
is set, the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt. The ADE  
interrupt stays active until the CYCEND status bit is cleared  
(see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section). Another  
calibration cycle starts as soon as the CYCEND flag is set. If  
the LVARHR register (Address 0x06) is not read before a new  
CYCEND flag is set, the LVARHR register is overwritten by a  
new value.  
REACTIVE ENERGY  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
REACTIVE POWER  
NO-LOAD  
THRESHOLD  
Figure 74. Reactive Energy Accumulation in Absolute Accumulation Mode  
Reactive Energy Pulse Output  
The ADE7169/ADE7569 provide all the circuitry with a pulse  
output whose frequency is proportional to reactive power (see  
the Energy-to-Frequency Conversion section). This pulse  
frequency output uses the calibrated signal after VARGAIN,  
and its behavior is consistent with the setting of the reactive  
energy accumulation mode in the ACCMODE register  
(Address 0x0F). The pulse output is active low and should  
preferably be connected to an LED, as shown in Figure 80.  
When a new half-line cycle is written in the LINCYC register  
(Address 0x12), the LVARHR register is reset, and a new  
accumulation starts at the next zero crossing. The number of  
half-line cycles is then counted internally until the value  
programmed in LINCYC is reached. This implementation  
provides a valid measurement at the first CYCEND interrupt  
after writing to the LINCYC register. The line reactive energy  
accumulation uses the same signal path as the reactive energy  
accumulation. The LSB size of these two registers is equivalent.  
TO  
DIGITAL-TO-FREQUENCY  
CONVERTER  
VARGAIN[11:0]  
48  
0
+
+
OUTPUT  
FROM  
LPF2  
%
VAROS[15:0]  
VARDIV[7:0]  
ACTIVE ENERGY  
IS ACCUMULATED IN  
THE INTERNAL REGISTER,  
AND THE LWATTHR  
REGISTER IS UPDATED  
AT THE END OF THE LINCYC  
HALF-LINE CYCLES  
23  
0
LPF1  
LVARHR[23:0]  
ZERO-CROSSING  
DETECTION  
CALIBRATION  
CONTROL  
FROM VOLTAGE  
CHANNEL ADC  
LINCYC[15:0]  
Figure 75. Line Cycle Reactive Energy Accumulation Mode  
Rev. B | Page 71 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The gain of the apparent energy can be adjusted by using the  
APPARENT POWER CALCULATION  
multiplier and by writing a twos complement, 12-bit word to the  
VAGAIN register (VAGAIN[11:0], Address 0x1F). Equation 32  
shows how the gain adjustment is related to the contents of the  
VAGAIN register.  
Apparent power is defined as the maximum power that can be  
delivered to a load. Vrms and Irms are the effective voltage and  
current delivered to the load, respectively. Therefore, the apparent  
power (AP) = Vrms × Irms. This equation is independent of the  
phase angle between the current and the voltage.  
Output VAGAIN =  
VAGAIN  
Equation 31 gives an expression of the instantaneous power  
signal in an ac system with a phase shift.  
Apparent Power × 1+  
(32)  
212  
For example, when 0x7FF is written to the VAGAIN register, the  
power output is scaled up by 50% (0x7FF = 2047d, 2047/212 = 0.5).  
Similarly, 0x800 = −2047d (signed twos complement) and power  
output is scaled by −50%. Each LSB represents 0.0244% of the  
power output. The apparent power is calculated with the current  
and voltage rms values obtained in the rms blocks of the  
(28)  
v(t) = 2 Vrms sin(ωt)  
2 Irms sin(ωt + θ)  
p(t) = v(t)×i(t)  
=Vrms Irms cos(θ)Vrms Irms cos(2ωt + θ)  
i
(
t
)
=
(29)  
(30)  
(31)  
p t  
( )  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
Figure 76 illustrates the signal processing for the calculation of  
the apparent power in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
Apparent Power Offset Calibration  
Each rms measurement includes an offset compensation register to  
calibrate and eliminate the dc component in the rms value (see the  
Current Channel RMS Calculation and the Voltage Channel  
RMS Calculation section). The voltage and current channels  
rms values are then multiplied together in the apparent power  
signal processing. Because no additional offsets are created in  
the multiplication of the rms values, there is no specific offset  
compensation in the apparent power signal processing. The  
offset compensation of the apparent power measurement is  
done by calibrating each individual rms measurement.  
The apparent power signal can be read from the waveform register  
by setting the WAVMODE register (Address 0x0D) and setting the  
WFSM bit (Bit 5) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR (MIRQENH,  
Address 0xDB). Like the current and voltage channel waveform  
sampling modes, the waveform data is available at sample rates  
of 25.6 kSPS, 12.8 kSPS, 6.4 kSPS, and 3.2 kSPS.  
VARMSCFCON  
APPARENT POWER  
SIGNAL (P)  
I
rms  
0x1A36E2  
CURRENT RMS SIGNAL – i(t)  
0x1CF68C  
0x00  
VAGAIN  
V
rms  
VOLTAGE RMS SIGNAL – v(t)  
0x1CF68C  
TO  
DIGITAL-TO-FREQUENCY  
CONVERTER  
0x00  
Figure 76. Apparent Power Signal Processing  
Rev. B | Page 72 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
provided to read the apparent energy. This register is reset to 0  
after a read operation.  
APPARENT ENERGY CALCULATION  
The apparent energy is given as the integral of the apparent power.  
Note that the apparent energy register is unsigned. By setting the  
VAEHF bit (Bit 2) and the VAEOF bit (Bit 5) in the Interrupt  
Enable 2 SFR (MIRQENM, Address 0xDA), the device can be  
configured to issue an ADE interrupt to the 8052 core when the  
apparent energy register is half-full or when an overflow occurs.  
The half-full interrupt for the unsigned apparent energy register  
is based on 24 bits as opposed to 23 bits for the signed active  
energy register.  
(33)  
Apparent Energy = Apparent Power(t)dt  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 achieve the integration of the apparent power signal  
by continuously accumulating the apparent power signal in an  
internal 48-bit register. The apparent energy register  
(VAHR[23:0], Address 0x07) represents the upper 24 bits of this  
internal register. This discrete time accumulation or summation  
is equivalent to integration in continuous time. Equation 34  
expresses the relationship.  
Integration Time Under Steady Load: Apparent Energy  
As mentioned in the Apparent Energy Calculation section, the  
discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation register is  
1.22 μs (5/MCLK). With full-scale sinusoidal signals on the  
analog inputs and the VAGAIN register (Address 0x1F) set to  
0x000, the average word value from the apparent power stage is  
0x1A36E2 (see the Apparent Power Calculation section). The  
maximum value that can be stored in the apparent energy  
register before it overflows is 224 or 0xFF,FFFF. The average  
word value is added to the internal register, which can store 248  
or 0xFFFF,FFFF,FFFF before it overflows. Therefore, the  
integration time under these conditions with VADIV = 0 is  
calculated as follows:  
(34)  
Apparent Energy = lim  
Apparent Power(nT)×T  
T 0  
n=0  
where:  
n is the discrete time sample number.  
T is the sample period.  
The discrete time sample period (T) for the accumulation  
register in the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 is 1.22 μs (5/MCLK).  
Figure 77 shows this discrete time integration or accumulation.  
The apparent power signal is continuously added to the internal  
register. This addition is a signed addition even if the apparent  
energy theoretically remains positive.  
Time =  
0xFFFF, FFFF, FFFF  
×1.22μs =199 sec = 3.33 min  
(35)  
The 49 bits of the internal register are divided by VADIV. If the  
value in the VADIV register (Address 0x26) is 0, the internal  
apparent energy register is divided by 1. VADIV is an 8-bit,  
unsigned register. The upper 24 bits are then written in the  
24-bit apparent energy register (VAHR[23:0], Address 0x07).  
The RVAHR register (Address 0x08), which is 24 bits long, is  
0xD055  
When VADIV is set to a value different from 0, the integration  
time varies, as shown in Equation 36.  
Time = TimeWDIV = 0 × VADIV  
(36)  
VAHR[23:0]  
23  
0
48  
0
%
VADIV  
48  
0
APPARENT POWER  
+
or  
+
I
rms  
APPARENT  
POWER SIGNAL = P  
APPARENT POWER OR I  
rms  
IS  
ACCUMULATED (INTEGRATED)  
IN THE APPARENT ENERGY  
REGISTER  
T
TIME (nT)  
Figure 77. Apparent Energy Calculation  
Rev. B | Page 73 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The line apparent energy accumulation uses the same signal  
path as the apparent energy accumulation. The LSB size of these  
two registers is equivalent.  
Apparent Energy Pulse Output  
All the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 circuitry has a pulse output whose frequency is  
proportional to apparent power (see the Energy-to-Frequency  
Conversion section). This pulse frequency output uses the  
calibrated signal after VAGAIN. This output can also be used to  
output a pulse whose frequency is proportional to Irms. The pulse  
output is active low and should preferably be connected to an  
LED, as shown in Figure 80.  
Apparent Power No Load Detection  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 include a no load threshold feature on the apparent  
power that eliminates any creep effects in the meter. The ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 accomplish  
this by not accumulating energy if the multiplier output is below  
the no load threshold. When the apparent power is below the  
no load threshold, the VANOLOAD flag (Bit 2) in the Interrupt  
Status 1 SFR (MIRQSTL, Address 0xDC) is set. If the VANOLOAD  
bit (Bit 2) is set in the Interrupt Enable 1 SFR (MIRQENL,  
Address 0xD9), the 8052 core has a pending ADE interrupt.  
The ADE interrupt stays active until the APNOLOAD status bit  
is cleared (see the Energy Measurement Interrupts section).  
Line Apparent Energy Accumulation  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 are designed with a special apparent energy  
accumulation mode that simplifies the calibration process. By  
using the on-chip, zero-crossing detection, the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
accumulate the apparent power signal in the LVAHR register  
(Address 0x09) for an integral number of half cycles, as shown in  
Figure 78. The line apparent energy accumulation mode is  
always active.  
The no load threshold level is selectable by setting the  
VANOLOAD bits (Bits[5:4]) in the NLMODE register (Address  
0x0E). Setting these bits to 0b00 disables the no load detection,  
and setting them to 0b01, 0b10, or 0b11 sets the no load  
detection threshold to 0.030%, 0.015%, and 0.0075% of the full-  
scale output frequency of the multiplier, respectively.  
The number of half-line cycles is specified in the LINCYC  
register (Address 0x12), which is an unsigned 16-bit register.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 can accumulate apparent power for up to 65,535  
combined half cycles. Because the apparent power is integrated  
on the same integral number of line cycles as the line active  
register and reactive energy register, these values can easily be  
compared. The energies are calculated more accurately because  
of this precise timing control and provide all the information  
needed for reactive power and power factor calculation.  
This no load threshold can also be applied to the Irms pulse  
output when selected. In this case, the level of no load threshold  
is the same as for the apparent energy.  
AMPERE-HOUR ACCUMULATION  
In a tampering situation where no voltage is available to the energy  
meter, the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 are capable of accumulating the ampere-hour instead of  
apparent power into the VAHR, RVAHR, and LVAHR. When the  
VARMSCFCON bit (Bit 3) of the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C)  
is set, the VAHR, RVAHR, and LVAHR, and the input for the  
digital-to-frequency converter accumulate Irms instead of apparent  
power. All the signal processing and calibration registers  
available for apparent power and energy accumulation remain  
the same when ampere-hour accumulation is selected. However,  
the scaling difference between Irms and apparent power requires  
independent values for gain calibration in the VAGAIN  
(Address 0x1F), VADIV (Address 0x26), CFxNUM (Address  
0x27 and Address 0x29), and CFxDEN (Address 0x28 and  
Address 0x2A) registers.  
At the end of an energy calibration cycle, the CYCEND flag (Bit 2)  
in the Interrupt Status 3 SFR (MIRQSTH, Address 0xDE) is set.  
If the CYCEND enable bit (Bit 2) in the Interrupt Enable 3 SFR  
(MIRQENH, Address 0xDB) is enabled, the 8052 core has a  
pending ADE interrupt.  
As for LWATTHR, when a new half-line cycle is written  
in the LINCYC register (Address 0x12), the LVAHR register  
(Address 0x09) is reset and a new accumulation starts at the next  
zero crossing. The number of half-line cycles is then counted until  
LINCYC is reached.  
This implementation provides a valid measurement at the first  
CYCEND interrupt after writing to the LINCYC register.  
Rev. B | Page 74 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
48  
0
+
+
APPARENT POWER  
or I  
%
rms  
LVAHR REGISTER IS  
UPDATED EVERY LINCYC  
ZERO CROSSING WITH THE  
TOTAL APPARENT ENERGY  
DURING THAT DURATION  
VADIV[7:0]  
23  
0
LPF1  
LVAHR[23:0]  
FROM  
VOLTAGE CHANNEL  
ADC  
ZERO-CROSSING  
DETECTION  
CALIBRATION  
CONTROL  
LINCYC[15:0]  
Figure 78. Line Cycle Apparent Energy Accumulation  
Enable 2 SFR (MIRQENM, Address 0xDA) are set, the 8052 core  
has a pending ADE interrupt. The ADE interrupt stays active  
until the CF1 or CF2 status bit is cleared (see the Energy  
Measurement Interrupts section).  
ENERGY-TO-FREQUENCY CONVERSION  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 also provide two energy-to-frequency conversions for  
calibration purposes. After initial calibration at manufacturing,  
the manufacturer or end customer often verifies the energy meter  
calibration. One convenient way to do this is for the manufacturer  
to provide an output frequency that is proportional to the active  
power, reactive power, apparent power, or Irms under steady load  
conditions. This output frequency can provide a simple single-  
wire, optically isolated interface to external calibration equipment.  
Figure 79 illustrates the energy-to-frequency conversion in the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
MODE2 REGISTER 0x0C  
Pulse Output Configuration  
The two pulse output circuits have separate configuration bits  
in the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C). Setting the CFxSEL bits  
to 0b00, 0b01, or 0b1X configures the DFC to create a pulse  
output proportional to active power , reactive power (ADE7169/  
ADE7569 only), or apparent power or Irms, respectively.  
The selection between Irms and apparent power is done by the  
VARMSCFCON bit in the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C).  
With this selection, CF2 cannot be proportional to apparent  
power if CF1 is proportional to Irms, and CF1 cannot be  
VARMSCFCON CFxSEL[1:0]  
proportional to apparent power if CF2 is proportional to Irms  
.
Irms  
CFxNUM  
Pulse Output Characteristic  
VA  
The pulse output for both DFCs stays low for 90 ms if the pulse  
period is longer than 180 ms (5.56 Hz). If the pulse period is  
shorter than 180 ms, the duty cycle of the pulse output is 50%.  
The pulse output is active low and should be connected to an  
LED, as shown in Figure 80.  
CFx PULSE  
DFC  
*
OUTPUT  
VAR  
÷
WATT  
CFxDEN  
*
AVAILABLE ONLY IN THE ADE7569 AND ADE7169  
V
DD  
Figure 79. Energy-to-Frequency Conversion  
CF  
Two digital-to-frequency converters (DFC) are used to generate  
the pulsed outputs. When WDIV = 0 or 1, the DFC generates a  
pulse each time 1 LSB in the energy register is accumulated. An  
output pulse is generated when a CFxNUM/CFxDEN number  
of pulses is generated at the DFC output. Under steady load  
conditions, the output frequency is proportional to the active  
power, reactive power, apparent power, or Irms, depending on the  
CFxSEL bits in the MODE2 register (Address 0x0C).  
Figure 80. CF Pulse Output  
The maximum output frequency with ac input signals at  
full scale and with CFxNUM = 0x00 and CFxDEN = 0x00  
is approximately 21.1 kHz.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 incorporate two registers per DFC, CFxNUM[15:0]  
and CFxDEN[15:0], to set the CFx frequency. These unsigned,  
16-bit registers can be used to adjust the CFx frequency to a wide  
range of values. These frequency scaling registers are 16-bit  
registers that can scale the output frequency by 1/216 to 1 with  
a step of 1/216.  
Both pulse outputs can be enabled or disabled by clearing or  
setting the DISCF1 bit (Bit 1) and the DISCF2 bit (Bit 2) in the  
MODE1 register (Address 0x0B), respectively.  
Both pulse outputs set separate flags in the Interrupt Status 2 SFR  
(MIRQSTM, Address 0xDD): CF1 (Bit 6) and CF2 (Bit 7). If the  
CF1 enable bit (Bit 6) and CF2 enable bit (Bit 7) in the Interrupt  
Rev. B | Page 75 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
If 0 is written to any of these registers, 1 is applied to the register.  
The ratio of CFxNUM/CFxDEN should be less than 1 to ensure  
proper operation. If the ratio of the CFxNUM/CFxDEN registers  
is greater than 1, the register values are adjusted to a ratio of 1.  
For example, if the output frequency is 1.562 kHz, and the  
content of CFxDEN is 0 (0x000), the output frequency can be  
set to 6.1 Hz by writing 0xFF to the CFxDEN register.  
ENERGY MEASUREMENT INTERRUPTS  
The energy measurement part of the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 has its own interrupt  
vector for the 8052 core, Vector Address 0x004B (see the  
Interrupt Vectors section). The bits set in the Interrupt Enable 1  
SFR (MIRQENL, Address 0xD9), Interrupt Enable 2 SFR  
(MIRQENM, Address 0xDA), and Interrupt Enable 3 SFR  
(MIRQENH, Address 0xDB) enable the energy measurement  
interrupts that are allowed to interrupt the 8052 core. If an  
event is not enabled, it cannot create a system interrupt.  
ENERGY REGISTER SCALING  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide measurements of active, reactive, and  
apparent energies that use separate paths and filtering for  
calculation. The difference in data paths can result in small  
differences in LSB weight between active, reactive, and apparent  
energy registers. These measurements are internally compensated  
so that the scaling is nearly one to one. The relationship between  
these registers is shown in Table 47.  
The ADE interrupt stays active until the status bit that has created  
the interrupt is cleared. The status bit is cleared when a 0 is  
written to this register bit.  
Table 47. Energy Registers Scaling  
Line Frequency = 50 Hz Line Frequency = 60 Hz Integrator  
Var = 0.9952 × Watt  
VA = 0.9978 × Watt  
Var = 0.9997 × Watt  
VA = 0.9977 × Watt  
Var = 0.9949 × Watt  
VA = 1.0015 × Watt  
Var = 0.9999 × Watt  
VA = 1.0015 × Watt  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
Rev. B | Page 76 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TEMPERATURE, BATTERY, AND SUPPLY VOLTAGE MEASUREMENTS  
The ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 include  
temperature measurements as well as battery and supply voltage  
measurements. (This feature is not available in the ADE7116.)  
These measurements enable many forms of compensation. The  
temperature and supply voltage measurements can be used to  
compensate external circuitry. The RTC can be calibrated over  
temperature to ensure that it does not drift. Supply voltage  
measurements allow the LCD contrast to be maintained despite  
variations in voltage. Battery measurements allow low battery  
detection to be performed. All ADC measurements are  
configured through the SFRs, as shown in Table 48.  
The temperature, battery, and supply voltage measurements can  
be configured to continue functioning in PSM1 and PSM2.  
Keeping the temperature measurement active ensures that it is  
not necessary to wait for the temperature measurement to settle  
before using it for compensation.  
Table 48. Temperature, Battery, and Supply Voltage Measurement SFRs  
SFR Address  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Mnemonic  
STRBPER  
DIFFPROG  
ADCGO  
BATVTH  
VDCINADC  
BATADC  
Description  
0xF9  
0xF3  
0xD8  
0xFA  
0xEF  
0xDF  
0xD7  
Peripheral ADC strobe period (see Table 49).  
Temperature and supply delta (see Table 50).  
Start ADC measurement (see Table 51).  
Battery detection threshold (see Table 52).  
VDCIN ADC value (see Table 53).  
Battery ADC value (see Table 54).  
Temperature ADC value (see Table 55).  
TEMPADC  
Table 49. Peripheral ADC Strobe Period SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:6]  
[5:4]  
Reserved  
00  
0
These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Period for background external voltage measurements.  
VDCIN_PERIOD  
VDCIN_PERIOD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No VDCIN measurement  
8 min  
2 min  
1 min  
[3:2]  
[1:0]  
BATT_PERIOD  
TEMP_PERIOD  
0
0
Period for background battery level measurements.  
BATT_PERIOD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No battery measurement  
16 min  
4 min  
1 min  
Period for background temperature measurements.  
TEMP_PERIOD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
No temperature measurement  
8 min  
2 min  
1 min  
Rev. B | Page 77 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 50. Temperature and Supply Delta SFR (DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:6]  
[5:3]  
Reserved  
0
0
Reserved.  
TEMP_DIFF  
Difference threshold between last temperature measurement interrupting 8052 and new  
temperature measurement that should interrupt 8052.  
TEMP_DIFF  
000  
Result  
No interrupt  
001  
1 LSB (≈ 0.8°C)  
2 LSB (≈ 1.6°C)  
3 LSB (≈ 2.4°C)  
4 LSB (≈ 3.2°C)  
5 LSB (≈ 4°C)  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
6 LSB (≈ 4.8°C)  
Every temperature measurement  
111  
[2:0]  
VDCIN_DIFF  
0
Difference threshold between last external voltage measurement interrupting 8052 and new  
external measurement that should interrupt 8052.  
VDCIN_DIFF  
000  
Result  
No interrupt  
001  
1 LSB (≈ 120 mV)  
2 LSB (≈ 240 mV)  
3 LSB (≈ 360 mV)  
4 LSB (≈ 480 mV)  
5 LSB (≈ 600 mV)  
6 LSB (≈ 720 mV)  
Every VDCIN measurement  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
Table 51. Start ADC Measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8)  
Bit  
Address  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
0xDF  
PLLACK  
0
Set this bit to clear the PLL fault bit, PLL_FLT, in the PERIPH register (Address  
0xF4). A PLL fault is generated if a reset is caused because the PLL lost lock.  
[6:3]  
2
0xDE to 0xDB  
0xDA  
Reserved  
0
0
Reserved.  
VDCIN_ADC_GO  
Set this bit to initiate an external voltage measurement. This bit is cleared  
when the measurement request is received by the ADC.  
1
0
0xD9  
0xD8  
TEMP_ADC_GO  
BATT_ADC_GO  
0
0
Set this bit to initiate a temperature measurement. This bit is cleared when  
the measurement request is received by the ADC.  
Set this bit to initiate a battery measurement. This bit is cleared when the  
measurement request is received by the ADC.  
Table 52. Battery Detection Threshold SFR (BATVTH, Address 0xFA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
BATVTH  
0
The battery ADC value is compared to this register, the battery threshold register. If  
BATADC is lower than the threshold, an interrupt is generated.  
Table 53. VDCIN ADC Value SFR (VDCINADC, Address 0xEF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
VDCINADC  
0
The VDCINADC value in this register is updated when an ADC interrupt occurs.  
Table 54. Battery ADC Value SFR (BATADC, Address 0xDF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
BATADC  
0
The battery ADC value in this register is updated when an ADC interrupt occurs.  
Table 55. Temperature ADC Value SFR (TEMPADC, Address 0xD7)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
TEMPADC  
0
The temperature ADC value in this register is updated when an ADC interrupt occurs.  
Rev. B | Page 78 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
In PSM1 operating mode, the 8052 is active, and the part is  
battery powered. Single temperature measurements can be  
initiated by setting the TEMP_ADC_GO bit in the start  
ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8).  
Background temperature measurements are not available.  
In PSM2 operating mode, the 8052 is not active.  
Temperature conversions are available through the  
background measurement mode only.  
TEMPERATURE MEASUREMENT  
To provide a digital temperature measurement, each ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 includes a dedicated  
ADC. An 8-bit temperature ADC value SFR (TEMPADC,  
Address 0xD7) holds the results of the temperature conversion.  
The resolution of the temperature measurement is 0.78°C/LSB.  
There are two ways to initiate a temperature conversion: a single  
temperature measurement or background temperature  
measurements.  
The temperature ADC value SFR (TEMPADC, Address 0xD7) is  
updated with a new value only when a temperature ADC  
interrupt occurs.  
Single Temperature Measurement  
Set the TEMP_ADC_GO bit (Bit 1) in the start ADC measure-  
ment SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8) to obtain a temperature  
measurement (see Table 51). An interrupt is generated when the  
conversion is complete and when the temperature measurement  
is available in the temperature ADC value SFR (TEMPADC,  
Address 0xD7).  
Temperature ADC Interrupt  
The temperature ADC can generate an ADC interrupt when at  
least one of the following conditions occurs:  
The difference between the new temperature ADC value and  
the last temperature ADC value generating an ADC interrupt  
is larger than the value set in the TEMP_DIFF bits.  
The temperature ADC conversion, initiated by setting the  
start ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8),  
finishes.  
Background Temperature Measurements  
Background temperature measurements are disabled by default.  
To configure the background temperature measurement mode,  
set a temperature measurement interval in the peripheral ADC  
strobe period SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9). Temperature  
measurements are then performed periodically in the background  
(see Table 49).  
When the ADC interrupt occurs, a new value is available in the  
temperature ADC value SFR (TEMPADC, Address 0xD7). Note  
that there is no flag associated with this interrupt.  
When a temperature conversion completes, the new temperature  
ADC value is compared to the last temperature ADC value that  
created an interrupt. If the absolute difference between the two  
values is greater than the setting in the TEMP_DIFF bits in the  
temperature and supply delta SFR (DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3),  
a TEMPADC interrupt is generated (see Table 50). This allows  
temperature measurements to take place completely in the  
background, requiring MCU activity only if the temperature  
changes more than a configurable delta.  
BATTERY MEASUREMENT  
To provide a digital battery measurement, each ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 includes a dedicated  
ADC. The battery measurement is available in the 8-bit battery  
ADC value SFR (BATADC, Address 0xDF). The battery  
measurement has a resolution of 14.6 mV/LSB. A battery  
conversion can be initiated by two methods: a single battery  
measurement or background battery measurements.  
To set up background temperature measurement,  
Single Battery Measurement  
Set the BATT_ADC_GO bit (Bit 0) in the start ADC measurement  
SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8) to obtain a battery measurement.  
An interrupt is generated when the conversion is done and  
when the battery measurement is available in the battery ADC  
value SFR (BATADC, Address 0xDF).  
1. Initiate a single temperature measurement by setting the  
TEMP_ADC_GO bit in the start ADC measurement SFR  
(ADCGO, Address 0xD8).  
2. Upon completion of this measurement, configure the  
TEMP_DIFF bits in the temperature and supply delta SFR  
(DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3) to establish the change in  
temperature that triggers an interrupt.  
3. Set up the interval for background temperature measurements  
by configuring the TEMP_PERIOD[1:0] bits in the periph-  
eral ADC strobe period SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9).  
Background Battery Measurements  
To configure background measurements for the battery, establish  
a measurement interval in the peripheral ADC strobe period  
SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9). Battery measurements are then  
performed periodically in the background (see Table 49).  
Temperature ADC in PSM0, PSM1, and PSM2  
When a battery conversion completes, the battery ADC value is  
compared to the low battery threshold, established in the battery  
detection threshold SFR (BATVTH, Address 0xFA). If the battery  
ADC value is below this threshold, a low battery flag is set. This  
low battery flag is the FBAT bit (Bit 2) in the power manage-  
ment interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8), used for power  
supply management.  
Depending on the operating mode of the ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569, a temperature conversion is  
initiated only by certain actions.  
In PSM0 operating mode, the 8052 is active. Temperature  
measurements are available in the background measurement  
mode and by initiating a single measurement.  
Rev. B | Page 79 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
This low battery flag can be enabled to generate the PSM  
interrupt by setting the EBAT bit (Bit 2) in the power  
management interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC).  
This method allows battery measurements to take place  
completely in the background, requiring MCU activity only if the  
battery drops below a user-specified threshold. To set up  
background battery measurements, follow these steps:  
EXTERNAL VOLTAGE MEASUREMENT  
The ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
include a dedicated ADC to provide a digital measurement of  
an external voltage on the VDCIN pin. An 8-bit SFR, the VDCIN  
ADC value SFR (VDCINADC, Address 0xEF), holds the results  
of the conversion. The resolution of the external voltage measure-  
ment is 15.3 mV/LSB. There are two ways to initiate an external  
voltage conversion: a single external voltage measurement or  
background external voltage measurements.  
1. Configure the battery detection threshold SFR (BATVTH,  
Address 0xFA) to establish a low battery threshold. If the  
BATADC measurement is below this threshold, the FBAT  
bit (Bit 2) in the power management interrupt flag SFR  
(IPSMF, Address 0xF8) is set.  
2. Set up the interval for background battery measurements  
by configuring the BATT_PERIOD bits in the peripheral  
ADC strobe period SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9).  
Single External Voltage Measurement  
To obtain an external voltage measurement, set the  
VDCIN_ADC_GO bit (Bit 2) in the start ADC measurement  
SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8). An interrupt is generated when  
the conversion is done and when the external voltage measure-  
ment is available in the VDCIN ADC value SFR (VDCINADC,  
Address 0xEF).  
Battery ADC in PSM0, PSM1, and PSM2 Modes  
Depending on the operating mode, a battery conversion is  
initiated only by certain actions.  
Background External Voltage Measurements  
Background external voltage measurements are disabled by  
default. To configure the background external voltage  
measurement mode, set an external voltage measurement  
interval in the peripheral ADC strobe period SFR (STRBPER,  
Address 0xF9). External voltage measurements are performed  
periodically in the background (see Table 49).  
In PSM0 operating mode, the 8052 is active. Battery  
measurements are available in the background measure-  
ment mode and by initiating a single measurement.  
In PSM1 operating mode, the 8052 is active and the part is  
battery powered. Single battery measurements can be  
initiated by setting the BATT_ADC_GO bit (Bit 0) in the  
start ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8).  
Background battery measurements are not available.  
In PSM2 operating mode, the 8052 is not active. Unlike  
temperature and VDCIN measurements, the battery  
conversions are not available in this mode.  
When an external voltage conversion is complete, the new  
external voltage ADC value is compared to the last external  
voltage ADC value that created an interrupt. If the absolute diff-  
erence between the two values is greater than the setting in the  
VDCIN_DIFF[2:0] bits in the temperature and supply delta SFR  
(DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3), a VDCIN ADC flag is set. This VDCIN  
ADC flag is FVADC (Bit 3) in the power management interrupt  
flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8), which is used for power supply  
management. This VDCIN ADC flag can be enabled to generate a  
PSM interrupt by setting the EVADC bit (Bit 3) in the power  
management interrupt enable SFR (IPSME, Address 0xEC).  
Battery ADC Interrupt  
The battery ADC can generate an ADC interrupt when at least  
one of the following conditions occurs:  
The new battery ADC value is smaller than the value set in  
the battery detection threshold SFR (BATVTH, Address  
0xFA), indicating a battery voltage loss.  
This method allows external voltage measurements to take place  
completely in the background, requiring MCU activity only if  
the external voltage has changed more than a configurable delta.  
A single battery measurement initiated by setting the  
BATT_ADC_GO bit finishes.  
To set up background external voltage measurements, follow  
these steps:  
When the battery flag (FBAT, Bit 2) is set in the power manage-  
ment interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8), a new ADC  
value is available in the battery ADC value SFR (BATADC,  
Address 0xDF). This battery flag can be enabled as a source of  
the PSM interrupt to generate a PSM interrupt every time the  
battery drops below a set voltage threshold or after a single  
conversion initiated by setting the BATT_ADC_GO bit is ready.  
1. Initiate a single external voltage measurement by setting  
the VDCIN_ADC_GO bit (Bit 2) in the start ADC  
measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address 0xD8).  
2. Upon completion of this measurement, configure the  
VDCIN_DIFF[2:0] bits to establish the change in voltage  
that sets the FVDCIN bit (Bit 0) in the power management  
interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF, Address 0xF8).  
3. Set up the interval for background external voltage measure-  
ments by configuring the VDCIN_PERIOD bits in the  
peripheral ADC strobe period SFR (STRBPER, Address 0xF9).  
The battery ADC value SFR (BATADC, Address 0xDF) is  
updated with a new value only when the battery flag (FBAT) is  
set in the power management interrupt flag SFR (IPSMF,  
Address 0xF8).  
Rev. B | Page 80 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
External Voltage ADC in PSM0, PSM1, and PSM2 Modes  
The external voltage ADC in the VDCIN ADC value SFR  
(VDCINADC, Address 0xEF) is updated with a new value only  
when an external voltage ADC interrupt occurs.  
An external voltage conversion is initiated only by certain actions  
that depend on the operating mode of the ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
External Voltage ADC Interrupt  
The external voltage ADC can generate an ADC interrupt when  
at least one of the following conditions occurs:  
In PSM0 operating mode, the 8052 is active. External  
voltage measurements are available in the background  
measurement mode and by initiating a single measurement.  
In PSM1 operating mode, the 8052 is active and the part is  
powered from battery. Single external voltage measurements  
can be initiated by setting the VDCIN_ADC_GO bit (Bit 2)  
in the start ADC measurement SFR (ADCGO, Address  
0xD8). Background external voltage measurements are not  
available.  
The difference between the new external voltage ADC  
value and the last external voltage ADC value generating  
an ADC interrupt is larger than the value set in the  
VDCIN_DIFF[2:0] bits in the temperature and supply  
delta SFR (DIFFPROG, Address 0xF3).  
The external voltage ADC conversion initiated by setting  
VDCIN_ADC_GO, finishes.  
In PSM2 operating mode, the 8052 is not active. External  
voltage conversions are available through the background  
measurement mode only.  
When the ADC interrupt occurs, a new value is available in the  
VDCIN ADC value SFR (VDCINADC, Address 0xEF). Note that  
there is no flag associated with this interrupt.  
Rev. B | Page 81 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
8052 MCU CORE ARCHITECTURE  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
16kB ELECTRICALLY  
REPROGRAMMABLE  
NONVOLATILE  
FLASH/EE  
ENERGY  
MEASUREMENT  
ADE7569 have an 8052 MCU core and use the 8052 instruction  
set. Some of the standard 8052 peripherals, such as the UART,  
have been enhanced. This section describes the standard 8052  
core and enhancements that have been made to it in the  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
PROGRAM/DATA  
MEMORY  
POWER  
MANAGEMENT  
256 BYTES  
GENERAL-  
PURPOSE  
RAM  
RTC  
128-BYTE  
SPECIAL  
FUNCTION  
REGISTER  
AREA  
8052  
COMPATIBLE  
CORE  
LCD DRIVER  
STACK  
The special function register (SFR) space is mapped into the upper  
128 bytes of internal data memory space and is accessed by direct  
addressing only. It provides an interface between the CPU and  
all on-chip peripherals. See Figure 81 for a block diagram of the  
programming model for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 via the SFR area.  
TEMPERATURE  
ADC  
REGISTER  
BANKS  
PC  
IR  
BATTERY  
ADC  
256 BYTES XRAM  
OTHER ON-CHIP  
PERIPHERALS:  
• SERIAL I/O  
• WDT  
• TIMERS  
Figure 81. Block Diagram Showing Programming Model via the SFRs  
All registers except the program counter (PC), instruction  
register (IR), and the four general-purpose register banks  
reside in the SFR area. The SFR registers include control,  
configuration, and data registers that provide an interface  
between the CPU and all on-chip peripherals.  
MCU REGISTERS  
The registers used by the MCU are summarized in this section.  
Table 56. 8052 SFRs  
SFR  
ACC  
B
PSW  
PCON  
DPL  
DPH  
DPTR  
SP  
Address  
0xE0  
0xF0  
0xD0  
0x87  
0x82  
0x83  
0x82 and 0x83  
0x81  
0xAF  
Bit Addressable  
Description  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Accumulator.  
Auxiliary math.  
Program status word (see Table 57).  
Program control (see Table 58).  
Data pointer low (see Table 59).  
Data pointer high (see Table 60).  
Data pointer (see Table 61).  
Stack pointer (see Table 62).  
Configuration (see Table 63).  
CFG  
Table 57. Program Status Word SFR (PSW, Address 0xD0)  
Bit  
Bit Address  
Mnemonic  
Description  
7
0xD7  
CY  
Carry flag. Modified by ADD, ADDC, SUBB, MUL, and DIV instructions.  
Auxiliary carry flag. Modified by ADD and ADDC instructions.  
General-purpose flag available to the user.  
6
0xD6  
AC  
5
0xD5  
F0  
[4:3]  
0xD4, 0xD3  
RS1, RS0  
Register bank select bits.  
RS1  
0
RS0  
0
Selected Bank  
0
1
2
3
0
1
1
0
1
1
2
1
0
0xD2  
0xD1  
0xD0  
OV  
F1  
P
Overflow flag. Modified by ADD, ADDC, SUBB, MUL, and DIV instructions.  
General-purpose flag available to the user.  
Parity bit. The number of bits set in the accumulator added to the value of the parity bit is  
always an even number.  
Rev. B | Page 82 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 58. Program Control SFR (PCON, Address 0x87)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
SMOD  
0
0
Double baud rate control.  
[6:0]  
Reserved  
Reserved. These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Table 59. Data Pointer Low SFR (DPL, Address 0x82)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
DPL  
0
These bits contain the low byte of the data pointer.  
Table 60. Data Pointer High SFR (DPH, Address 0x83)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
DPH  
0
These bits contain the high byte of the data pointer.  
Table 61. Data Pointer SFR (DPTR, Address 0x82 and Address 0x83)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[15:0]  
DP  
0
These bits contain the 2-byte address of the data pointer. DPTR is a combination of the DPH and DPL  
SFRs.  
Table 62. Stack Pointer SFR (SP, Address 0x81)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
SP  
7
These bits contain the eight LSBs of the pointer for the stack.  
Table 63. Configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
EXTEN  
Default  
Description  
7
1
0
Reserved. This bit should be left set for proper operation.  
Enhanced UART enable bit.  
6
EXTEN  
Result  
0
1
Standard 8052 UART without enhanced error-checking features.  
Enhanced UART with enhanced error checking (see the UART Additional  
Features section).  
5
4
SCPS  
0
0
Synchronous communication selection bit.  
SCPS  
Result  
0
1
I2C port is selected for control of the shared I2C/SPI pins and SFRs.  
SPI port is selected for control of the shared I2C/SPI pins and SFRs.  
MOD38EN  
38 kHz modulation enable bit.  
MOD38EN  
Result  
0
1
38 kHz modulation is disabled.  
38 kHz modulation is enabled on the pins selected by the MOD38[7:0]  
bits in the extended port configuration SFR (EPCFG, Address 0x9F).  
[3:2]  
[1:0]  
Reserved  
00  
01  
Reserved. These bits should be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
XREN1, XREN0  
XREN[1:0]  
Result  
XREN1 OR XREN0 = 1  
XREN1 AND XREN0 = 0  
Enable MOVX instruction to use 256 bytes of extended RAM.  
Disable MOVX instruction.  
Rev. B | Page 83 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
BASIC 8052 REGISTERS  
Program Counter (PC)  
Data Pointer (DPTR)  
The data pointer SFR (DPTR, Address 0x82 and Address 0x83)  
The program counter holds the 2-byte address of the next  
instruction to be fetched. The PC is initialized with 0x00 at reset  
and is incremented after each instruction is performed. Note  
that the amount that is added to the PC depends on the number  
of bytes in the instruction, therefore, the increment can range  
from one to three bytes. The program counter is not directly  
accessible to the user but can be directly modified by CALL and  
JMP instructions that change which part of the program is active.  
is made up of two 8-bit registers: DPL (low byte, Address 0x82),  
and DPH (high byte, Address 0x83). These SFRs provide  
memory addresses for internal code and data access. The DPTR  
can be manipulated as a 16-bit register (DPTR = DPH, DPL) or  
as two independent 8-bit registers (DPH and DPL) (see Table  
59 and Table 60).  
The 8052 MCU core architecture supports dual data pointers  
(see the 8052 MCU Core Architecture section).  
Instruction Register (IR)  
Stack Pointer (SP)  
The instruction register holds the opcode of the instruction  
being executed. The opcode is the binary code that results from  
assembling an instruction. This register is not directly accessible  
to the user.  
The stack pointer SFR (SP, Address 0x81) keeps track of the  
current address of the top of the stack. To push a byte of data  
onto the stack, the stack pointer is incremented and the data is  
moved to the new top of the stack. To pop a byte of data off the  
stack, the top byte of data is moved into the awaiting address  
and the stack pointer is decremented. The stack is a last in, first  
out (LIFO) method of data storage because the most recent  
addition to the stack is the first to come off it.  
Register Banks  
There are four banks, each containing an 8-byte-wide register, for  
a total of 32 bytes of registers. These registers are convenient for  
temporary storage of mathematical operands. An instruction  
involving the accumulator and a register can be executed in one  
clock cycle, as opposed to two clock cycles to perform an  
instruction involving the accumulator and a literal or a byte of  
general-purpose RAM. The register banks are located in the first  
32 bytes of RAM.  
The stack is used during CALL and RET instructions to keep  
track of the address to move into the PC when returning from  
the function call. The stack is also manipulated when vectoring  
for interrupts to keep track of the prior state of the PC.  
The stack resides in the internal extended RAM, and the  
SP register holds the address of the stack in the extended RAM.  
The advantage of this solution is that the stack is segregated to  
the internal XRAM. The use of the general-purpose RAM can  
be limited to data storage. The use of the extended internal  
RAM can be limited to the stack pointer. This separation limits  
the chance of data RAM corruption when the stack pointer  
overflows in data RAM.  
The active register bank is selected by the RS0 and RS1 bits in  
the program status word SFR (PSW, Address 0xD0).  
Accumulator  
The accumulator is a working register, storing the results of  
many arithmetic or logical operations. The accumulator is used  
in more than half of the 8052 instructions where it is usually  
referred to as A. The program status register (PSW) constantly  
monitors the number of bits that are set in the accumulator to  
determine if it has even or odd parity. The accumulator is stored  
in the SFR space (see Table 56).  
Data can still be stored in XRAM by using the MOVX command.  
0xFF  
0x00  
0xFF  
0x00  
B Register  
256 BYTES OF  
RAM  
256 BYTES OF  
ON-CHIP XRAM  
The B register is used by the multiply and divide instructions,  
MUL AB and DIV AB to hold one of the operands. Because it is  
not used for many instructions, it can be used as a scratch pad  
register like those in the register banks. The B register is stored  
in the SFR space (see Table 56).  
(DATA)  
DATA + STACK  
Figure 82. Extended Stack Pointer Operation  
To change the default starting address for the stack, move a  
value into the stack pointer (SP). For example, to enable the  
extended stack pointer and initialize it at the beginning of the  
XRAM space, use the following code:  
Program Status Word (PSW)  
The PSW register (PSW, Address 0xD0) reflects the status of  
arithmetic and logical operations through carry, auxiliary carry,  
and overflow flags. The parity flag reflects the parity of the  
contents of the accumulator, which can be helpful for  
communication protocols. The program status word SFR is bit  
addressable.  
MOV  
SP,#00H  
Rev. B | Page 84 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Power Control Register (PCON, Address 0x87)  
STANDARD 8052 SFRs  
The 8052 core defines two power-down modes: power-down and  
idle. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 enhance the power control capability of the traditional  
8052 MCU with additional power management functions. The  
POWCON register is used to define power control-specific  
functionality for the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569. The program control SFR (PCON, Address  
0x87) is not bit addressable. See the Power Management section.  
The standard 8052 SFRs include the accumulator (ACC), B,  
PSW, DPTR, and SP SFRs, as described in the Basic 8052  
Registers section. The 8052 also defines standard timers, serial  
port interfaces, interrupts, I/O ports, and power-down modes.  
Timer SFRs  
The 8052 contains three 16-bit timers: the identical Timer 0 and  
Timer 1, as well as a Timer 2. These timers can also function as  
event counters. Timer 2 has a capture feature in which the value  
of the timer can be captured in two 8-bit registers upon the  
assertion of an external input signal (see Table 112 and the  
Timers section).  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 have many other peripherals not standard to the  
8052 core:  
ADE energy measurement DSP  
RTC  
LCD driver  
Serial Port SFRs  
The full-duplex serial port peripheral requires two registers, one  
for setting up the baud rate and other communication parameters,  
and another byte for the transmit/receive buffer. The ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 also  
provide enhanced serial port functionality with a dedicated timer  
for baud rate generation with a fractional divisor and additional  
error detection. See Table 139 and the UART Serial Interface  
section.  
Battery switchover/power management  
Temperature ADC  
Battery ADC  
SPI/I2C communication  
Flash memory controller  
Watchdog timer  
Interrupt SFRs  
MEMORY OVERVIEW  
There is a two-tiered interrupt system standard in the 8052 core.  
The priority level for each interrupt source is individually  
selectable as high or low. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 enhance this interrupt system  
by creating, in essence, a third interrupt tier for a highest  
priority power supply management interrupt (PSM). See  
the Interrupt System section.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 contain three memory blocks:  
16 kB of on-chip Flash/EE program and data memory  
256 bytes of general-purpose RAM  
256 bytes of internal extended RAM (XRAM)  
The 256 bytes of general-purpose RAM share the upper 128 bytes  
of its address space with the SFRs. All of the memory spaces are  
shown in Figure 81. The addressing mode specifies which  
memory space to access.  
I/O Port SFRs  
The 8052 core supports four I/O ports, P0 through P3, where  
Port 0 and Port 2 are typically used for access to external code  
and data spaces. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569, unlike standard 8052 products, provide  
internal nonvolatile flash memory so that an external code  
space is unnecessary. The on-chip LCD driver requires many  
pins, some of which are dedicated to LCD functionality, and  
others that can be configured as LCD or general-purpose I/O.  
Due to the limited number of I/O pins, the  
General-Purpose RAM  
General-purpose RAM resides in Memory Location 0x00  
through Memory Location 0xFF. It contains the register banks.  
0x7F  
GENERAL-PURPOSE  
AREA  
0x30  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
0x2F  
do not allow access to external code and data spaces.  
BIT-ADDRESSABLE  
BANKS  
(BIT ADDRESSES)  
SELECTED  
VIA  
BITS IN PSW  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide 20 pins that can be used for general-purpose  
I/O. These pins are mapped to Port 0, Port 1, and Port 2 and are  
accessed through three bit-addressable 8052 SFRs: P0, P1, and  
P2. Another enhanced feature of these parts is that the weak  
pull-ups standard on 8052 Port 1, Port 2, and Port 3 can be  
disabled to make open-drain outputs, as is standard on Port 0.  
The weak pull-ups can be enabled on a pin-by-pin basis. See the  
I/O Ports section.  
0x20  
0x18  
0x10  
0x08  
0x00  
0x1F  
11  
10  
01  
00  
0x17  
0x0F  
0x07  
FOUR BANKS OF EIGHT  
REGISTERS R0 TO R7  
RESET VALUE OF  
STACK POINTER  
Figure 83. Lower 128 Bytes of Internal Data Memory  
Rev. B | Page 85 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Address 0x80 through Address 0xFF of general-purpose RAM  
are shared with the SFRs. The mode of addressing determines  
which memory space is accessed, as shown in Figure 84.  
0xFF  
Special Function Registers (SFRs)  
Special function registers are registers that affect the function of  
the 8052 core or its peripherals. These registers are located in  
RAM at Address 0x80 through Address 0xFF. They are accessible  
only through direct addressing as shown in Figure 84.  
ACCESSIBLE BY  
ACCESSIBLE BY  
INDIRECT ADDRESSING DIRECT ADDRESSING  
ONLY  
ONLY  
0x80  
0x7F  
The individual bits of some of the SFRs can be accessed for use  
in Boolean and program branching instructions. These SFRs are  
labeled as bit-addressable and the bit addresses are given in  
Table 15.  
ACCESSIBLE BY  
DIRECT AND INDIRECT  
ADDRESSING  
0x00  
GENERAL-PURPOSE RAM  
Extended Internal RAM (XRAM)  
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS (SFRs)  
Figure 84. General-Purpose RAM and SFR Memory Address Overlap  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide 256 bytes of extended on-chip RAM. No  
external RAM is supported. This RAM is located in Address  
0x00 through Address 0xFF in the extended RAM space. To  
select the extended RAM memory space, the extended indirect  
addressing modes are used.  
Both direct and indirect addressing can be used to access general-  
purpose RAM from 0x00 through 0x7F, but indirect addressing  
must be used to access general-purpose RAM with addresses in  
the range from 0x80 through 0xFF because they share the same  
address space with the SFRs.  
0x00FF  
The 8052 core also has the means to access individual bits of  
certain addresses in the general-purpose RAM and special  
function memory spaces. The individual bits of general-purpose  
RAM, Address 0x20 to Address 0x2F, can be accessed through  
Bit Address 0x00 to Bit Address 0x7F. The benefit of bit  
addressing is that the individual bits can be accessed quickly,  
without the need for bit masking, which takes more code memory  
and execution time. The bit addresses for general-purpose RAM  
Address 0x20 through Address 0x2F can be seen in Figure 85.  
BYTE  
256 BYTES OF  
EXTENDED INTERNAL  
RAM (XRAM)  
0x0000  
Figure 86. Extended Internal RAM (XRAM) Space  
Code Memory  
Code and data memory is stored in the 16 kB flash memory  
space. No external code memory is supported. To access code  
memory, code indirect addressing is used.  
ADDRESSING MODES  
ADDRESS  
BIT ADDRESSES (HEXA)  
0x2F  
0x2E  
0x2D  
0x2C  
0x2B  
0x2A  
0x29  
0x28  
0x27  
0x26  
0x25  
0x24  
0x23  
0x22  
0x21  
0x20  
7F 7E 7D 7C 7B 7A 79 78  
77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70  
6F 6E 6D 6C 6B 6A 69 68  
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60  
5F 5E 5D 5C 5B 5A 59 58  
57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50  
4F 4E 4D 4C 4B 4A 49 48  
47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40  
3F 3E 3D 3C 3B 3A 39 38  
37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30  
2F 2E 2D 2C 2B 2A 29 28  
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20  
1F 1E 1D 1C 1B 1A 19 18  
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10  
0F 0E 0D 0C 0B 0A 09 08  
07 06 05 04 03 02 01 00  
The 8052 core provides several addressing modes. The  
addressing mode determines how the core interprets the  
memory location or data value specified in assembly language  
code. There are six addressing modes, as shown in Table 64.  
Table 64. 8052 Addressing Modes  
Core Clock  
Addressing Mode Example  
Bytes  
Cycles  
Immediate  
MOV A,#A8h  
2
3
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
2
2
1
2
4
4
4
4
3
MOV DPTR,#A8h  
MOV A, A8h  
MOV A, IE  
Direct  
MOV A, R0  
Indirect  
MOV A, @R0  
MOVX A, @DPTR  
Figure 85. Bit Addressable Area of General-Purpose RAM  
Extended Direct  
Bit addressing can be used for instructions that involve Boolean  
variable manipulation and program branching (see the  
Instruction Set section).  
Extended Indirect MOVX A, @R0  
Code Indirect MOVC A, @A+DPTR  
MOVC A, @A+PC  
JMP @A+ DPTR  
Rev. B | Page 86 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
In extended direct addressing mode, the DPTR register points  
to the address of the byte of extended RAM. The following code  
moves the contents of extended RAM Address 0x100 to the  
Immediate Addressing  
In immediate addressing, the expression entered after the  
number sign (#) is evaluated by the assembler and stored in the  
memory address specified. This number is referred to as a literal  
because it refers only to a value and not to a memory location.  
accumulator:  
MOV  
DPTR,#100h  
A,@DPTR  
MOVX  
Instructions using this addressing mode are slower than those  
between two registers because the literal must be stored and  
fetched from memory. The expression can be entered as a  
symbolic variable or as an arithmetic expression; the value is  
computed by the assembler.  
These two instructions require a total of seven clock cycles and  
four bytes of storage in the program memory.  
Extended Indirect Addressing  
The internal extended RAM is accessed through a pointer to the  
address in indirect addressing mode. The ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 have 256 bytes of  
internal extended RAM, accessed through MOVX instructions.  
External memory is not supported on the devices.  
Direct Addressing  
With direct addressing, the value at the source address is moved  
to the destination address. Direct addressing provides the fastest  
execution time of all the addressing modes when an instruction  
is performed between registers. Note that indirect or direct  
addressing modes can be used to access general-purpose RAM  
Address 0x00 through Address 0x7F. An instruction with direct  
addressing that uses an address between 0x80 and 0xFF refers to  
a special function memory location.  
In extended indirect addressing mode, a register holds the address  
of the byte of extended RAM. The following code moves the  
contents of extended RAM Address 0x80 to the accumulator:  
MOV  
R0,#80h  
A,@R0  
MOVX  
Indirect Addressing  
These two instructions require six clock cycles and three bytes  
of storage.  
With indirect addressing, the value pointed to by the register is  
moved to the destination address. For example, to move the  
contents of internal RAM Address 0x82 to the accumulator, use  
the following two instructions, which require a total of four  
clock cycles and three bytes of storage in the program memory:  
Note that there are 256 bytes of extended RAM, so both extended  
direct and extended indirect addressing can cover the whole  
address range. There is a storage and speed advantage to using  
extended indirect addressing because the additional byte of  
addressing available through the DPTR register that is not  
needed is not stored.  
MOV  
MOV  
R0,#82h  
A,@R0  
Indirect addressing allows addresses to be computed and is  
useful for indexing into data arrays stored in RAM.  
From the three examples demonstrating the access of internal  
RAM from 0x80 through 0xFF and extended internal RAM  
from 0x00 through 0xFF, it can be seen that it is most efficient  
to use the entire internal RAM accessible through indirect  
access before moving to extended RAM.  
Note that an instruction that refers to Address 0x00 through  
Address 0x7F is referring to internal RAM, and indirect or  
direct addressing mode can be used. An instruction with  
indirect addressing that uses an address between 0x80 and 0xFF  
refers to internal RAM, not to an SFR.  
Code Indirect Addressing  
The internal code memory can be accessed indirectly. This can  
be useful for implementing lookup tables and other arrays of  
constants that are stored in flash memory. For example, to move  
the data stored in flash memory at Address 0x8002 into the  
accumulator, use the following code:  
Extended Direct Addressing  
The DPTR register (see Table 61) is used to access internal  
extended RAM in extended indirect addressing mode. The  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
have 256 bytes of XRAM, accessed through MOVX instructions.  
External memory spaces are not supported on this device.  
MOV  
DPTR,#8002h  
A
CLR  
MOVX  
A,@A+DPTR  
The accumulator can be used as a variable index into the array  
of flash memory located at DPTR.  
Rev. B | Page 87 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
INSTRUCTION SET  
Table 65 documents the number of clock cycles required for each instruction. Most instructions are executed in one or two clock cycles,  
resulting in a 4-MIPS peak performance. Note that throughout this section, A represents the accumulator.  
Table 65. Instruction Set  
Mnemonic  
Arithmetic  
ADD A,Rn  
ADD A,@Ri  
ADD A,dir  
ADD A,#data  
ADDC A,Rn  
ADDC A,@Ri  
ADDC A,dir  
ADDC A,#data  
SUBB A,Rn  
SUBB A,@Ri  
SUBB A,dir  
SUBB A,#data  
INC A  
INC Rn  
INC @  
INC dir  
INC DPTR  
DEC A  
DEC Rn  
DEC @Ri  
DEC dir  
MUL AB  
Description  
Bytes  
Cycles  
Add register to A  
Add indirect memory to A  
Add direct byte to A  
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
1
1
2
2
3
1
1
2
2
9
9
2
Add immediate to A  
Add register to A with carry  
Add indirect memory to A with carry  
Add direct byte to A with carry  
Add immediate to A with carry  
Subtract register from A with borrow  
Subtract indirect memory from A with borrow  
Subtract direct from A with borrow  
Subtract immediate from A with borrow  
Increment A  
Increment register  
Ri increment indirect memory  
Increment direct byte  
Increment data pointer  
Decrement A  
Decrement register  
Decrement indirect memory  
Decrement direct byte  
Multiply A by B  
Divide A by B  
Decimal adjust A  
DIV AB  
DA A A  
Logic  
ANL A,Rn  
ANL A,@Ri  
ANL A,dir  
ANL A,#data  
ANL dir,A  
ANL dir,#data  
ORL A,Rn  
ORL A,@Ri  
ORL A,dir  
ORL A,#data  
ORL dir,A  
ORL dir,#data  
XRL A,Rn  
XRL A,@Ri  
XRL A,#data  
XRL dir,A  
XRL A,dir  
XRL dir,#data  
CLR A  
AND register to A  
AND indirect memory to A  
AND direct byte to A  
AND immediate to A  
AND A to direct byte  
AND immediate data to direct byte  
OR register to A  
OR indirect memory to A  
OR direct byte to A  
OR immediate to A  
OR A to direct byte  
OR immediate data to direct byte  
Exclusive-OR register to A  
Exclusive-OR indirect memory to A  
Exclusive-OR immediate to A  
Exclusive-OR A to direct byte  
Exclusive-OR indirect memory to A  
Exclusive-OR immediate data to direct  
Clear A  
1
1
2
2
2
3
1
1
2
2
2
3
1
2
2
2
2
3
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
3
1
2
2
2
2
3
1
2
2
2
2
3
1
1
1
1
CPL A  
SWAP A  
RL A  
Complement A  
Swap nibbles of A  
Rotate A left  
Rev. B | Page 88 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Mnemonic  
RLC A  
RR A  
Description  
Bytes  
Cycles  
Rotate A left through carry  
Rotate A right  
Rotate A right through carry  
1
1
1
1
1
1
RRC A  
Data Transfer  
MOV A,Rn  
MOV A,@Ri  
MOV Rn,A  
MOV @Ri,A  
MOV A,dir  
MOV A,#data  
MOV Rn,#data  
MOV dir,A  
MOV Rn,dir  
MOV dir,Rn  
MOV @Ri,#data  
MOV dir,@Ri  
MOV @Ri,dir  
MOV dir,dir  
MOV dir,#data  
MOV DPTR,#data  
MOVC A,@A+DPTR  
MOVC A,@A+PC  
MOVX A,@Ri  
MOVX A,@DPTR  
MOVX @Ri,A  
MOVX @DPTR,A  
PUSH dir  
Move register to A  
Move indirect memory to A  
Move A to register  
Move A to indirect memory  
Move direct byte to A  
Move immediate to A  
Move register to immediate  
Move A to direct byte  
Move register to direct byte  
Move direct to register  
Move immediate to indirect memory  
Move indirect to direct memory  
Move direct to indirect memory  
Move direct byte to direct byte  
Move immediate to direct byte  
Move immediate to data pointer  
Move code byte relative DPTR to A  
Move code byte relative PC to A  
Move external (A8) data to A  
Move external (A16) data to A  
Move A to external data (A8)  
Move A to external data (A16)  
Push direct byte onto stack  
Pop direct byte from stack  
Exchange A and register  
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
2
2
1
2
2
2
POP dir  
XCH A,Rn  
XCH A,@Ri  
XCHD A,@Ri  
XCH A,dir  
Exchange A and indirect memory  
Exchange A and indirect memory nibble  
Exchange A and direct byte  
Boolean  
CLR C  
CLR bit  
SETB C  
SETB bit  
CPL C  
CPL bit  
ANL C,bit  
ANL C,/bit  
ORL C,bit  
ORL C,/bit OR  
MOV C,bit  
MOV bit,C  
Branching  
JMP @A+DPTR  
RET  
Clear carry  
Clear direct bit  
Set carry  
Set direct bit  
Complement carry  
Complement direct bit  
AND direct bit and carry  
AND direct bit inverse to carry  
OR direct bit and carry  
Direct bit inverse to carry  
Move direct bit to carry  
Move carry to direct bit  
1
2
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Jump indirect relative to DPTR  
Return from subroutine  
Return from interrupt  
Absolute jump to subroutine  
Absolute jump unconditional  
Short jump (relative address)  
Jump on carry equal to 1  
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
3
4
4
3
3
3
3
RETI  
ACALL addr11  
AJMP addr11  
SJMP rel  
JC rel  
Rev. B | Page 89 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Mnemonic  
JNC rel  
JZ rel  
JNZ rel  
DJNZ Rn,rel  
LJMP  
LCALL addr16  
JB bit,rel  
JNB bit,rel  
Description  
Bytes  
Cycles  
Jump on carry equal to 0  
Jump on accumulator = 0  
Jump on accumulator ≠ 0  
Decrement register, JNZ relative  
Long jump unconditional  
Long jump to subroutine  
Jump on direct bit = 1  
Jump on direct bit = 0  
Jump on direct bit = 1 and clear  
Compare A, direct JNE relative  
Compare A, immediate JNE relative  
Compare register, immediate JNE relative  
Compare indirect, immediate JNE relative  
Decrement direct byte, JNZ relative  
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
JBC bit,rel  
CJNE A,dir,rel  
CJNE A,#data,rel  
CJNE Rn,#data,rel  
CJNE @Ri,#data,rel  
DJNZ dir,rel  
MISCELLANEOUS  
NOP  
No operation  
1
1
INSTRUCTIONS THAT AFFECT FLAGS  
READ-MODIFY-WRITE INSTRUCTIONS  
Many instructions explicitly modify the carry bit, such as the  
MOV C bit and CLR C instructions. Other instructions that  
affect status flags are listed in this section.  
Some 8052 instructions read the latch and others read the pin.  
The state of the pin is read for instructions that input a port bit.  
Instructions that read the latch rather than the pins are the ones  
that read a value, possibly change it, and rewrite it to the latch.  
Because these instructions involve modifying the port, it is  
assumed that the pins being modified are outputs, so the output  
state of the pin is read from the latch. This prevents a possible  
misinterpretation of the voltage level of a pin. For example, if a  
port pin is used to drive the base of a transistor, a 1 is written to  
the bit to turn on the transistor. If the CPU reads the same port  
bit at the pin rather than the latch, it reads the base voltage of  
the transistor and interprets it as Logic 0. Reading the latch  
rather than the pin returns the correct value of 1.  
ADD A, Source  
This instruction adds the source to the accumulator. No status  
flags are referenced by the instruction.  
Table 67. ADD A (Source) Affected Status Flags  
Flag  
Description  
C
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 7. Cleared otherwise.  
Used to indicate an overflow if the operands are  
unsigned.  
OV  
AC  
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 6 or a carry out of Bit 7,  
but not if both are set. Used to indicate an overflow for  
signed addition. This flag is set if two positive operands  
yield a negative result or if two negative operands yield  
a positive result.  
The instructions that read the latch rather than the pins are  
called read-modify-write instructions and are listed in Table 66.  
When the destination operand is a port or a port bit, these  
instructions read the latch rather than the pin.  
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 3. Cleared otherwise.  
Table 66. Read-Modify-Write Instructions  
ADDC A, Source  
Instruction Example  
Description  
Logic AND  
Logic OR  
This instruction adds the source and the carry bit to the accu-  
mulator. The carry status flag is referenced by the instruction.  
ANL  
ORL  
XRL  
JBC  
ANL P0,A  
ORL P1,A  
XRL P2,A  
Logic EX-OR  
Table 68. ADDC A (Source) Affected Flags  
JBC P1.1,LABEL Jump if bit = 1 and clear bit  
Flag  
Description  
CPL  
INC  
CPL P2.0  
INC P2  
Complement bit  
Increment  
C
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 7. Cleared otherwise.  
Used to indicate an overflow if the operands are  
unsigned.  
DEC  
DJNZ  
DEC P2  
Decrement  
DJNZ P0,LABEL Decrement and jump if not zero  
OV  
AC  
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 6 or a carry out of Bit 7, but  
not if both are set. Used to indicate an overflow for  
signed addition. This flag is set if two positive operands  
yield a negative result or if two negative operands yield  
a positive result.  
MOV PX.Y,C1 MOV P0.0,C  
Move carry to Bit Y of Port X  
Clear Bit Y of Port X  
Set Bit Y of Port X  
CLR PX.Y1  
SETB PX.Y1  
CLR P0.0  
SETB P0.0  
1 These instructions read the port byte (all eight bits), modify the addressed  
bit, and write the new byte back to the latch.  
Set if there is a carry out of Bit 3. Cleared otherwise.  
Rev. B | Page 90 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
SUBB A, Source  
to correct the lower four bits. If the carry bit is set when the  
instruction begins, or if 0x06 is added to the accumulator in the  
first step, 0x60 is added to the accumulator to correct the higher  
This instruction subtracts the source byte and the carry  
(borrow) flag from the accumulator. It references the carry  
(borrow) status flag.  
four bits.  
The carry and AC status flags are referenced by this instruction.  
Table 69. SUBB A (Source) Affected Status Flags  
Flag  
Description  
Table 72. DA A Affected Status Flag  
C
Set if there is a borrow needed for Bit 7. Cleared  
otherwise. Used to indicate an overflow if the  
operands are unsigned.  
Set if there is a borrow needed for Bit 6 or Bit 7, but  
not for both. Used to indicate an overflow for signed  
subtraction. This flag is set if a negative number  
subtracted from a positive number yields a negative  
result or if a positive number subtracted from a  
negative number yields a positive result.  
Flag  
Description  
C
Set if the result is greater than 0x99. Cleared  
otherwise.  
OV  
RRC A  
This instruction rotates the accumulator to the right through  
the carry flag. The old LSB of the accumulator becomes the new  
carry flag, and the old carry flag is loaded into the new MSB of  
the accumulator.  
AC  
Set if a borrow is needed for Bit 3. Cleared otherwise.  
The carry status flag is referenced by this instruction.  
MUL AB  
This instruction multiplies the accumulator by the B SFR. This  
operation is unsigned. The lower byte of the 16-bit product is  
stored in the accumulator and the higher byte is left in the B  
register. No status flags are referenced by the instruction.  
Table 73. RRC A Affected Status Flag  
Flag  
Description  
C
Equal to the state of ACC[0] before execution of the  
instruction.  
RLC A  
Table 70. MUL AB Affected Status Flags  
This instruction rotates the accumulator to the left through the  
carry flag. The old MSB of the accumulator becomes the new  
carry flag, and the old carry flag is loaded into the new LSB of  
the accumulator.  
Flag  
Description  
C
OV  
Cleared  
Set if the result is greater than 255. Cleared otherwise.  
DIV AB  
The carry status flag is referenced by this instruction.  
This instruction divides the accumulator by the B SFR. This  
operation is unsigned. The integer part of the quotient is stored  
in the accumulator and the remainder goes into the B register.  
No status flags are referenced by the instruction.  
Table 74. RLC A Affected Status Flag  
Flag  
Description  
C
Equal to the state of ACC[7] before execution of the  
instruction.  
Table 71. DIV AB Affected Status Flags  
Flag  
CJNE Destination, Source, Relative Jump  
Description  
This instruction compares the source value to the destination  
value and branches to the location set by the relative jump if  
they are not equal. If the values are equal, program execution  
continues with the instruction after the CJNE instruction.  
C
OV  
Cleared  
Cleared unless the B register is equal to 0, in which  
case the results of the division are undefined and the  
OV flag is set.  
DA A  
No status flags are referenced by this instruction.  
This instruction adjusts the accumulator to hold two 4-bit digits  
after the addition of two binary coded decimals (BCDs) with  
the ADD or ADDC instructions. If the AC bit is set or if the value  
of Bit 0 to Bit 3 exceeds 9, 0x06 is added to the accumulator  
Table 75. CJNE Destination (Source, Relative Jump) Affected  
Status Flags  
Flag  
Description  
C
Set if the source value is greater than the destination  
value. Cleared otherwise.  
Rev. B | Page 91 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
DUAL DATA POINTERS  
MOV DPTR,#0  
;Main DPTR = 0  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 incorporates two data pointers. The second data  
pointer is a shadow data pointer and is selected via the data  
pointer control SFR (DPCON, Address 0xA7). DPCON features  
automatic hardware postincrement and postdecrement, as well as  
an automatic data pointer toggle.  
MOV DPCON,#55H  
;Select shadow DPTR  
;DPTR1 increment mode  
;DPTR0 increment mode  
;DPTR auto toggling ON  
MOV DPTR,#0D000H ;DPTR = D000H  
MOVELOOP: CLR A  
Note that this is the only section of the data sheet where the  
main and shadow data pointers are distinguished. Whenever the  
data pointer (DPTR) is mentioned elsewhere in the data sheet,  
active DPTR is implied.  
MOVC A,@A+DPTR  
;Post Inc DPTR  
;Get data  
;Swap to Main DPTR(Data)  
MOVX @DPTR,A  
In addition, only the MOVC/MOVX @DPTR instructions  
automatically postincrement and postdecrement the DPTR.  
Other MOVC/MOVX instructions, such as MOVC PC  
or MOVC @Ri, do not cause the DPTR to automatically  
postincrement and postdecrement.  
;Put ACC in XRAM  
;Increment main DPTR  
;Swap Shadow DPTR(Code)  
MOV A, DPL  
To illustrate the operation of DPCON, the following code copies  
256 bytes of code memory at Address 0xD000 into XRAM,  
starting from Address 0x0000:  
JNZ MOVELOOP  
Table 76. Data Pointer Control SFR (DPCON, Address 0xA7)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
0
0
Not implemented. Write don’t care.  
6
DPT  
Data pointer automatic toggle enable. Cleared by the user to disable autoswapping of the DPTR.  
Set in user software to enable automatic toggling of the DPTR after each MOVX or MOVC instruction.  
[5:4]  
DP1m1,  
DP1m0  
0
Shadow data pointer mode. These bits enable extra modes of the shadow data pointer operation,  
allowing more compact and more efficient code size and execution.  
DP1m1  
DP1m0  
Result (Behavior of the Shadow Data Pointer)  
8052 behavior.  
DPTR is postincremented after a MOVX or a MOVC instruction.  
DPTR is postdecremented after a MOVX or MOVC instruction.  
DPTR LSB is toggled after a MOVX or MOVC instruction. This instruction can be  
useful for moving 8-bit blocks to/from 16-bit devices.  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
[3:2]  
DP0m1,  
DP0m0  
0
Main data pointer mode. These bits enable extra modes of the main data pointer operation, allowing  
more compact and more efficient code size and execution.  
DP0m1  
DP0m0  
Result (Behavior of the Main Data Pointer)  
8052 behavior.  
DPTR is postincremented after a MOVX or a MOVC instruction.  
DPTR is postdecremented after a MOVX or MOVC instruction.  
DPTR LSB is toggled after a MOVX or MOVC instruction. This instruction is useful  
for moving 8-bit blocks to/from 16-bit devices.  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Not implemented. Write don’t care.  
DPSEL  
Data pointer select. Cleared by the user to select the main data pointer, meaning that the contents of  
this 16-bit register are placed into the DPL SFR and DPH SFR. Set by the user to select the shadow data  
pointer, meaning that the contents of a separate 16-bit register appear in the DPL SFR and DPH SFR.  
Rev. B | Page 92 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
INTERRUPT SYSTEM  
The unique power management architecture of the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 includes  
an operating mode (PSM2) where the 8052 MCU core is shut  
down. Events can be configured to wake the 8052 MCU core  
from the PSM2 operating mode. A distinction is drawn here  
between events that can trigger the wake-up of the 8052 MCU  
core and events that can trigger an interrupt when the MCU  
core is active. Events that can wake the core are referred to as  
wake-up events, whereas events that can interrupt the program  
flow when the MCU is active are called interrupts. See the 3.3 V  
Peripherals and Wake-Up Events section to learn more about  
events that can wake the 8052 core from PSM2 mode.  
A Priority 1 interrupt can interrupt the service routine of a  
Priority 0 interrupt, and if two interrupts of different priorities  
occur at the same time, the Priority 1 interrupt is serviced first.  
An interrupt cannot be interrupted by another interrupt of the  
same priority level. If two interrupts of the same priority level  
occur simultaneously, a polling sequence is observed. See the  
Interrupt Priority section.  
INTERRUPT ARCHITECTURE  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 possess advanced power supply management  
features. To ensure a fast response to time-critical power supply  
issues, such as a loss of line power, the power supply manage-  
ment interrupt should be able to interrupt any interrupt service  
routine. To enable the user to have full use of the standard 8052  
interrupt priority levels, an additional priority level is added for the  
power supply management (PSM) interrupt. The PSM interrupt  
is the only interrupt at this highest interrupt priority level.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide 12 interrupt sources with three priority levels.  
The power management interrupt is at the highest priority level.  
The other two priority levels are configurable through the  
interrupt priority SFR (IP, Address 0xB8) and the interrupt  
enable and Priority 2 SFR (IEIP2, Address 0xA9).  
HIGH  
PSM  
STANDARD 8052 INTERRUPT ARCHITECTURE  
PRIORITY 1  
The standard 8052 interrupt architecture includes two tiers of  
interrupts, where some interrupts are assigned a high priority  
and others are assigned a low priority.  
PRIORITY 0  
LOW  
Figure 88. Interrupt Architecture  
HIGH  
See the Power Supply Management (PSM) Interrupt section for  
more information on the PSM interrupt.  
PRIORITY 1  
PRIORITY 0  
LOW  
INTERRUPT REGISTERS  
Figure 87. Standard 8052 Interrupt Priority Levels  
The control and configuration of the interrupt system are carried  
out through four interrupt-related SFRs, discussed in this section.  
Table 77. Interrupt SFRs  
SFR  
Address Default Bit Addressable Description  
IE  
IP  
0xA8  
0xB8  
0xA9  
0x00  
0x00  
0xA0  
0x10  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Interrupt enable (see Table 78).  
Interrupt priority (see Table 79).  
Interrupt enable and Priority 2 (see Table 80).  
Watchdog timer (see Table 85 and the Writing to the Watchdog Timer SFR (WDCON,  
Address 0xC0) section).  
IEIP2  
WDCON 0xC0  
Table 78. Interrupt Enable SFR (IE, Address 0xA8)  
Bit Bit Address  
Mnemonic  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0xAF  
0xAE  
0xAD  
0xAC  
0xAB  
0xAA  
0xA9  
0xA8  
EA  
ETEMP1  
ET2  
ES  
ET1  
Enables all interrupt sources. Set by the user. Cleared by the user to disable all interrupt sources.  
Enables the temperature ADC interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables the Timer 2 interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables the UART serial port interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables the Timer 1 interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables External Interrupt 1 (INT1). Set by the user.  
Enables the Timer 0 interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables External Interrupt 0 (INT0). Set by the user.  
EX1  
ET0  
EX0  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Rev. B | Page 93 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 79. Interrupt Priority SFR (IP, Address 0xB8)  
Bit  
Bit Address  
Mnemonic  
PADE  
PTEMP  
PT2  
PS  
PT1  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
0xBF  
0xBE  
0xBD  
0xBC  
0xBB  
ADE energy measurement interrupt Priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
Temperature ADC interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
Timer 2 interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
UART serial port interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
Timer 1 interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
INT1 (External Interrupt 1) priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
Timer 0 interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
INT0 (External Interrupt 0) priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
0xBA  
PX1  
1
0
0xB9  
0xB8  
PT0  
PX0  
Table 80. Interrupt Enable and Priority 2 SFR (IEIP2, Address 0xA9)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Description  
7
Reserved  
6
PTI  
RTC interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
PSI  
EADE  
ETI  
EPSM  
ESI  
SPI/I2C interrupt priority (1 = high, 0 = low).  
Enables the energy metering interrupt (ADE). Set by the user.  
Enables the RTC interval timer interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables the PSM power supply management interrupt. Set by the user.  
Enables the SPI/I2C interrupt. Set by the user.  
INTERRUPT PRIORITY  
If two interrupts of the same priority level occur simultaneously, the polling sequence is observed (as shown in Table 81).  
Table 81. Priority Within Interrupt Level  
Source  
IPSM  
IRTC  
IADE  
WDT  
ITEMP1  
IE0  
Priority  
Description  
0 (highest)  
1
2
3
4
5
Power supply monitor interrupt.  
RTC interval timer interrupt.  
ADE energy measurement interrupt.  
Watchdog timer overflow interrupt.  
Temperature ADC interrupt  
External interrupt 0.  
TF0  
IE1  
6
7
Timer/Counter 0 interrupt.  
External Interrupt 1.  
TF1  
ISPI/I2CI  
RI/TI  
8
9
10  
Timer/Counter 1 Interrupt.  
SPI/I2C interrupt.  
UART serial port interrupt.  
Timer/Counter 2 interrupt.  
TF2/EXF2  
11 (lowest)  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Rev. B | Page 94 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
INTERRUPT FLAGS  
The interrupt flags and status flags associated with the interrupt vectors are shown in Table 82 and Table 83. Most of the interrupts have  
flags associated with them.  
Table 82. Interrupt Flags  
Interrupt Source  
Flag  
Bit Name  
IE0  
Description  
IE0  
TCON.1  
TCON.5  
TCON.3  
TCON.7  
SCON.1  
SCON.0  
T2CON.7  
T2CON.6  
N/A  
External interrupt 0.  
TF0  
IE1  
TF0  
Timer 0.  
IE1  
External interrupt 1.  
TF1  
RI + TI  
TF1  
Timer 1.  
TI  
Transmit interrupt.  
RI  
Receive interrupt.  
TF2 + EXF2  
TF2  
Timer 2 overflow flag.  
EXF2  
N/A  
FPSM  
Timer 2 external flag.  
ITEMP (Temperature ADC)1  
IPSM (Power Supply)  
Temperature ADC interrupt. Does not have an interrupt flag associated with it.  
PSM interrupt flag.  
IPSMF.6  
IADE (Energy Measurement DSP) MIRQSTL.7 ADEIRQFLAG Read MIRQSTH, MIRQSTM, MIRQSTL.  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Table 83. Status Flags  
Interrupt Source  
ITEMP (Temperature ADC)1  
ISPI/I2CI  
Flag  
Bit Address Description  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
Temperature ADC interrupt. Does not have a status flag associated with it.  
SPI2CSTAT  
SPI2CSTAT  
SPI interrupt status register.  
I2C interrupt status register.  
RTC midnight flag.  
IRTC (RTC Interval Timer)  
WDT (Watchdog Timer)  
TIMECON.7 MIDNIGHT  
TIMECON.2 ALARM  
RTC alarm flag.  
WDCON.2  
WDS  
Watchdog timeout flag.  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
A functional block diagram of the interrupt system is shown in  
Figure 89. Note that the PSM interrupt is the only interrupt in  
the highest priority level.  
interrupt. Similarly, clearing the I2C/SPI status bits in the SPI  
Interrupt Status SFR (SPISTAT, Address 0xEA) does not cancel  
a pending I2C/SPI interrupt. These interrupts remain pending  
until the RTC or I2C/SPI interrupt vectors are enabled. Their  
respective interrupt service routines are entered shortly  
thereafter.  
If an external wake-up event occurs to wake the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 from PSM2  
mode, a pending external interrupt is generated. When the EX0  
bit (Bit 0) or the EX1 bit (Bit 2) in the interrupt enable SFR (IE,  
Address 0xA8) is set to enable external interrupts, the program  
counter is loaded with the IE0 or IE1 interrupt vector. The IE0  
and IE1 interrupt flags (Bit 1 and Bit 3, respectively) in the  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 control SFR (TCON,  
Address 0x88) are not affected by events that occur when the  
8052 MCU core is shut down during PSM2. See the Power  
Supply Management (PSM) Interrupt section.  
Figure 89 shows how the interrupts are cleared when the  
interrupt service routines are entered. Some interrupts with  
multiple interrupt sources are not automatically cleared;  
specifically, the PSM, ADE, UART, and Timer 2 interrupt  
INT0  
INT1  
vectors. Note that the  
and  
interrupts are only  
cleared only if the external interrupt is configured to be  
triggered by a falling edge by setting IT0 (Bit 0) in the  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 control SFR (TCON,  
The RTC, temperature ADC, and I2C/SPI interrupts are latched  
such that pending interrupts cannot be cleared without entering  
their respective interrupt service routines. Clearing the RTC  
midnight flags and alarm flags does not clear a pending RTC  
INT0 INT1  
Address 0x88). If  
or  
is configured to interrupt on a  
low level, the interrupt service routine is reentered until the  
respective pin goes high.  
Rev. B | Page 95 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PRIORITY LEVEL  
IE/IEIP2 REGISTERS  
IP/IEIP2 REGISTERS  
LOW  
HIGH HIGHEST  
IPSMF  
IPSME  
FPSM  
(IPSMF.6)  
PSM  
IN OUT  
LATCH  
RESET  
MIDNIGHT  
ALARM  
RTC  
MIRQSTH MIRQSTM MIRQSTL  
MIRQENH MIRQENM MIRQENL  
ADE  
MIRQSTL.7  
WATCHDOG TIMEOUT  
WDIR  
WATCHDOG  
TEMP ADC*  
IN OUT  
LATCH  
TEMPADC INTERRUPT  
RESET  
PSM2  
IT0  
0
INT0  
EXTERNAL  
INTERRUPT 0  
IE0  
1
IT0  
TF0  
INTERRUPT  
POLLING  
SEQUENCE  
TIMER 0  
PSM2  
IE1  
IT1  
0
EXTERNAL  
INTERRUPT 1  
INT1  
1
IT1  
TF1  
TIMER 1  
CFG.5  
SPI INTERRUPT  
IN OUT  
LATCH  
1
2
I C/SPI  
2
I C INTERRUPT  
RESET  
0
RI  
TI  
UART  
TF2  
TIMER 2  
EXF2  
INDIVIDUAL  
INTERRUPT  
ENABLE  
LEGEND  
AUTOMATIC  
CLEAR SIGNAL  
GLOBAL  
INTERRUPT  
ENABLE (EA)  
*NOT AVAILABLE IN THE ADE7116.  
Figure 89. Interrupt System Functional Block Diagram  
Rev. B | Page 96 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
INTERRUPT VECTORS  
CONTEXT SAVING  
When an interrupt occurs, the program counter is pushed  
onto the stack, and the corresponding interrupt vector address  
is loaded into the program counter. When the interrupt service  
routine is complete, the program counter is popped off the stack  
by an RETI instruction. This allows program execution to resume  
from where it was interrupted. The interrupt vector addresses  
are shown in Table 84.  
When the 8052 vectors to an interrupt, only the program counter  
is saved on the stack. Therefore, the interrupt service routine  
must be written to ensure that registers used in the main  
program are restored to their pre-interrupt state. Common  
SFRs that can be modified in the ISR are the accumulator  
register and the PSW register. Any general-purpose registers  
that are used as scratch pads in the ISR should also be restored  
before exiting the interrupt. The following example 8052 code  
shows how to restore some commonly used registers:  
Table 84. Interrupt Vector Addresses  
Source  
Vector Address  
0x0003  
0x000B  
0x0013  
0x001B  
0x0023  
0x002B  
0x0033  
0x003B  
0x0043  
0x004B  
0x0053  
0x005B  
GeneralISR:  
IE0  
TF0  
IE1  
TF1  
; save the current Accumulator value  
PUSH  
ACC  
; save the current status and register bank  
selection  
RI + TI  
TF2 + EXF2  
ITEMP (Temperature ADC)1  
ISPI/I2CI  
IPSM (Power Supply)  
IADE (Energy Measurement DSP)  
IRTC (RTC Interval Timer)  
WDT (Watchdog Timer)  
PUSH  
PSW  
; service interrupt  
; restore the status and register bank  
selection  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
POP  
PSW  
; restore the accumulator  
INTERRUPT LATENCY  
POP  
ACC  
The 8052 architecture requires that at least one instruction  
execute between interrupts. To ensure this, the 8052 MCU  
core hardware prevents the program counter from jumping to  
an ISR immediately after completing an RETI instruction or an  
access of the IP and IE SFRs.  
RETI  
The shortest interrupt latency is 3.25 instruction cycles, 800 ns  
with a clock of 4.096 MHz. The longest interrupt latency for a  
high priority interrupt results when a pending interrupt is  
generated during a low priority interrupt RETI, followed by a  
multiply instruction. This results in a maximum interrupt  
latency of 16.25 instruction cycles, 4 μs with a clock of 4.096 MHz.  
Rev. B | Page 97 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
WATCHDOG TIMER  
The watchdog timer generates a device reset or interrupt within  
a reasonable amount of time if the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/  
ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 enter an erroneous state, possibly  
due to a programming error or electrical noise. The watchdog is  
enabled by default with a timeout of two seconds and creates a  
system reset if not cleared within two seconds. The watchdog  
function can be disabled by clearing the watchdog enable bit  
(WDE, Bit 1) in the watchdog timer SFR (WDCON, Address  
0xC0).  
The WDCON SFR can be written to by user software only if the  
double write sequence described in Table 85 is initiated on  
every write access to the WDCON SFR.  
To prevent any code from inadvertently disabling the watchdog, a  
watchdog protection can be activated. This watchdog protection  
locks in the watchdog enable and event settings so they cannot  
be changed by user code. The protection is activated by clearing  
a watchdog protection bit in the flash memory. The watchdog  
protection bit is the most significant bit at Address 0x3FFA of  
the flash memory. When this bit is cleared, the WDIR bit (Bit 3) is  
forced to 0, and the WDE bit is forced to 1. Note that the  
sequence for configuring the flash protection bits must be  
followed to modify the watchdog protection bit at Address  
0x3FFA (see the Protecting the Flash section).  
The watchdog circuit generates a system reset or interrupt  
(WDS, Bit 2) if the user program fails to set the WDE bit within  
a predetermined amount of time (set by the PRE bits).  
The watchdog timer is clocked from the 32.768 kHz external  
crystal connected between the XTAL1 and XTAL2 pins.  
Table 85. Watchdog Timer SFR (WDCON, Address 0xC0)  
Bit  
Address  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:4]  
0xC7 to  
0xC4  
PRE  
7
Watchdog prescaler. In normal mode, the 16-bit watchdog timer is clocked by the input  
clock (32.768 kHz). The PRE bits set which of the upper bits of the counter are used as the  
watchdog output, as follows:  
29  
tWATCHDOG = 2PRE  
×
CLKIN  
PRE  
Result (Watchdog Timeout)  
0000  
0001  
0010  
0011  
0100  
0101  
0110  
0111  
1000  
1001  
15.6 ms  
31.2 ms  
62.5 ms  
125 ms  
250 ms  
500 ms  
1 sec  
2 sec  
0 sec, automatic reset  
0 sec, serial download reset  
Not a valid selection  
1010 to 1111  
3
2
0xC3  
0xC2  
WDIR  
WDS  
0
0
Watchdog interrupt response bit. When cleared, the watchdog generates a system reset  
when the watchdog timeout period has expired. When set, the watchdog generates an  
interrupt when the watchdog timeout period has expired.  
Watchdog status bit. This bit is set to indicate that a watchdog timeout has occurred. It is  
cleared by writing a 0 or by an external hardware reset. A watchdog reset does not clear  
WDS; therefore, it can be used to distinguish between a watchdog reset and a hardware  
reset from the RESET pin.  
1
0
0xC1  
0xC0  
WDE  
1
0
Watchdog enable bit. When set, this bit enables the watchdog and clears its counter. The  
watchdog counter is subsequently cleared again whenever WDE is set. If the watchdog is  
not cleared within its selected timeout period, it generates a system reset or watchdog  
interrupt, depending on the WDIR bit.  
WDWR  
Watchdog write enable bit (see the Writing to the Watchdog Timer SFR (WDCON, Address  
0xC0) section).  
Rev. B | Page 98 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 86. Watchdog and Flash Protection Byte in Flash (Flash Address = 0x3FFA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
WDPROT_PROTKY7  
1
This bit holds the protection for the watchdog timer and the seventh bit of the flash protection key.  
When this bit is cleared, the watchdog enable and event bits WDE and WDIR cannot be changed  
by user code. The watchdog configuration is then fixed to WDIR = 0 and WDE = 1. The watchdog  
timeout in the PRE bits can still be modified by user code.  
The value of this bit is also used to set the flash protection key. If this bit is cleared to protect the  
watchdog, then the default value for the flash protection key is 0x7F instead of 0xFF (see the  
Protecting the Flash section for more information on how to clear this bit).  
[6:0]  
PROTKY[6:0]  
0xFF  
These bits hold the flash protection key. The content of this flash address is compared to the  
flash protection key SFR (PROTKY, Address 0xBB) when the protection is being set or changed. If  
the two values match, the new protection is written to the flash Address 0x3FFF to Address  
0x3FFB. See the Protecting the Flash section for more information on how to configure these  
bits.  
Watchdog Timer Interrupt  
Writing to the Watchdog Timer SFR (WDCON, Address  
0xC0)  
If the watchdog timer is not cleared within the watchdog timeout  
period, a system reset occurs unless the watchdog timer interrupt  
is enabled. The watchdog timer interrupt response bit (WDIR,  
Bit 3) is located in the watchdog timer SFR (WDCON, Address  
0xC0). Enabling the WDIR bit allows the program to examine  
the stack or other variables that may have led the program to  
execute inappropriate code. The watchdog timer interrupt also  
allows the watchdog to be used as a long interval timer.  
Writing data to the WDCON SFR involves a double instruction  
sequence. The WDWR (Bit 0) bit must be set, and the following  
instruction must be a write instruction to the WDCON SFR.  
; Disable Watchdog  
CLR EA  
SETB WDWR  
CLR WDE  
Note that WDIR is automatically configured as a high priority  
interrupt. This interrupt cannot be disabled by the EA bit (Bit 7)  
in the interrupt enable SFR (IE, Address 0xA8; see Table 78).  
Even if all of the other interrupts are disabled, the watchdog is  
kept active to watch over the program.  
SETB EA  
This sequence is necessary to protect the WDCON SFR from  
code execution upsets that may unintentionally modify this  
SFR. Interrupts should be disabled during this operation due to  
the consecutive instruction cycles.  
Rev. B | Page 99 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
LCD DRIVER  
Using shared pins, the LCD module is capable of directly driving  
an LCD panel of 17 × 4 segments without compromising any  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
functions. It is capable of driving LCDs with 2×, 3×, and 4× multi-  
plexing. The LCD waveform voltages generated through internal  
charge pump circuitry support up to 5 V LCDs for the ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569. An external resistor  
ladder for LCD waveform voltage generation is also supported.  
LCD REGISTERS  
There are six LCD control registers that configure the driver for  
the specific type of LCD in the end system and set up the user  
display preferences. The LCD configuration SFR (LCDCON,  
Address 0x95), LCD Configuration X SFR (LCDCONX,  
Address 0x9C), and LCD Configuration Y SFR (LCDCONY,  
Address 0xB1) contain general LCD driver configuration  
information including the LCD enable and reset, as well as the  
method of LCD voltage generation and multiplex level. The  
LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96) configures timing  
settings for LCD frame rate and blink rate. LCD pins are  
configured for LCD functionality in the LCD segment enable  
SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97) and the LCD Segment Enable 2  
SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has an embedded LCD control circuit, driver, and  
power supply circuit. The LCD module is functional in all  
operating modes (see the Operating Modes section).  
Table 87. LCD Driver SFRs  
SFR Address  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Mnemonic  
LCDCON  
LCDCLK  
Description  
0x95  
0x96  
LCD configuration SFR (see Table 88).  
LCD clock (see  
Table 92).  
0x97  
0x9C  
0xAC  
0xAE  
0xB1  
0xED  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
LCDSEGE  
LCDCONX  
LCDPTR  
LCDDAT  
LCDCONY  
LCDSEGE2  
LCD segment Enable (see Table 95).  
LCD configuration X (see Table 89).  
LCD pointer (see Table 96).  
LCD data (see Table 97).  
LCD configuration Y (see Table 91).  
LCD segment Enable 2 (see Table 98).  
Table 88. LCD Configuration SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
7
LCDEN  
0
0
0
LCD enable. If this bit is set, the LCD driver is enabled.  
6
LCDRST  
BLINKEN  
LCD data registers reset. If this bit is set, the LCD data registers are reset to 0.  
5
Blink mode enable bit. If this bit is set, blink mode is enabled. The blink mode is configured by the  
BLKMOD and BLKFREQ bits in the LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96).  
4
LCDPSM2  
0
Forces LCD off when in PSM2 (sleep) mode. Note that the internal voltage reference must be enabled by  
setting the REF_BAT_EN bit in the Peripheral Configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address 0xF4) to allow LCD  
operation in PSM2 mode.  
LCDPSM2  
Result  
0
1
The LCD is disabled or enabled in PSM2 by the LCDEN bit  
The LCD is disabled in PSM2 regardless of LCDEN setting  
3
CLKSEL  
BIAS  
0
0
0
LCD clock selection.  
CLKSEL  
Result  
0
1
fLCDCLK = 2048 Hz  
fLCDCLK = 128 Hz  
2
Bias mode.  
BIAS  
Result  
1/2  
1/3  
0
1
[1:0]  
LMUX  
LCD multiplex level.  
LMUX  
00  
Result  
Reserved.  
01  
10  
11  
2× multiplexing. FP27/COM3 is used as FP27, and FP28/COM2 is used as FP28.  
3× multiplexing. FP27/COM3 is used as FP27, and FP28/COM2 is used as COM2.  
4× multiplexing. FP27/COM3 is used as COM3, and FP28/COM2 is used as COM2.  
Rev. B | Page 100 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 89. LCD Configuration X SFR (LCDCONX, Address 0x9C)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
EXTRES  
Default  
Description  
7
0
0
Reserved.  
6
External resistor ladder selection bit.  
EXTRES  
Result  
0
External resistor ladder is disabled. Charge pump is enabled.  
1
External resistor ladder is enabled. Charge pump is disabled.  
[5:0]  
BIASLV  
0
Bias level selection bits. See Table 90.1  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Table 90. LCD Bias Voltage When Contrast Control Is Enabled1  
1/2 Bias  
VC  
1/3 Bias  
VC  
BIASLVL[5]  
VA (V)  
VB  
VB  
0
VB = VA  
VC = 2 × VA  
VB = 2 × VA  
VC = 3 × VA  
BLVL  
[
4:0  
]
VREF  
×
31  
1
VB = VA  
VC = 2 × VA  
VB = 2 × VA  
VC = 3 × VA  
BLVL  
[
4 : 0  
]
VREF × 1 +  
31  
1 This feature is not available in the ADE7116.  
Table 91. LCD Configuration Y SFR (LCDCONY, Address 0xB1)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
INV_LVL  
Default  
Description  
7
6
0
0
This bit should be kept cleared for proper operation.  
Frame inversion mode enable bit. If this bit is set, frames are inverted every other frame. If this bit is  
cleared, frames are not inverted.  
[5:2]  
1
Reserved  
UPDATEOVER  
0000  
0
These bits should be kept cleared to 0 for proper operation.  
Update finished flag bit. This bit is updated by the LCD driver. When set, this bit indicates that the  
LCD memory has been updated and a new frame has begun.  
0
REFRESH  
0
Refresh LCD data memory bit. This bit should be set by the user. When set, the LCD driver does not  
use the data in the LCD data registers to update the display. The LCD data registers can be updated  
by the 8052. When cleared, the LCD driver uses the data in the LCD data registers to update display  
at the next frame.  
Table 92. LCD Clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:6]  
BLKMOD  
0
Blink mode clock source configuration bits.  
BLKMOD  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
The blink rate is controlled by software; the display is off.  
The blink rate is controlled by software; the display is on.  
The blink rate is 2 Hz.  
The blink rate is set by BLKFREQ.  
[5:4]  
[3:0]  
BLKFREQ  
0
0
Blink rate configuration bits. These bits control the LCD blink rate if the BLKMOD bits = 11.  
BLKFREQ  
Result (Blink Rate)  
1 Hz  
00  
01  
10  
11  
1/2 Hz  
1/3 Hz  
1/4 Hz  
FD  
LCD frame rate selection bits. See Table 93 and Table 94.  
Rev. B | Page 101 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 93. LCD Frame Rate Selection for fLCDCLK = 2048 Hz (LCDCON[3] = 0)  
2× Multiplexing  
3× Multiplexing  
4× Multiplexing  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
FD3  
0
FD2  
0
FD1  
0
FD0  
1
fLCD (Hz)  
256  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
fLCD (Hz)  
341.3  
341.3  
256  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
fLCD (Hz)  
512  
1281  
85.3  
64  
170.71  
113.81  
85.3  
68.3  
56.9  
48.8  
42.7  
37.9  
34.1  
31  
1281  
85.3  
64  
0
0
1
0
170.7  
128  
341.3  
256  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
102.4  
85.3  
73.1  
64  
51.2  
42.7  
36.6  
32  
204.8  
170.7  
146.3  
128  
204.8  
170.7  
146.3  
128  
51.2  
42.7  
36.6  
32  
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
56.9  
51.2  
46.5  
42.7  
39.4  
36.6  
34.1  
32  
28.5  
25.6  
23.25  
21.35  
19.7  
18.3  
17.05  
16  
113.8  
102.4  
93.1  
113.8  
102.4  
93.1  
85.3  
78.8  
73.1  
68.3  
64  
28.5  
25.6  
23.25  
21.35  
19.7  
18.3  
17.05  
16  
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
85.3  
28.4  
26.3  
24.4  
22.8  
21.3  
10.7  
1
1
0
0
78.8  
1
1
0
1
73.1  
1
1
1
0
68.3  
1
1
1
1
64  
0
0
0
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1 Not within the range of typical LCD frame rates.  
Table 94. LCD Frame Rate Selection for fLCDCLK = 128 Hz (LCDCON[3] = 1)  
2× Multiplexing  
3× Multiplexing  
4× Multiplexing  
FD3  
0
FD2  
0
FD1  
0
FD0  
1
fLCD (Hz)  
32  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
fLCD (Hz)  
32  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
fLCD (Hz)  
32  
Frame Rate (Hz)  
161  
10.6  
8
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
10.7  
42.7  
21.3  
8
0
0
1
0
21.3  
16  
32  
32  
8
0
0
1
1
32  
32  
8
0
1
0
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
0
1
0
1
16  
8
32  
32  
8
0
1
1
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
0
1
1
1
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
0
0
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
0
0
1
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
0
1
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
0
1
1
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
1
0
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
1
0
1
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
1
1
0
16  
8
32  
32  
8
1
1
1
1
128  
64  
64  
32  
128  
64  
128  
64  
32  
16  
0
0
0
0
1 Not within the range of typical LCD frame rates.  
Rev. B | Page 102 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 95. LCD Segment Enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
FP25EN  
FP24EN  
FP23EN  
FP22EN  
FP21EN  
FP20EN  
Reserved  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
[1:0]  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FP25 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP24 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP23 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP22 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP21 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP20 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
These bits must be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Table 96. LCD Pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
R/W  
0
Read or write LCD bit. If this bit is set to 1, the data in LCD data SFR (LCDDAT, Address 0xAE) is  
written to the address indicated by the ADDRESS bits (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC).  
6
[5:0]  
Reserved  
ADDRESS  
0
0
Reserved.  
LCD memory address (see Table 99).  
Table 97. LCD Data SFR (LCDDAT, Address 0xAE)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
LCDDATA  
0
Data to be written into or read out of the LCD memory SFRs.  
Table 98. LCD Segment Enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED)  
Bit  
[7:4]  
3
2
1
Mnemonic  
Reserved  
FP19EN  
FP18EN  
FP17EN  
Default  
Description  
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved.  
FP19 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP18 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP17 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
FP16 function select bit. 0 = general-purpose I/O, 1 = LCD function.  
0
FP16EN  
The Display Element Control section contains details about  
LCD SETUP  
setting up the LCD data memory to turn individual LCD  
segments on and off. Setting the LCDRST bit (Bit 6) in the LCD  
Configuration SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95) resets the LCD  
data memory to its default (0). A power-on reset also clears the  
LCD data memory.  
The LCD configuration SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95)  
configures the LCD module to drive the type of LCD in the user  
end system. The BIAS bit (Bit 2) and the LMUX bits in this SFR  
should be set according to the LCD specifications.  
The COM2/FP28 and COM3/FP27 pins default to LCD segment  
lines. Selecting the 3× multiplex level in the LCD configuration  
SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95) by setting LMUX[1:0] to 10  
changes the FP28 pin functionality to COM2. The 4× multiplex  
level selection, LMUX[1:0] = 11, changes the FP28 pin  
functionality to COM2 and the FP27 pin functionality to  
COM3.  
LCD TIMING AND WAVEFORMS  
An LCD segment acts like a capacitor that is charged and  
discharged at a certain rate. This rate, the refresh rate, determines  
the visual characteristics of the LCD. A slow refresh rate results  
in the LCD blinking on and off between refreshes. A fast refresh  
rate presents a screen that appears to be continuously lit. In  
addition, a faster refresh rate consumes more power.  
The LCD segments of FP0 to FP15 and FP26 are enabled by  
default. Additional pins are selected for LCD functionality in  
the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97) and  
LCD Segment Enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED) where  
there are individual enable bits for the FP16 to FP25 segment  
pins. The LCD pins do not have to be enabled sequentially. For  
example, if the alternate function of FP23, the Timer 2 input, is  
required, any of the other shared pins, FP16 to FP25, can be  
enabled instead.  
The frame rate, or refresh rate, for the LCD module is derived  
from the LCD clock, fLCDCLK. The LCD clock is selected as 2048 Hz  
or 128 Hz by the CLKSEL bit (Bit 3) in the LCD Configuration  
SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95). The minimum refresh rate  
needed for the LCD to appear solid (without blinking) is  
independent of the multiplex level.  
Rev. B | Page 103 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The LCD waveform frequency, fLCD, is the frequency at which  
the LCD switches the active common line. Thus, the LCD  
waveform frequency depends heavily on the multiplex level.  
The frame rate and LCD waveform frequency are set by fLCDCLK  
segment lines, and the MSBs store the state of the odd numbered  
segment lines. For example, LCD Data Address 0 refers to  
Segment Line 1 and Segment Line 0 (see Table 99). Note that the  
LCD data memory is maintained in the PSM2 operating mode.  
,
the multiplex level, and the FD[3:0] frame rate selection bits in  
the LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96).  
The LCD data memory is accessed indirectly through the LCD  
pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC) and LCD Data SFR  
(LCDDAT, Address 0xAE). Moving a value to the LCDPTR SFR  
selects the LCD data byte to be accessed and initiates a read or  
write operation (see Table 96).  
The LCD module provides 16 different frame rates for  
f
LCDCLK = 2048 Hz, ranging from 8 Hz to 128 Hz for an LCD  
with 4× multiplexing. Fewer options are available with  
fLCDCLK = 128 Hz, ranging from 8 Hz to 32 Hz for a 4× multi-  
plexed LCD. The 128 Hz clock is beneficial for battery  
operation because it consumes less power than the 2048 Hz  
clock. The frame rate is set by the FD bits in the LCD clock  
SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96); see Table 93 and Table 94.  
Writing to LCD Data Registers  
To update the LCD data memory, first set the LSB of the LCD  
Configuration Y SFR (LCDCONY, Address 0xB1) to freeze the  
data being displayed on the LCD while updating it. This  
operation ensures that the data displayed on the screen does not  
change while the data is being changed. Then, move the data to  
the LCD data SFR (LCDDAT, Address 0xAE) prior to accessing  
the LCD pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC). When the  
MSB of the LCD pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC) is set,  
the content of the LCD data SFR (LCDDAT, Address 0xAE) is  
transferred to the internal LCD data memory designated by the  
address in the LCDPTR SFR. Clear the LSB of the LCD  
Configuration Y SFR (LCDCONY, Address 0xB1) when all of  
the data memory has been updated to allow the use of the new  
LCD setup for display.  
The LCD waveform is inverted at twice the LCD waveform  
frequency, fLCD. This way, each frame has an average dc offset  
of 0. ADC offset degrades the lifetime and performance of  
the LCD.  
BLINK MODE  
Blink mode is enabled by setting the BLINKEN bit (Bit 5) in the  
LCD Configuration SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95). This mode  
is used to alternate between the LCD on state and LCD off state  
so that the LCD screen appears to blink. There are two blinking  
modes: a software controlled blink mode and an automatic  
blink mode.  
Sample 8052 code to update the segments attached to FP10 and  
FP11 pins, use the following sample 8052 code:  
Software Controlled Blink Mode  
ORL  
MOV  
MOV  
ANL  
LCDCONY,#01h ;start updating the data  
LCDDAT,#FFh  
The LCD blink rate can be controlled by user code with the  
BLKMOD bits in the LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96)  
by toggling the bits to turn the display on and off at a rate  
determined by the MCU code.  
LCDPTR,#80h OR 05h  
LCDCONY,#0FEh;update finished  
Reading LCD Data Registers  
Automatic Blink Mode  
When the MSB of the LCD Pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address  
0xAC) is cleared, the content of the LCD data memory address  
designated by LCDPTR is transferred to the LCD data SFR  
(LCDDAT, Address 0xAE).  
There are five blink rates available if the RTC peripheral is  
enabled. These blink rates are selected by the BLKMOD and  
BLKFREQ bits in the LCD clock SFR (LCDCLK, Address 0x96);  
see Table 92.  
Sample 8052 code to read the contents of LCD Data Memory  
Address 0x07, which holds the on and off state of the segments  
attached to FP14 and FP15, is as follows.  
DISPLAY ELEMENT CONTROL  
A bank of 15 bytes of data memory located in the LCD module  
controls the on or off state of each segment of the LCD. The  
LCD data memory is stored in Address 0 through Address 14 in  
the LCD module. Each byte configures the on and off states of two  
segment lines. The LSBs store the state of the even numbered  
MOV  
MOV  
LCDPTR,#07h  
R1, LCDDAT  
Rev. B | Page 104 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 99. LCD Data Memory Accessed Indirectly Through LCD Pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC) and LCD Data SFR (LCDDAT,  
Address 0xAE)1, 2  
LCD Pointer SFR (LCDPTR, Address 0xAC)  
LCD Pointer SFR (LCDDAT, Address 0xAE)  
LCD Memory Address  
COM3  
COM2  
COM1  
COM0  
COM3  
FP28  
FP26  
FP24  
FP22  
FP20  
FP18  
FP16  
FP14  
FP12  
FP10  
FP8  
COM2  
FP28  
FP26  
FP24  
FP22  
FP20  
FP18  
FP16  
FP14  
FP12  
FP10  
FP8  
COM1  
FP28  
FP26  
FP24  
FP22  
FP20  
FP18  
FP16  
FP14  
FP12  
FP10  
FP8  
COM0  
FP28  
FP26  
FP24  
FP22  
FP20  
FP18  
FP16  
FP14  
FP12  
FP10  
FP8  
0x0E  
0x0D  
0x0C  
0x0B  
0x0A  
0x09  
0x08  
0x07  
0x06  
0x05  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
FP27  
FP25  
FP23  
FP21  
FP19  
FP17  
FP15  
FP13  
FP11  
FP9  
FP27  
FP25  
FP23  
FP21  
FP19  
FP17  
FP15  
FP13  
FP11  
FP9  
FP27  
FP25  
FP23  
FP21  
FP19  
FP17  
FP15  
FP13  
FP11  
FP9  
FP27  
FP25  
FP23  
FP21  
FP19  
FP17  
FP15  
FP13  
FP11  
FP9  
FP7  
FP5  
FP3  
FP1  
FP7  
FP5  
FP3  
FP1  
FP7  
FP5  
FP3  
FP1  
FP7  
FP5  
FP3  
FP1  
FP6  
FP4  
FP2  
FP0  
FP6  
FP4  
FP2  
FP0  
FP6  
FP4  
FP2  
FP0  
FP6  
FP4  
FP2  
FP0  
1 COMx designates the common lines.  
2 FPx designates the segment lines.  
Contrast Control  
VOLTAGE GENERATION  
The electrical characteristics of the liquid in the LCD change  
over temperature. This requires adjustments in the LCD waveform  
voltages to ensure a readable display. An added benefit of the  
internal charge pump voltage generation is a configurable bias  
voltage that can be compensated over temperature and supply  
to maintain contrast on the LCD. These compensations can be  
performed based on the ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 temperature and supply voltage measurements (see  
the Temperature, Battery, and Supply Voltage Measurements  
section). This dynamic contrast control is not easily implemented  
with external resistor ladder voltage generation.  
The ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 provide two ways  
to generate the LCD waveform voltage levels. The on-chip charge  
pump option can generate 5 V. This makes it possible to use 5 V  
LCDs with the 3.3 V ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569.  
There is also an option to use an external resistor ladder with a  
3.3 V LCD. The EXTRES bit (Bit 6) in the LCD Configuration X  
SFR (LCDCONX, Address 0x9C) selects the resistor ladder or  
charge pump option. In the ADE7116 only, the resistor driver  
option is available.  
When selecting how to generate the LCD waveform voltages,  
the following should be considered:  
The LCD bias voltage sets the contrast of the display when  
the charge pump provides the LCD waveform voltages. The  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 provide 64 bias levels  
selected by the BIASLVL[5:0] bits in the LCD Configuration X  
SFR (LCDCONX, Address 0x9C). The voltage level on LCDVA,  
LCDVB, and LCDVC depend on the internal voltage reference  
value (VREF), BIASLVL[5:0] selection, and the biasing selected  
as described in Table 90.  
Lifetime performance power consumption  
Contrast control  
Lifetime Performance Power Consumption  
In most LCDs, a high amount of current is required when the LCD  
waveforms change state. The external resistor ladder option draws a  
constant amount of current, whereas the charge pump circuitry  
allows dynamic current consumption. If the LCD module is used  
with the internal charge pump option when the display is disabled,  
the voltage generation is disabled so that no power is consumed by  
the LCD function. This feature results in significant power  
savings if the display is turned off during battery operation.  
Lifetime Performance  
DC offset on a segment degrades its performance over time.  
The voltages generated through the internal charge pump  
switch faster than those generated by the external resistor  
ladder, reducing the likelihood of a dc voltage being applied  
to a segment and increasing the lifetime of the LCD.  
Rev. B | Page 105 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
LCD EXTERNAL CIRCUITRY  
LCD FUNCTION IN PSM2 MODE  
The voltage generation selection is made by the EXTRES bit (Bit  
6) in the LCD configuration X SFR (LCDCONX, Address 0x9C).  
This bit is cleared by default for charge pump voltage generation,  
but it can be set to enable an external resistor ladder.  
The LCDPSM2 (Bit 4) and LCDEN (Bit 7) in the LCD config-  
uration SFR (LCDCON, Address 0x95) control the LCD  
functionality in the PSM2 operating mode (see Table 100).  
Note that the internal voltage reference must be enabled by setting  
REF_BAT_EN bit (Bit 3) in the peripheral configuration SFR  
(PERIPH, Address 0xF4) to allow LCD operation in PSM2 mode  
(see Table 20).  
Charge Pump  
Voltage generation through the charge pump requires external  
capacitors to store charge. (Note that this feature is not available  
in the ADE7116 or ADE7156.) The external connections to  
LCDVA, LCDVB, and LCDVC, as well as to LCDVP1 and  
LCDVP2, are shown in Figure 90.  
Table 100. Bits Controlling LCD Functionality in PSM2  
Mode  
LCDPSM2  
LCDEN  
Result  
0
0
1
0
1
X
The display is off in PSM2.  
The display is on in PSM2.  
The display is off in PSM2.  
LCDVC  
470nF  
LCDVB  
CHARGE PUMP  
470nF  
AND  
LCDVA  
LCD WAVEFORM  
470nF  
CIRCUITRY  
LCDVP1  
In addition, note that the LCD configuration and data memory  
is retained when the display is turned off.  
100nF  
LCDVP2  
Figure 90. External Circuitry for Charge Pump Option  
Example LCD Setup  
External Resistor Ladder  
An example of how to set up the LCD peripheral for a specific  
LCD is described in this section with the following parameters:  
To enable the external resistor ladder option, set the EXTRES  
bit (Bit 6) in the LCD Configuration X SFR (LCDCONX,  
Address 0x9C). When EXTRES = 1, the LCD waveform voltages  
are supplied by the external resistor ladder. Because the LCD  
voltages are not generated on-chip, the LCD bias compensation  
implemented to maintain contrast over temperature and supply  
is not possible.  
Type of LCD: 5 V, 4× multiplexed with 1/3 bias, 96 segment  
Voltage generation: internal charge pump  
Refresh rate: 64 Hz  
A 96-segment LCD with 4× multiplexing requires 96/4 = 24  
segment lines. Sixteen pins, FP0 to FP15, are automatically  
dedicated for use as LCD segments. Eight more pins must be  
chosen for the LCD function. Because the LCD has 4× multi-  
plexing, all four common lines are used. As a result, COM2/FP28  
and COM3/FP27 cannot be used as segment lines. Based on the  
alternate functions of the pins used for FP16 through FP25,  
FP16 to FP23 are chosen for the eight remaining segment lines.  
These pins are enabled for LCD functionality in the LCD  
segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97) and LCD  
Segment Enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
The external circuitry needed for the resistor ladder option is  
shown in Figure 92. The resistors required should be in the  
range of 10 kΩ to 100 kΩ and should be based on the current  
required by the LCD being used.  
LCDVC  
LCDVB  
LCD WAVEFORM  
CIRCUITRY  
LCDVA  
LCDVP1  
LCDVP2  
To determine contrast setting for this 5 V LCD, Table 90 shows  
the BIASLVL[5:0] setting in the LCD Configuration X SFR  
(LCDCONX, Address 0x9C) that corresponds to a VC of 5 V in  
1/3 bias mode. The maximum bias level setting for this LCD is  
BIASLVL[5:0] = 101110.  
Figure 91. External Circuitry for External Resistor Ladder Option:  
1/2 Bias Configuration  
LCDVC  
LCDVB  
LCD WAVEFORM  
CIRCUITRY  
LCDVA  
LCDVP1  
LCDVP2  
Figure 92. External Circuitry for External Resistor Ladder Option:  
1/3 Bias Configuration  
Rev. B | Page 106 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The LCD is set up with the following 8052 code:  
; set up LCD pins to have LCD functionality  
MOV  
MOV  
LCDSEG,#FP20EN+FP21EN+FP22EN+FP23EN  
LCDSEGX,#FP16EN+FP17EN+FP18EN+FP19EN  
; set up LCDCON for fLCDCLK=2048Hz, 1/3 bias and 4x multiplexing  
MOV LCDCON,#BIAS+LMUX1+LMUX0  
; setup LCDCONX for charge pump and BIASLVL[110111]  
MOV LCDCONX,#BIASLVL5+BIASLVL4+BIASLVL3+BIASLVL2+BIASLVL1+BIASLVL0  
; set up refresh rate for 64Hz with fLCDCLK=2048Hz  
MOV LCDCLK,#FD3+FD2+FD1+FD0  
; set up LCD data registers with data to be displayed using  
; LCDPTR and LCDDATA registers  
; turn all segments on FP27 ON and FP26 OFF  
ORL  
MOV  
MOV  
ANL  
ORL  
LCDCONY,#01h ; start data memory refresh  
LCDDAT,#F0H  
LCDPTR, #80h OR 0DH  
LCDCONY,#0FEh; end of data memory refresh  
LCDCON,#LCDEN ; enable LCD  
To set up the same 3.3 V LCD for use with an external resistor ladder:  
; set up LCDCONX for external resistor ladder  
MOV  
LCDCONX,#EXTRES  
Rev. B | Page 107 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
FLASH MEMORY  
In reliability qualification, every byte in both the program and  
FLASH MEMORY OVERVIEW  
data Flash/EE memory is cycled from 0x00 to 0xFF until a first  
fail is recorded, signifying the endurance limit of the on-chip  
Flash/EE memory.  
Flash memory is a type of nonvolatile memory that is in-circuit  
programmable. The default, erased state of a byte of flash memory  
is 0xFF. When a byte of flash memory is programmed, the required  
bits change from 1 to 0. The flash memory must be erased to  
turn the 0s back to 1s. A byte of flash memory cannot, however,  
be erased individually. The entire segment, or page, of flash  
memory that contains the byte must be erased.  
As indicated in the Specifications section, the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 flash  
memory endurance qualification has been carried out in  
accordance with JEDEC Standard 22 Method A117 over the  
industrial temperature range of −40°C, +25°C, and +85°C. The  
results allow the specification of a minimum endurance figure  
over supply and temperature of 100,000 cycles, with a minimum  
endurance figure of 20,000 cycles of operation at 25°C.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provide 16 kB of flash program/information memory.  
This memory is segmented into 32 pages that each contain 512  
bytes each. To reprogram one byte of flash memory, the other  
511 bytes in that page must be erased. The flash memory can be  
erased by page or all at once in a mass erase. There is a command  
to verify that a flash write operation has completed successfully.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 flash memory controller also offers configurable flash  
memory protection.  
Retention is the ability of the flash memory to retain its  
programmed data over time. Again, the parts have been  
qualified in accordance with the formal JEDEC Retention  
Lifetime Specification (A117) at a specific junction temperature  
(TJ = 55°C).  
As part of this qualification procedure, the flash memory is  
cycled to its specified endurance limit described previously,  
before data retention is characterized. This means that the flash  
memory is guaranteed to retain its data for its full specified  
retention lifetime every time the flash memory is  
reprogrammed. It should also be noted that retention lifetime,  
based on an activation energy of 0.6 eV, derates with TJ as  
shown in Figure 93.  
The 16 kB of flash memory are provided on-chip to facilitate  
code execution without any external discrete ROM device  
requirements. The program memory can be programmed in-  
circuit, using the serial download mode provided or using  
conventional third party memory programmers.  
Flash/EE Memory Reliability  
300  
The flash memory arrays on the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 are fully qualified for  
two key Flash/EE memory characteristics: Flash/EE memory  
cycling endurance and Flash/EE memory data retention.  
250  
ANALOG DEVICES  
200  
SPECIFICATION  
100 YEARS MIN.  
AT TJ = 55°C  
Endurance quantifies the ability of the Flash/EE memory to be  
cycled through many program, read, and erase cycles. In real  
terms, a single endurance cycle is composed of four independent,  
sequential events:  
150  
100  
50  
1. Initial page erase sequence.  
2. Read/verify sequence.  
3. Byte program sequence.  
4. Second read/verify sequence.  
0
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
90  
100  
110  
TJ JUNCTION TEMPERATURE (°C)  
Figure 93. Flash/EE Memory Data Retention  
Rev. B | Page 108 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The implication of write/erase protecting the last page is that  
the content of the 506 bytes in this page that are available to the  
user must not change.  
FLASH MEMORY ORGANIZATION  
The 16 kB array of flash memory provided by the ADE7116/  
ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 are  
segmented into 32 pages of 512 bytes each. It is up to the user to  
decide which flash memory is to be used for data memory. It is  
recommended that each page be dedicated solely to program or  
data memory so that an instance does not arise where the  
program counter is loaded with data memory instead of an  
opcode from the program memory or where program memory  
is erased to update a byte of data memory.  
Thus, it is recommended that if code protection is enabled, the  
last page of user accessible flash memory should be used only to  
store data that does not need modification in the field. If the  
firmware requires protection and may need updating in the  
future, the last page should be reserved for constants used by  
the user code that do not require modification during  
emulation or debug.  
0x3FFF  
0x1FFF  
Page 0 through Page 30 are, therefore, available for general  
program and data memory use. It is recommended that Page 31  
be used for constants or code that do not require future  
modifications. Note that the last six bytes of Page 31 are  
reserved for the flash memory protection and are, therefore,  
unavailable to the user.  
PAGE 15  
PAGE 14  
PAGE 13  
PAGE 12  
PAGE 11  
PAGE 10  
PAGE 9  
PAGE 8  
PAGE 7  
PAGE 6  
PAGE 5  
PAGE 4  
PAGE 3  
PAGE 2  
PAGE 1  
PAGE 0  
PAGE 31  
PAGE 30  
PAGE 29  
PAGE 28  
PAGE 27  
PAGE 26  
PAGE 25  
PAGE 24  
PAGE 23  
PAGE 22  
PAGE 21  
PAGE 20  
PAGE 19  
PAGE 18  
PAGE 17  
PAGE 16  
0x3E00  
0x3DFF  
0x1E00  
0x1DFF  
READ  
READ  
0x3C00  
0x3BFF  
0x1C00  
0x1BFF  
PROTECT  
BIT 7  
PROTECT  
BIT 3  
0x3A00  
0x39FF  
0x1A00  
0x19FF  
0x3800  
0x37FF  
0x1800  
0x17FF  
0x3600  
0x35FF  
0x1600  
0x15FF  
USING THE FLASH MEMORY  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 6  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 2  
0x3400  
0x33FF  
0x1400  
0x13FF  
The 16 kB of flash memory are configured as 32 pages, each  
comprising 512 bytes. As with the other ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 peripherals, the  
interface to this memory space is via a group of registers  
mapped in the SFR space (see Table 101).  
0x3200  
0x31FF  
0x1200  
0x11FF  
0x3000  
0x2FFF  
0x1000  
0x0FFF  
0x2E00  
0x2DFF  
0x0E00  
0x0DFF  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 5  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 1  
0x2C00  
0x2BFF  
0x0C00  
0x0BFF  
The flash data SFR, (EDATA, Address 0xBC) holds the byte of data  
to be accessed. The byte of flash memory is addressed via the  
EADRH SFR (Address 0xC7) and the EADRL SFR (Address  
0xC6). Finally, the ECON SFR (Address 0xB9) is an 8-bit  
control register that can be written to with one of seven flash  
memory access commands to trigger various read, write, erase,  
and verify functions.  
0x2A00  
0x29FF  
0x0A00  
0x09FF  
0x2800  
0x27FF  
0x0800  
0x07FF  
0x2600  
0x25FF  
0x0600  
0x05FF  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 4  
READ  
PROTECT  
BIT 0  
0x2400  
0x23FF  
0x0400  
0x03FF  
0x2200  
0x21FF  
0x0200  
0x01FF  
Table 101. Flash SFRs  
0x2000  
0x0000  
Bit  
CONTAINS PROTECTION SETTINGS.  
SFR  
Address Default Addressable Description  
Figure 94. Flash Memory Organization  
ECON  
FLSHKY 0xBA  
PROTKY 0xBB  
0xB9  
0x00  
0xFF  
0xFF  
No  
No  
No  
Flash control.  
Flash key.  
Flash protection  
key.  
Flash data.  
Flash W/E  
Protection 0.  
Flash W/E  
Protection 1.  
Flash read  
protection.  
The flash memory can be protected from read or write/erase  
access. The protection is implemented in the upper page of  
user program memory, Page 31. Four of the bytes from this  
page are used to set up write/erase protection for each page.  
Another byte is used for configuring read protection of the flash  
memory. The read protection is selected in groups of four pages.  
Finally, there is a byte used to store the key required for  
modifying the protection scheme. The last page of flash  
memory must be write/erase protected at a minimum.  
EDATA  
PROTB0 0xBD  
0xBC  
0x00  
0xFF  
No  
No  
PROTB1 0xBE  
0xFF  
0xFF  
0x00  
0x00  
No  
No  
No  
No  
PROTR  
EADRL  
EADRH  
0xBF  
0xC6  
0xC7  
Flash low byte  
address.  
Flash high byte  
address.  
Figure 95 demonstrates the steps required for access to the flash  
memory.  
Rev. B | Page 109 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ECON  
COMMAND  
ADDRESS ADDRESS PROTECTION  
DECODER DECODER  
ACCESS  
ALLOWED?  
TRUE: ACCESS  
ALLOWED  
EADRH EADRL  
ECON = 0  
FLASH  
PROTECTION KEY  
FLSHKY  
FALSE: ACCESS  
DENIED  
ECON = 1  
FLSHKY = 0 × 3B?  
Figure 95. Flash Memory Read/Write/Erase Protection Block Diagram  
ECON—Flash Control SFR  
The program counter, PC, is held on the instruction where the  
ECON SFR is written to until the flash memory controller is  
done performing the requested operation. Then, the PC  
increments to continue with the next instruction.  
Programming flash memory is done through the Flash Control  
SFR (ECON, Address 0xB9). This SFR allows the user to read,  
write, erase, or verify the 16 kB of flash memory. As a method of  
security, a key must be written to the FLSHKY, Address 0xBA)  
to initiate any user access to the flash memory. Upon completion  
of the flash memory operation, the FLSHKY SFR is reset such that  
it must be written to before another flash memory operation.  
Requiring the key to be set before an access to the flash memory  
decreases the likelihood of user code or data being overwritten  
by a runaway program.  
Any interrupt requests that occur while the flash controller is  
performing an operation are not handled until the flash operation  
is complete. All peripherals, such as timers and counters, continue  
to operate as configured throughout the flash memory access.  
Table 102. Flash Control SFR (ECON, Address 0xB9)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default  
Value  
Description  
[7:0]  
ECON  
0
1
Write byte. The value in EDATA is written to the flash memory at the page address given by  
EADRH (Address 0xC7) and EADRL (Address 0xC6). Note that the byte being addressed must be  
pre-erased.  
2
3
Erase page. A 512-byte page of flash memory address is erased. The page is selected by the  
address in EADRH and EADRL. Any address in the page can be written to EADRH and EADRL to  
select it for erasure.  
Erase all. All 16 kB of the available flash memory are erased. Note that this command is used  
during serial mode and parallel download mode but should not be executed by user code.  
4
5
Read byte. The byte in the flash memory addressed by EADRH/EADRL is read into EDATA.  
Erase Page and Write Byte. The page that holds the byte addressed by EADRH/EADRL is erased.  
Data in EDATA is then written to the byte of flash memory addressed by EADRH/EADRL.  
8
Protect code (see the Protecting the Flash section).  
Table 103. Flash Key SFR (FLSHKY, Address 0xBA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
FLSHKY  
0xFF  
The content of this SFR is compared to the flash key, 0x3B. If the two values match, the next ECON  
operation is allowed (see the Protecting the Flash section).  
Table 104. Flash Protection Key SFR (PROTKY, Address 0xBB)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
PROTKY 0xFF  
The content of this SFR is compared to the flash memory location at Address 0x3FFA. If the two values  
match, the update of the write/erase and read protection setup is allowed (see the Protecting the Flash  
section).  
If the protection key in the flash is 0xFF, the PROTKY SFR value is not used for comparison. This SFR is  
also used to write the protection key in the flash. This is done by writing the desired value in PROTKY  
and by writing 0x08 in the ECON SFR. This operation can only be done once.  
Table 105. Flash Data SFR (EDATA, Address 0xBC)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
EDATA Flash pointer data.  
0
Rev. B | Page 110 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 106. Flash Write/Erase Protection 0 SFR (PROTB0, Address 0xBD)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
PROTB0  
0xFF  
This SFR is used to write the write/erase protection bits for Page 0 to Page 7 of the flash memory  
(see the Protecting the Flash section). Clearing the bits enables the protection.  
PROTB0.7 PROTB0.6 PROTB0.5 PROTB0.4 PROTB0.3 PROTB0.2 PROTB0.1 PROTB0.0  
Page 7  
Page 6  
Page 5  
Page 4  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
Page 0  
Table 107. Flash Write/Erase Protection 1 SFR (PROTB1, Address 0xBE)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:0]  
PROTB1  
0xFF  
This SFR is used to write the write/erase protection bits for Page 8 to Page 15 of the flash memory  
(see the Protecting the Flash section). Clearing the bits enables the protection.  
PROTB1.7 PROTB1.6 PROTB1.5 PROTB1.4 PROTB1.3 PROTB1.2 PROTB1.1 PROTB1.0  
Page 15  
Page 14  
Page 13  
Page 12  
Page 11  
Page 10  
Page 9  
Page 8  
Table 108. Flash Read Protection SFR (PROTR, Address 0xBF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
PROTR  
0xFF  
This SFR is used to write the read protection bits for Page 0 to Page 31 of the flash memory  
(see the Protecting the Flash section). Clearing the bits enables the protection.  
PROTR.7  
Page 28 to Page 24 to Page 20 to Page 16 to Page 12 to Page 8 to  
Page 31 Page 27 Page 23 Page 19 Page 15 Page 11  
PROTR.6  
PROTR.5  
PROTR.4  
PROTR.3  
PROTR.2  
PROTR.1  
PROTR.0  
Page 4 to  
Page 7  
Page 0 to  
Page 3  
Table 109. Flash Low Byte Address SFR (EADRL, Address 0xC6)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
EADRL  
0
Flash pointer low byte address. This SFR is also used to write the write/erase protection bits for Page 16  
to Page 23 of the flash memory (see the Protecting the Flash section). Clearing the bits enables the  
protection.  
EADRL.7  
EADRL.6  
EADRL.5  
EADRL.4  
EADRL.3  
EADRL.2  
EADRL.1  
EADRL.0  
Page 23  
Page 22  
Page 21  
Page 20  
Page 19  
Page 18  
Page 17  
Page 16  
Table 110. Flash High Byte Address SFR (EADRH, Address 0xC7)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
EADRH  
0
Flash Pointer High Byte Address. This SFR is also used to write the write/erase protection bits for Page 24  
to Page 31 of the flash memory (see the Protecting the Flash section). Clearing the bits enables the  
protection.  
EADRH.7  
EADRH.6  
EADRH.5  
EADRH.4  
EADRH.3  
EADRH.2  
EADRH.1  
EADRH.0  
Page 31  
Page 30  
Page 29  
Page 28  
Page 27  
Page 26  
Page 25  
Page 24  
Flash Functions  
Erase Page  
The following sample 8052 code is provided to demonstrate  
how to use the flash functions. For these examples, Flash  
Memory Byte 0x3C00 is accessed.  
Erase the page containing Flash Memory Byte 0x3C00.  
MOV EADRH,#3Ch  
byte address  
; Select page through  
Write Byte  
MOV EADRL,#00h  
Write 0xF3 into flash memory byte 0x3C00.  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
key.  
; Write Flash security  
MOV EDATA,#F3h  
MOV EADRH,#3Ch  
MOV EADRL,#00h  
; Data to be written  
; Set up byte address  
MOV ECON,#02h; Erase Page  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
key.  
; Write Flash security  
; Write Byte  
MOV ECON,#01h  
Rev. B | Page 111 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Erase All  
Erase Page and Write Byte  
Erase all of the 16 kB flash memory.  
Erase the page containing flash memory byte 0x3C00 and then  
write 0xF3 to that address. Note that the other 511 bytes in this  
page are erased.  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
key.  
; Write Flash security  
MOV ECON,#03h  
; Erase all  
MOV EDATA,#F3h  
MOV EADRH,#3Ch  
MOV EADRL,#00h  
; Data to be written  
; Set up byte address  
Read Byte  
Read flash memory byte 0x3C00.  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
key.  
; Write flash security  
MOV EADRH,#3Ch  
MOV EADRL,#00h  
; Setup byte address  
MOV ECON,#05h; Erase page and then write  
byte  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
key.  
; Write Flash security  
; Read Byte  
MOV ECON,#04h  
; Data is ready in EDATA register  
Rev. B | Page 112 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
The sequence for writing the flash protection follows:  
PROTECTING THE FLASH MEMORY  
1. Set up the EADRH, EADRL, PROTB1, and PROTB0 SFRs  
with the write/erase protection bits. When erased, the  
protection bits default to 1, like any other bit of flash  
memory. The default protection setting is for no protection.  
To enable protection, write a 0 to the bits corresponding to  
the pages that should be protected.  
2. Set up the PROTR SFR with the read protection bits. Note  
that every read protection bit protects four pages. To enable  
the read protection bit, write a 0 to the bits that should be  
read protected.  
3. To enable the protection key, write to the PROTKY SFR.  
If enabled, the protection key is required to modify the  
protection scheme. The protection key, Flash Memory  
Address 0x3FFA, defaults to 0xFF; if the PROTKY register  
is not written to, it remains 0xFF. If the protection key is  
written to, the PROTKY SFR must be written with this  
value every time the protection functionality is accessed.  
Note that after the protection key is configured, it cannot  
be modified. Also note that the most significant bit of  
Address 0x3FFA is used to enable a lock mechanism for  
the watchdog settings (see the Watchdog Timer section for  
more information).  
Two forms of protection are offered for this flash memory: read  
protection and write/erase protection. The read protection ensures  
that any pages that are read protected cannot be read by the end  
user. The write protection ensures that the flash memory cannot  
be erased or written over. This protects the end system from  
tampering and can prevent the code from being overwritten in the  
event of a runaway program.  
Write/erase protection is individually selectable for all 32 pages.  
Read protection is selected in groups of four pages (see Figure  
94 for the groupings). The protection bits are stored in the last  
flash memory locations, Address 0x3FFA through Address  
0x3FFF (see Figure 96); four bytes are reserved for write/erase  
protection, one byte is for read protection, and another byte to  
set the flash protection key (PROTKY, Address 0xBB). The user  
must enable write/erase protection for the last page, at a  
minimum, for the entire protection scheme to work.  
Note that the read protection does not prevent MOVC  
commands from being executed within the code.  
There is an additional layer of protection offered by a protection  
security key (PROTKY). The user can set up a protection  
security key so that the protection scheme cannot be changed  
without this key. When the protection key has been configured,  
it cannot be modified.  
4. Run the protection command by writing 0x08 to the  
ECON SFR.  
5. Reset the chip to activate the new protection.  
Enabling Flash Protection by Code  
To enable read and write/erase protection for the last page only,  
use the following 8052 code. Writing the flash protection  
command to the ECON SFR initiates programming of the  
protection bits in the flash.  
The protection bytes in the flash can be programmed using the  
flash controller command and programming ECON to 0x08. In  
this case, the EADRH, EADRL, PROTB1, and PROTB0 bytes  
are used to store the data to be written to the 32 bits of write  
protection. Note that the EADRH and EADRL registers are not  
used as data pointers here but to store write protection data.  
; enable read protection on the last four  
pages only  
MOV PROTR,#07Fh  
EADRH  
WP  
31  
WP  
30  
WP  
29  
WP  
28  
WP  
27  
WP  
26  
WP  
25  
WP  
24  
0x3FFF  
0x3FFE  
0x3FFD  
0x3FFC  
0x3FFB  
WP  
23  
WP  
22  
WP  
21  
WP  
20  
WP  
19  
WP  
18  
WP  
17  
WP  
16  
EADRL  
; set up a protection key of 0A3h. This  
command can be  
WP  
15  
WP  
14  
WP  
13  
WP  
12  
WP  
11  
WP  
10  
WP  
9
WP  
8
PROTB1  
PROTB0  
PROTR  
PROTKY  
; omitted to use the default protection key  
of 0xFF  
WP  
7
WP  
6
WP  
5
WP  
4
WP  
3
WP  
2
WP  
1
WP  
0
RP  
RP  
RP  
RP  
RP  
RP  
RP  
7:4  
RP  
3:0  
MOV PROTKY,#0A3h  
31:28 27:24 23:20 19:16 15:12 11:8  
WDOG  
LOCK  
PROTECTION KEY  
0x3FFA  
0x3FF9  
; write the flash key to the FLSHKY register  
to enable flash  
; access. The flash access key is not  
configurable.  
MOV FLSHKY,#3Bh  
0x3E00  
Figure 96. Flash Protection in Page 31  
; write flash protection command to the ECON  
register  
MOV ECON,#08h  
Rev. B | Page 113 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Enabling Flash Protection by Emulator Commands  
Protection bits can be modified from a 1 to a 0, even after the  
last page has been protected. In this way, more protection can  
be added but none can be removed.  
Another way to set the flash protection bytes is to use the  
reserved emulator commands available only in download mode.  
These commands write directly to the SFRs and can be used to  
duplicate the operation described in the Enabling Flash  
Protection by Code section. When these flash bytes are written,  
the part can exit emulation mode by reset and the protections  
are effective. This method can be used in production and  
implemented after downloading the program. The commands  
used for this operation are an extension of the commands listed  
in Application Note uC004, Understanding the Serial Download  
Protocol, available at www.analog.com.  
When the last page is read protected, the protection bits can still  
be read by the user code. All other bits on this page are not  
available for reading.  
The protection scheme is intended to protect the end system. Pro-  
tection should be disabled while developing and emulating code.  
Flash Memory Timing  
Typical program and erase times for the flash memory are  
shown in Table 111.  
Command with ASCII Code I or 0x49 writes the data into R0.  
Command with ASCII Code F or 0x46 writes R0 into the  
SFR address defined in the data of this command.  
Table 111. Flash Memory Program and Erase Times  
Bytes  
Flash Memory  
Timing  
Command  
Affected  
Write Byte  
Erase Page  
Erase All  
Read Byte  
Erase Page and Write Byte  
Verify Byte  
1 byte  
512 bytes  
16 kB  
1 byte  
512 bytes  
1 byte  
30 μs  
Omitting the protocol defined in uC004, the sequence to load  
protections is similar to the sequence mentioned in the  
Enabling Flash Protection by Code section, except that two  
emulator commands are necessary to replace one assembly  
command. For example, to write the protection value in  
EADRH (Address 0xC7), the following two commands must be  
executed:  
20 ms  
200 ms  
100 ns  
21 ms  
100 ns  
Note that the core microcontroller operation is idled until the  
requested flash memory operation is complete. In practice, this  
means that even though the flash operation is typically initiated  
with a two-machine-cycle MOV instruction to write to the flash  
control SFR (ECON, Address 0xB9), the next instruction is not  
executed until the Flash/EE operation is complete. This means  
that the core cannot respond to interrupt requests until the  
Flash/EE operation is complete, although the core peripheral  
functions, such as counter/timers, continue to count, as  
configured throughout this period.  
Command I with data = value of Protection Byte 0x3FFF.  
Command F with data = 0xC7.  
With this protocol, the protection can be written to the flash  
memory using the same sequence as described in the Enabling  
Flash Protection by Code section. When the part is reset, the  
protection is effective.  
Notes on Flash Protection  
The flash protection scheme is disabled by default so that none  
of the pages of the flash are protected from reading or writing/  
erasing.  
IN-CIRCUIT PROGRAMMING  
Serial Downloading  
The last page must be write/erase protected for the protection  
scheme to work.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 facilitate code download via the standard UART  
serial port. The parts enter serial download mode after a reset or  
To activate the protection settings, the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 must be reset after  
configuring the protection.  
SDEN  
a power cycle if the  
pin is pulled low through an external  
1 kΩ resistor. Once in serial download mode, the hidden  
embedded download kernel executes. This allows the user to  
download code to the full 16 kB of flash memory while the  
device is in-circuit in its target application hardware.  
After configuring protection on the last page and resetting the  
part, protections that have been enabled can be removed only  
by mass erasing the flash memory. The protection bits are read  
and erase protected by enabling read and write/erase protection  
on the last page, but the protection bits are never truly write  
protected.  
Protection configured in the last page of the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 affects whether flash  
memory can be accessed in serial download mode. Read  
protected pages cannot be read. Write/erase protected pages  
cannot be written or erased.  
Rev. B | Page 114 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
TIMERS  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 has three 16-bit timer/counters: Timer/Counter 0,  
Timer/Counter 1, and Timer/Counter 2. The timer/counter  
hardware is included on-chip to relieve the processor core of  
overhead inherent in implementing timer/counter functionality  
in software. Each timer/counter consists of two 8-bit registers:  
THx and TLx (x = 0, 1, or 2). All three timers can be configured  
to operate as timers or as event counters.  
When functioning as a counter, the TLx register is incremented  
by a 1-to-0 transition at its corresponding external input pin:  
T0, T1, or T2. When the samples show a high in one cycle and a  
low in the next cycle, the count is incremented. Because it takes  
two machine cycles (two core clock periods) to recognize a 1-to-0  
transition, the maximum count rate is half the core clock frequency.  
There are no restrictions on the duty cycle of the external input  
signal, but to ensure that a given level is sampled at least once  
before it changes, it must be held for a minimum of one full  
machine cycle. User configuration and control of all timer  
operating modes is achieved via the SFRs listed in Table 112.  
When functioning as a timer, the TLx SFR is incremented every  
machine cycle. (Users can think of it as counting machine cycles.)  
Because a machine cycle on a single-cycle core consists of one core  
clock period, the maximum count rate is the core clock frequency.  
Table 112. Timer SFRs  
SFR  
Address  
Bit Addressable  
Description  
TCON  
TMOD  
TL0  
TL1  
TH0  
0x88  
0x89  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 control (see Table 114).  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer./Counter 1 mode (see Table 113).  
Timer 0 low byte (see Table 117).  
Timer 1 low byte (see Table 119).  
Timer 0 high byte (see Table 116).  
0x8A  
0x8B  
0x8C  
0x8D  
0xC8  
0xCA  
0xCB  
0xCC  
0xCD  
TH1  
Timer 1 high byte (see Table 118).  
T2CON  
RCAP2L  
RCAP2H  
TL2  
Timer/Counter 2 control (see Table 115).  
Timer 2 reload/capture low byte (see Table 123).  
Timer 2 reload/capture high byte (see Table 122).  
Timer 2 low byte (Table 121).  
TH2  
Timer 2 high byte (see Table 120).  
TIMER REGISTERS  
Table 113. Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 Mode SFR (TMOD, Address 0x89)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
7
Gate1  
C/T1  
0
Timer 1 gating control. Set by software to enable Timer/Counter 1 only when the INT1 pin is high and the  
TR1 control is set. Cleared by software to enable Timer 1 whenever the TR1 control bit is set.  
6
0
Timer 1 timer or counter select bit. Set by software to select counter operation (input from T1 pin). Cleared  
by software to select the timer operation (input from internal system clock).  
[5:4]  
T1/M1,  
T1/M0  
00  
Timer 1 mode select bits.  
T1/M1, T1/M0  
Result  
00  
TH1 (Address 0x8D) operates as an 8-bit timer/counter. TL1 (Address 0x8D) serves as  
5-bit prescaler.  
01  
10  
11  
16-bit timer/counter. TH1 and TL1 are cascaded; there is no prescaler.  
8-bit autoreload timer/counter. TH1 holds a value to reload into TL1 each time it overflows.  
Timer/Counter 1 stopped.  
3
Gate0  
C/T0  
0
Timer 0 gating control. Set by software to enable Timer/Counter 0 only when the INT0 pin is high and the TR0  
control bit is set. Cleared by software to enable Timer 0 whenever the TR0 control bit is set in the  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 control SFR (TCON, Address 0x88)  
2
0
Timer 0 timer or counter select bit. Set by software to the select counter operation (input from T0 pin).  
Cleared by software to the select timer operation (input from internal system clock).  
[1:0]  
T0/M1,  
T0/M0  
00  
Timer 0 mode select bits.  
T0/M1, T0/M0  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
TH0 operates as an 8-bit timer/counter. TL0 serves as a 5-bit prescaler.  
16-bit timer/counter. TH0 and TL0 are cascaded; there is no prescaler.  
8-bit autoreload timer/counter. TH0 holds a value to reload into TL0 each time it overflows.  
TL0 is an 8-bit timer/counter controlled by the standard Timer 0 control bits. TH0 is an  
8-bit timer only, controlled by Timer 1 control bits.  
Rev. B | Page 115 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 114. Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 Control SFR (TCON, Address 0x88)  
Bit  
Address  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default  
Description  
7
0x8F  
TF1  
TR1  
TF0  
TR0  
IE11  
0
0
0
0
0
Timer 1 overflow flag. Set by hardware on a Timer/Counter 1 overflow. Cleared by hardware  
when the program counter (PC) vectors to the interrupt service routine.  
Timer 1 run control bit. Set by the user to turn on Timer/Counter 1. Cleared by the user to  
turn off Timer/Counter 1.  
Timer 0 overflow flag. Set by hardware on a Timer/Counter 0 overflow. Cleared by hardware  
when the PC vectors to the interrupt service routine.  
Timer 0 run control bit. Set by the user to turn on Timer/Counter 0. Cleared by the user to  
turn off Timer/Counter 0.  
External Interrupt 1 (INT1) flag. Set by hardware by a falling edge or by a zero level applied  
to the external interrupt pin, INT1, depending on the state of Bit IT1. Cleared by hardware  
when the PC vectors to the interrupt service routine only if the interrupt was transition activated.  
If level activated, the external requesting source, rather than the on-chip hardware, controls  
the request flag.  
6
5
4
3
0x8E  
0x8D  
0x8C  
0x8B  
2
1
0x8A  
0x89  
IT11  
IE01  
0
0
External Interrupt 1 (IE1) trigger type. Set by software to specify edge sensitive detection, that  
is, 1-to-0 transition. Cleared by software to specify level sensitive detection, that is, zero  
level.  
External Interrupt 0 (INT0) flag. Set by hardware by a falling edge or by a zero level being  
applied to the external interrupt pin, INT0, depending on the state of Bit IT0. Cleared by  
hardware when the PC vectors to the interrupt service routine only if the interrupt was  
transition activated. If level activated, the external requesting source, rather than the on-chip  
hardware, controls the request flag.  
0
0x88  
IT01  
0
External Interrupt 0 (IE0) Trigger Type. Set by software to specify edge sensitive detection, that is,  
1-to-0 transition. Cleared by software to specify level sensitive detection, that is, zero level.  
1
INT0  
INT1  
interrupt pins.  
These bits are not used to control Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 but are instead used to control and monitor the external  
and  
Table 115. Timer/Counter 2 Control SFR (T2CON, Address 0xC8)  
Bit  
Address  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default  
Description  
7
0xCF  
TF2  
0
0
0
Timer 2 overflow flag. Set by hardware on a Timer 2 overflow. TF2 cannot be set when  
either RCLK = 1 or TCLK = 1. Cleared by user software.  
Timer 2 external flag. Set by hardware when either a capture or reload is caused by a  
negative transition on T2EX pin and EXEN2 = 1. Cleared by user software.  
Receive clock enable bit. Set by the user to enable the serial port to use Timer 2 overflow  
pulses for its receive clock in Serial Port Mode 1 and Serial Port Mode 3. Cleared by the user  
to enable Timer 1 overflow to be used for the receive clock.  
6
5
0xCE  
0xCD  
EXF2  
RCLK  
4
3
0xCC  
0xCB  
TCLK  
0
0
Transmit clock enable bit. Set by the user to enable the serial port to use Timer 2 overflow  
pulses for its transmit clock in Serial Port Mode 1 and Serial Port Mode 3. Cleared by the user  
to enable Timer 1 overflow to be used for the transmit clock.  
Timer 2 external enable flag. Set by the user to enable a capture or reload to occur as a  
result of a negative transition on the T2EX pin if Timer 2 is not being used to clock the serial  
port. Cleared by the user for Timer 2 to ignore events at T2EX.  
EXEN2  
2
1
0xCA  
0xC9  
TR2  
C/T2  
0
0
Timer 2 start/stop control bit. Set by the user to start Timer 2. Cleared by the user to stop Timer 2.  
Timer 2 timer or counter function select bit. Set by the user to select the counter function  
(input from external T2 pin). Cleared by the user to select the timer function (input from  
the on-chip core clock).  
0
0xC8  
CAP2  
0
Timer 2 capture/reload select bit. Set by the user to enable captures on negative transitions  
at T2EX if EXEN2 = 1. Cleared by the user to enable autoreloads with Timer 2 overflows or  
negative transitions at T2EX when EXEN2 = 1. When either RCLK = 1 or TCLK = 1, this bit is  
ignored and the timer is forced to autoreload on Timer 2 overflow.  
Rev. B | Page 116 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Mode 0 (13-Bit Timer/Counter)  
Table 116. Timer 0 High Byte SFR (TH0, Address 0x8C)  
Mode 0 configures an 8-bit timer/counter. Figure 97 shows  
Mode 0 operation. Note that the divide-by-12 prescaler is not  
present on the single-cycle core.  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
TH0  
0
Timer 0 data high byte.  
Table 117. Timer 0 Low Byte SFR (TL0, Address 0x8A)  
Bit  
fCORE  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
C/T0 = 0  
[7:0]  
TL0  
0
Timer 0 data low byte.  
INTERRUPT  
TL0  
TH0  
TF0  
(5 BITS) (8 BITS)  
C/T0 = 1  
Table 118. Timer 1 High Byte SFR (TH1, Address 0x8D)  
P0.6/T0  
GATE  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
CONTROL  
[7:0]  
TH1  
0
Timer 1 data high byte.  
TR0  
Table 119. Timer 1 Low Byte SFR (TL1, Address 0x8B)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
I
NT0  
[7:0]  
TL1  
0
Timer 1 data low byte.  
Figure 97. Timer/Counter 0, Mode 0  
In this mode, the timer register is configured as a 13-bit register.  
As the count rolls over from all 1s to all 0s, it sets the timer  
overflow flag, TF0 (Address 0x88[5]). TF0 can then be used to  
request an interrupt. The counted input is enabled to the timer  
Table 120. Timer 2 High Byte SFR (TH2, Address 0xCD)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
TH2  
0
Timer 2 data high byte.  
Table 121. Timer 2 Low Byte SFR (TL2, Address 0xCC)  
INT0  
when TR0 = 1 and either Gate0 to 0 or  
= 1. Setting Gate0  
INT0  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
to 1 allows the timer to be controlled by the external input  
[7:0]  
TL2  
0
Timer 2 data low byte.  
to facilitate pulse width measurements. TR0 is a control bit in  
the Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 control SFR  
(TCON, Address 0x88); the Gate0/Gate1 bits are in  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 mode SFR (TMOD,  
Address 0x89). The 13-bit register consists of all eight bits of  
Timer 0 high byte SFR (TH0, Address 0x8C) and the lower five  
bits of Timer 0 low byte SFR (TL0, Address 0x8A). The upper  
three bits of TL0 SFR are indeterminate and should be ignored.  
Setting the run flag (TR0) does not clear the registers.  
Table 122. Timer 2 Reload/Capture High Byte SFR  
(RCAP2H, Address 0xCB)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
TH2  
0
Timer 2 reload/  
capture high byte.  
Table 123. Timer 2 Reload/Capture Low Byte SFR (RCAP2L,  
Address 0xCA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
Mode 1 (16-Bit Timer/Counter)  
[7:0]  
TL2  
0
Timer 2 reload/  
capture low byte.  
Mode 1 is the same as Mode 0 except that the Mode 1 timer  
register runs with all 16 bits. Mode 1 is shown in Figure 98.  
fCORE  
TIMER 0 AND TIMER 1  
C/T0 = 0  
Timer 0 High/Low and Timer 1 High/Low Data SFRs  
INTERRUPT  
TL0  
TH0  
TF0  
(8 BITS) (8 BITS)  
Each timer consists of two 8-bit SFRs. They are Timer 0 high  
byte (TH0, Address 0x8C), Timer 0 low byte (TL0, Address 0x8A),  
Timer 1 high byte (TH1, Address 0x8D), and Timer 1 low byte  
(TL1, Address 0x8B). These SFRs can be used as independent  
registers or combined into a single 16-bit register, depending on  
the timer mode configuration (see Table 116 to Table 119).  
C/T0 = 1  
P0.6/T0  
CONTROL  
TR0  
GATE  
INT0  
Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 Operating Modes  
Figure 98. Timer/Counter 0, Mode 1  
This section describes the operating modes for Timer/Counter 0  
and Timer/Counter 1. Unless otherwise noted, these modes of  
operation are the same for both Timer 0 and Timer 1.  
Rev. B | Page 117 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Mode 2 (8-Bit Timer/Counter with Autoreload)  
TIMER 2  
Timer/Counter 2 Data Registers  
Mode 2 configures the timer register as an 8-bit counter (TL0)  
with automatic reload as shown in Figure 99. Overflow from TL0  
not only sets TF0 but also reloads TL0 with the contents of TH0,  
which is preset by software. The reload leaves TH0 unchanged.  
Timer/Counter 2 also has two pairs of 8-bit data registers  
associated with it: Timer 2 high byte SFR (TH2, Address 0xCD),  
Timer 2 low byte SFR (TL2, Address 0xCC), Timer 2 reload/  
capture high byte SFR (RCAP2H, Address 0xCB), and Timer 2  
reload/capture low byte SFR (RCAP2L, Address 0xCA). These  
are used both as timer data registers and as timer capture/reload  
registers (see Table 120 to Table 123).  
fCORE  
C/T = 0  
INTERRUPT  
TL0  
TF0  
(8 BITS)  
C/T = 1  
Timer/Counter 2 Operating Modes  
P0.6/T0  
CONTROL  
TR0  
The following sections describe the operating modes for  
Timer/Counter 2. The operating modes are selected by bits in  
the Timer/Counter 2 control SFR (T2CON, Address 0xC8), as  
shown in Table 115 and Table 124.  
RELOAD  
GATE  
INT0  
TH0  
(8 BITS)  
Figure 99. Timer/Counter 0, Mode 2  
Table 124. T2CON Operating Modes  
RCLK (or) TCLK  
CAP2  
TR2  
Mode  
Mode 3 (Two 8-Bit Timer/Counters)  
0
0
1
X
0
1
X
X
1
1
1
0
16-bit autoreload  
16-bit capture  
Baud rate  
Off  
Mode 3 has different effects on Timer 0 and Timer 1. Timer 1 in  
Mode 3 simply holds its count. The effect is the same as setting  
TR1 = 0. Timer 0 in Mode 3 establishes TL0 and TH0 as two  
separate counters. This configuration is shown in Figure 100.  
16-Bit Autoreload Mode  
T
TL0 uses the Timer 0 control bits, C/ , Gate0 (see Table 113),  
INT0  
TR0 and TF0 (see Table 114), and the  
pin. TH0 is locked  
The 16-bit autoreload mode has two options that are selected by  
EXEN2 (Bit 3) in the Timer/Counter 2 control SFR (T2CON,  
Address 0xC8). If EXEN2 = 0 when Timer 2 rolls over, it not  
only sets TF2 but also causes the Timer 2 SFRs to be reloaded  
with the 16-bit value in both the Timer 2 reload/capture high byte  
SFR (RCAP2H, Address 0xCB) and Timer 2 reload/capture low  
byte SFR (RCAP2L, Address 0xCA) registers, which are preset  
by software. If EXEN2 = 1, Timer 2 performs the same events as  
when EXEN2 = 0 but adds a 1-to-0 transition at the external  
input, T2EX, which triggers the 16-bit reload and sets EXF2.  
Autoreload mode is shown in Figure 101.  
into a timer function (counting machine cycles) and takes over  
the use of TR1 and TF1 from Timer 1. Therefore, TH0 controls the  
Timer 1 interrupt. Mode 3 is provided for applications requiring  
an extra 8-bit timer or counter.  
When Timer 0 is in Mode 3, Timer 1 can be turned on and off  
by switching it out of and into its own Mode 3, or it can be used  
by the serial interface as a baud rate generator. In fact, Timer 1  
can be used in any application not requiring an interrupt from  
Timer 1 itself.  
CORE  
CLK/12  
fCORE  
16-Bit Capture Mode  
C/T = 0  
INTERRUPT  
TL0  
TF0  
The 16-bit capture mode has two options that are selected by  
EXEN2 (Bit 3) in the Timer/Counter 2 control SFR (T2CON,  
Address 0xC8). If EXEN2 = 0, Timer 2 is a 16-bit timer or  
counter that, upon overflowing, sets the Timer 2 overflow bit  
(TF2, Bit 7). This bit can be used to generate an interrupt. If  
EXEN2 = 1, then Timer 2 performs the same events as when  
EXEN2 = 0, but it adds a l-to-0 transition on the T2E external  
input, causing the current value in the Timer 2 SFRs, TL2  
(Address 0xCC) and TH2 (Address 0xCD), to be captured into  
the RCAP2L (Address 0xCA) and RCAP2H (Address 0xCB)  
SFRs, respectively. In addition, the transition at T2EX causes the  
EXF2 bit (Bit 6) in the T2CON SFR (Address 0xC8) to be set,  
and EXF2, like TF2, can generate an interrupt. Capture mode is  
shown in Figure 102. The baud rate generator mode is selected  
by RCLK = 1 and/or TCLK = 1.  
(8 BITS)  
C/T = 1  
P0.6/T0  
CONTROL  
TR0  
GATE  
INT0  
INTERRUPT  
TH0  
fCORE/12  
TF1  
(8 BITS)  
TR1  
Figure 100. Timer/Counter 0, Mode 3  
Rev. B | Page 118 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
In either case, if Timer 2 is used to generate the baud rate, the TF2  
interrupt flag does not occur. Therefore, Timer 2 interrupts do not  
occur and do not have to be disabled. In this mode, the EXF2 flag  
can, however, still cause interrupts that can be used as a third  
external interrupt. Baud rate generation is described as part of the  
UART serial port operation in the UART Serial Interface section.  
fCORE  
C/T2 = 0  
TL2  
(8 BITS)  
TH2  
(8 BITS)  
C/T2 = 1  
P1.4/T2  
CONTROL  
TR2  
RELOAD  
TRANSITION  
DETECTOR  
RCAP2L  
RCAP2H  
TF2  
TIMER  
INTERRUPT  
P1.3/  
T2EX  
EXF2  
CONTROL  
EXEN2  
Figure 101. Timer/Counter 2, 16-Bit Autoreload Mode  
fCORE  
C/T2 = 0  
C/T2 = 1  
TL2  
(8 BITS)  
TH2  
(8 BITS)  
TF2  
P1.4/T2  
CONTROL  
TR2  
TIMER  
INTERRUPT  
CAPTURE  
TRANSITION  
DETECTOR  
RCAP2L  
RCAP2H  
P1.3/  
T2EX  
EXF2  
CONTROL  
EXEN2  
Figure 102. Timer/Counter 2, 16-Bit Capture Mode  
Rev. B | Page 119 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
PLL  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 are intended for use with a 32.768 kHz watch crystal.  
A PLL locks onto a multiple of this frequency to provide a stable  
4.096 MHz clock for the system. The core can operate at this  
frequency or at binary submultiples of it to allow power savings  
when maximum core performance is not required. The default  
core clock is the PLL clock divided by 4, or 1.024 MHz. The ADE  
energy measurement clock is derived from the PLL clock and is  
maintained at 4.096 MHz/5 MHz, 819.2 kHz across all CD  
settings.  
The PLL is controlled by the CD bits in the power control SFR  
(POWCON, Address 0xC5). To protect erroneous changes to  
the POWCON SFR, a key is required to modify the register.  
First, the key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1) is written with the  
key, 0xA7, and then a new value is written to the POWCON SFR.  
If the PLL loses lock, the MCU is reset and the PLL_FLT bit (Bit 4)  
is set in the peripheral configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address 0xF4).  
Set the PLLACK bit in the start ADC measurement SFR  
(ADCGO, Address 0xD8) to acknowledge the PLL fault,  
clearing the PLL_FLT bit.  
PLL REGISTERS  
Table 125. Power Control SFR (POWCON, Address 0xC5)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
7
Reserved  
1
0
Reserved.  
6
METER_OFF  
Set this bit to 1 to turn off the modulators and energy metering DSP circuitry to reduce power if  
metering functions are not needed in PSM0.  
5
Reserved  
COREOFF  
Reserved  
CD  
0
0
This bit should be kept at 0 for proper operation.  
Set this bit to 1 to shut down the core if in the PSM1 operating mode.  
Reserved.  
4
3
[2:0]  
010  
Controls the core clock frequency (fCORE). fCORE = 4.096 MHz/2CD.  
CD  
Result (fCORE in MHz)  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
4.096  
2.048  
1.024  
0.512  
0.256  
0.128  
0.064  
0.032  
Writing to the Power Control SFR (POWCON, Address 0xC5)  
Note that writing data to the POWCON SFR involves writing 0xA7 into the key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1) followed by a write to the  
POWCON SFR.  
Table 126. Key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:0]  
KYREG  
0
Write 0xA7 to the KYREG SFR before writing to the POWCON SFR to unlock it.  
Write 0xEA to the KYREG SFR before writing to the INTPR, HTHSEC, SEC, MIN, or HOUR timekeeping SFRs  
to unlock them.  
Rev. B | Page 120 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
REAL-TIME CLOCK (RTC)  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 have an embedded real-time clock (RTC) as shown in  
Figure 103. The external 32.768 kHz crystal is used as the clock  
source for the RTC. Calibration is provided to compensate the  
nominal crystal frequency and for variations in the external  
crystal frequency over temperature. By default, the RTC is  
maintained active in all power saving modes. The RTC counters  
retain their values through watchdog resets and external resets.  
They are only reset during a power-on reset.  
RTC SFRS  
Note that none of the real-time clock SFRs are bit addressable.  
Table 127. Real-Time Clock SFR  
SFR  
Address  
Description  
TIMECON  
HTHSEC  
0xA1  
0xA2  
RTC Configuration (see Table 128).  
Hundredths of a Second Counter  
(see Table 129).  
Seconds Counter (see Table 130).  
Minutes Counter (see Table 131).  
Hours Counter (see Table 132).  
Alarm Interval (see Table 133).  
RTC Nominal Compensation (see  
Table 134).  
SEC  
MIN  
HOUR  
INTVAL  
RTCCOMP  
0xA3  
0xA4  
0xA5  
0xA6  
0xF6  
32.768kHz  
CRYSTAL  
RTCCOMP  
TEMPCAL  
CALIBRATION  
TEMPCAL  
0xF7  
RTC Temperature Compensation (see  
Table 135).  
CALIBRATED  
32.768kHz  
RTCEN  
Protecting the RTC from Runaway Code  
ITS1 ITS0  
To protect the RTC from runaway code, a key must be written  
to the KYREG SFR (Address, 0xC1) to obtain write access to the  
interrupt pins configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF),  
hundredths of a second counter SFR (HTHSEC, Address 0xA2),  
seconds counter SFR (SEC, 0xA3), minutes counter SFR (MIN,  
Address 0xA4), and hours counter SFR (HOUR, Address 0xA5).  
KYREG should be set to 0xEA to unlock it and reset it to zero  
after a timekeeping register is written to. The RTC registers can  
be written using the following 8052 assembly code:  
8-BIT  
PRESCALER  
HUNDREDTHS COUNTER  
HTHSEC  
INTERVAL  
TIMEBASE  
SELECTION  
MUX  
ITEN  
SECOND COUNTER  
SEC  
MOV  
MOV  
KYREG,#0EAh  
INTPR,#080h  
MINUTE COUNTER  
MIN  
HOUR COUNTER  
HOUR  
MIDNIGHT EVENT  
8-BIT  
INTERVAL COUNTER  
ALARM  
EVENT  
EQUAL?  
INTVAL SFR  
Figure 103. RTC Implementation  
Rev. B | Page 121 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 128. RTC Configuration SFR (TIMECON, Address 0xA1)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
7
MIDNIGHT  
0
Midnight flag. This bit is set when the RTC rolls over to 00:00:00:00. It can be cleared by the user to  
indicate that the midnight event has been serviced. In twenty-four hour mode, the midnight flag is  
raised once a day at midnight. When this interrupt is used for wake-up from PSM2 to PSM1 mode, the  
RTC interrupt must be serviced and the flag cleared to be allowed to enter PSM2 mode.  
6
TFH  
0
Twenty-four hour mode. This bit is retained during a watchdog reset or an external reset. It is reset after a  
power-on reset (POR).  
TFH  
0
1
Result  
256-hour mode. The HOUR register rolls over from 255 to 0.  
24-hour mode. The HOUR register rolls over from 23 to 0.  
[5:4]  
ITS  
SIT  
0
0
Interval timer time base selection.  
ITS  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Result (Time Base)  
1/128 sec.  
Second.  
Minute.  
Hour.  
3
Interval Timer 1 alarm.  
SIT  
0
1
Result  
The ALARM flag is set after INTVAL counts, and then another interval count starts.  
The ALARM flag is set after one time interval.  
2
1
ALARM  
ITEN  
0
0
Interval timer alarm flag. This bit is set when the configured time interval has elapsed. It can be cleared  
by the user to indicate that the alarm event has been serviced. This bit cannot be set to 1 by user code.  
Interval timer enable.  
ITEN  
Result  
0
1
The interval timer is disabled. The 8-bit interval timer counter is reset.  
Set this bit to enable the interval timer.  
0
Reserved  
1
This bit must be left set for proper operation.  
Table 129. Hundredths of a Second Counter SFR (HTHSEC, Address 0xA2)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
HTHSEC  
0
This counter updates every 1/128 second, referenced from the calibrated 32.768 kHz clock. It overflows  
from 127 to 00, incrementing the seconds counter (SEC). This register is retained during a watchdog  
reset or an external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
Table 130. Seconds Counter SFR (SEC, Address 0xA3)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
SEC  
0
This counter updates every second, referenced from the calibrated 32.768 kHz clock. It overflows from 59 to  
00, incrementing the minutes counter (MIN). This register is retained during a watchdog reset or an  
external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
Table 131. Minutes Counter SFR (MIN, Address 0xA4)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
MIN  
0
This counter updates every minute, referenced from the calibrated 32.768 kHz clock. It overflows from 59 to  
00, incrementing the hours counter, HOUR. This register is retained during a watchdog reset or an  
external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
Table 132. Hours Counter SFR (HOUR, Address 0xA5)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:0]  
HOUR  
0
This counter updates every hour, referenced from the calibrated 32.768 kHz clock. If the TFH bit in the  
RTC configuration SFR (TIMECON, 0xA1) is set, the HOUR SFR overflows from 23 to 00, setting the  
MIDNIGHT bit and creating a pending RTC interrupt. If the TFH bit is cleared, the HOUR SFR overflows from  
255 to 00, setting the MIDNIGHT bit and creating a pending RTC interrupt. This register is retained during  
a watchdog reset or an external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
Rev. B | Page 122 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 133. RTC Alarm Interval SFR (INTVAL, Address 0xA6)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:0]  
INTVAL  
0
The interval timer counts according to the time base established in the ITS bits of the RTC configuration SFR  
(TIMECON, 0xA1). When the number of counts is equal to INTVAL, the ALARM flag is set and a pending  
RTC interrupt is created. Note that the interval counter is eight bits. Therefore, it can count up to 255 seconds,  
for example.  
Table 134. RTC Nominal Compensation SFR (RTCCOMP, Address 0xF6)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
Holds the nominal RTC compensation value at 25°C. This register is retained during a watchdog reset  
or an external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
[7:0]  
RTCCOMP  
0
Table 135. RTC Temperature Compensation SFR (TEMPCAL, Address 0xF7)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:0]  
TEMPCAL  
0
The TEMPCAL SFR is adjusted based on the temperature read in the TEMPADC SFR to calibrate the RTC  
over temperature. This allows the external crystal shift to be compensated over temperature. This  
register is retained during a watchdog reset or an external reset. It is reset after a POR.  
Table 136. Interrupt Pins Configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
RTCCAL  
0
Controls the RTC calibration output. When set, the RTC calibration frequency selected by the FSEL bits  
is output on the P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL pin.  
[6:5]  
FSEL  
Sets RTC calibration output frequency and calibration window.  
FSEL  
Result (Calibration Window, Frequency)  
30.5 sec, 1 Hz  
30.5 sec, 512 Hz  
0.244 sec, 500 Hz  
0.244 sec, 16 kHz  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
4
Reserved  
INT1PRG  
[3:1]  
000  
Controls the function of the INT1 pin.  
INT1PRG  
Result  
x
x
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
x
x
GPIO  
BCTRL  
INT1 input disabled  
INT1 input enabled  
0
INT0PRG  
0
Controls the function of the INT0 pin.  
INT0PRG  
Result  
0
1
INT0 input disabled  
INT0 input enabled  
Table 137. Key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:0]  
KYREG  
0
Write 0xA7 to this SFR before writing to the POWCON SFR, which unlocks KYREG.  
Write 0xEA to this SFR before writing to the INTPR, HTHSEC, SEC, MIN, or HOUR timekeeping registers  
to unlock KYREG.  
Rev. B | Page 123 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
READ AND WRITE OPERATIONS  
RTC MODES  
Writing to the RTC Registers  
The RTC can be configured in a 24-hour mode or a 256-hour  
mode. A midnight event is generated when the RTC hour  
counter rolls over from 23 to 0 or 255 to 0, depending on  
whether the TFH bit is set in the RTC Configuration SFR  
(TIMECON, Address 0xA1). The midnight event sets the  
MIDNIGHT flag in the TIMECON SFR, and a pending RTC  
interrupt is created. The RTC midnight event wakes the 8052  
MCU core if the MCU is asleep in PSM2 mode when the  
midnight event occurs.  
The RTC circuitry runs off a 32.768 kHz clock. The timekeeping  
registers, the hundredths of a second counter SFR (HTHSEC,  
Address 0xA2), seconds counter SFR (SEC, Address 0xA3),  
minutes counter SFR (MIN, Address 0xA4), and hours counter  
SFR (HOUR, Address 0xA5), are updated with a 32.768 kHz  
clock. However, the RTC configuration SFR (TIMECON,  
Address 0xA1) and alarm interval SFR (INTVAL, Address 0xA6)  
are updated with a 128 Hz clock. It takes up to two 128 Hz clock  
cycles from when the MCU writes to the TIMECON SFR or  
INTVAL SFR until there is a successful update in the RTC.  
In the 24-hour mode, the midnight event is generated once a  
day at midnight. The 24-hour mode is useful for updating a  
software calendar to keep track of the current day. The 256-hour  
mode results in power savings during extended operation in  
PSM2 mode because the MCU core wakes up less frequently.  
To protect the RTC timekeeping registers from runaway code,  
a key must be written to the Key SFR (KYREG, Address 0xC1),  
which is described in Table 126, to obtain write access to the  
HTHSEC, SEC, MIN and HOUR SFRs. KYREG should be set to  
0xEA to unlock the timekeeping registers and reset to 0 after a  
timekeeping register is written to. The RTC registers can be  
written to using the following 8052 assembly code:  
RTC INTERRUPTS  
The RTC midnight interrupt and alarm interrupt are enabled by  
setting the ETI bit in the Interrupt Enable and Priority 2 SFR  
(IEIP2, Address 0xA9). When a midnight or alarm event  
occurs, a pending RTC interrupt is generated. If the RTC  
interrupt is enabled, the program vectors to the RTC interrupt  
address and the pending interrupt are cleared. If the RTC  
interrupt is disabled, the RTC interrupt remains pending until  
the RTC interrupt is enabled. The program then vectors to the  
RTC interrupt address.  
MOV  
CALL  
RTCKey,#0EAh  
UpdateRTC  
UpdateRTC:  
MOV KYREG,RTCKey  
MOV SEC,#30  
MOV KYREG,RTCKey  
MOV MIN,#05  
The MIDNIGHT flag and ALARM flag are set when the  
midnight event and alarm event occur, respectively. The user  
should manage these flags to keep track of which event caused  
an RTC interrupt by servicing the event and clearing the  
appropriate flag in the RTC interrupt servicing routine.  
MOV KYREG,RTCKey  
MOV HOUR,#04  
MOV KYREG,#00h  
RET  
Note that if the ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 are awakened by an RTC event, either by  
the MIDNIGHT event or an ALARM event, the pending RTC  
interrupt must be serviced before the device can go back to  
sleep again. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 keep waking up until this interrupt has  
been serviced.  
Reading the RTC Counter SFRs  
The RTC cannot be stopped to read the current time because  
stopping the RTC introduces an error in its timekeeping.  
Therefore, the RTC is read on the fly, and the counter registers  
must be checked for overflow. This can be accomplished  
through the following 8052 assembly code:  
Interval Timer Alarm  
The RTC can be used as an interval timer. When the interval  
timer is enabled by setting the ITEN bit in the RTC Configuration  
SFR (TIMECON, Address 0xA1), the interval timer clock source  
selected by the ITS1 and ITS0 bits is passed through an 8-bit  
counter. This counter increments on every interval timer clock  
pulse until it is equal to the value in the alarm interval SFR  
(INTVAL, Address 0xA6). Then, an alarm event is generated,  
setting the ALARM flag and creating a pending RTC interrupt.  
If the SIT bit in the RTC configuration SFR (TIMECON,  
Address 0xA1) is cleared, the 8-bit counter is cleared and starts  
counting again. If the SIT bit is set, the 8-bit counter is held in  
reset after the alarm occurs.  
ReadAgain:  
MOV R0,HTHSEC  
MOV R1,SEC  
; using Bank 0  
MOV R2,MIN  
MOV R3,HOUR  
MOV A,HTHSEC  
CJNE A, 00h, ReadAgain ; 00h is R0 in  
Bank 0  
Rev. B | Page 124 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Take care when changing the interval timer time base. The  
recommended procedure is as follows:  
A shorter window of 0.244 sec is offered for fast calibration  
during PSM0 or PSM1 mode. Two output frequencies are  
offered for this RTC calibration output mode: 500 Hz with  
FSEL = 10 and 16 kHz with FSEL = 11 in the INTPR SFR.  
Note that for the 0.244 second calibration window, the RTC is  
clocked 125 times faster than in normal mode, resulting in  
timekeeping registers that represent seconds/125, minutes/125,  
and hours/125 instead of seconds, minutes, and hours.  
Therefore, this mode should be used for calibration only.  
1. If the alarm interval SFR (INTVAL, Address 0xA6) is going  
to be modified, write to this register first. Then, wait for  
one 128 Hz clock cycle to synchronize with the RTC,  
64,000 cycles at a 4.096 MHz instruction cycle clock.  
2. Disable the interval timer by clearing the ITEN bit in the  
RTC configuration SFR (TIMECON, Address 0xA1).  
Then, wait for one 128 Hz clock cycle to synchronize with  
the RTC, 64,000 cycles at a 4.096 MHz instruction cycle  
clock.  
3. Read the TIMECON SFR to ensure that the ITEN bit is  
clear. If it is not, wait for another 128 Hz clock cycle.  
4. Set the time-base bits (ITS) in the TIMECON SFR to  
configure the interval. Wait for a 128 Hz clock cycle for this  
change to take effect.  
Table 138. RTC Calibration Options  
Calibration  
Window (sec)  
fRTCCAL  
(Hz)  
Option  
FSEL  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Normal Mode 0  
Normal Mode 1  
Calibration Mode 0  
Calibration Mode 1  
30.5  
30.5  
0.244  
0.244  
1
512  
500  
16,000  
The RTC alarm event wakes the 8052 MCU core if the MCU is  
in PSM2 mode when the alarm event occurs.  
When no RTC compensation is applied, RTCCOMP and  
TEMPCAL are equal to zero, the nominal compensation  
required to account for the error in the external crystal can be  
determined. In this case, it is not necessary to wait for an entire  
calibration window to determine the error in the pulse output.  
Calculating at the error in frequency between two consecutive  
pulses on the P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL pin is sufficient.  
RTC CALIBRATION  
The RTC provides registers to compensate for the tolerance of  
the crystal frequency and its variation over temperature.  
Up to 248 ppm frequency error can be calibrated with the RTC  
circuitry. The compensation is fully digital and implemented by  
adding or subtracting pulses from the crystal clock signal.  
The value to write to the RTCCOMP SFR is calculated from the  
% error or seconds per day error on the frequency output. Each  
LSB of the RTCCOMP SFR represents 2 ppm of correction  
where 1 sec/day error is equal to 11.57 ppm.  
The resolution of the RTC nominal compensation SFR  
(RTCCOMP, Address 0xF6) is 2 ppm/LSB or 0.17 sec/day/LSB.  
The RTC compensation circuitry adds the RTC temperature  
compensation SFR (TEMPCAL, Address 0xF7) and the RTC  
nominal compensation SFR (RTCCOMP, Address 0xF6) to  
determine how much compensation is required. The sum of  
these two registers is limited to 248 ppm or 42.85 sec/day.  
RTCCOMP = 5000 ×(% Error)  
1
RTCCOMP =  
×(sec/day Error)  
2 ×11.57  
During calibration, user software writes the current time. Refer  
to the Read and Write Operations section for more information  
on how to read and write to the RTC timekeeping registers.  
Calibrating the RTC  
The nominal crystal frequency can be calibrated by adjusting  
the RTCCOMP SFR so that the clock going into the RTC is  
precisely 32.768 kHz at 25°C.  
Calibration Flow  
An RTC calibration pulse output is provided on the P0.2/CF1/  
RTCCAL pin. Enable the RTC output by setting the RTCCAL  
bit in the interrupt pins configuration SFR (INTPR,  
Address 0xFF).  
The RTC calibration is accurate to within 2 ppm over a 30.5 sec  
window in all operational modes: PSM0, PSM1, and PSM2. Two  
output frequencies are offered for the normal RTC mode: 1 Hz  
with FSEL = 00 and 512 Hz with FSEL = 01 in the interrupt pins  
configuration SFR (INTPR, Address 0xFF).  
Rev. B | Page 125 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
UART SERIAL INTERFACE  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 UART can be configured in one of four modes.  
(P1.0/RxD) and TxD (P1.1/TxD) pins, and the firmware  
interface is through the SFRs presented in Table 139.  
Both the serial port receive and transmit registers are accessed  
through the serial port buffer SFR (SBUF, Address 0x99).  
Writing to SBUF loads the transmit register, and reading SBUF  
accesses a physically separate receive register.  
Shift register with baud rate fixed at fCORE/12  
8-bit UART with variable baud rate  
9-bit UART with baud rate fixed at fCORE/64 or fCORE/32  
9-bit UART with variable baud rate  
An enhanced UART mode is offered by using the UART timer  
and by providing enhanced frame error, break error, and  
overwrite error detection. This mode is enabled by setting the  
EXTEN bit in the configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF). See  
the UART Additional Features section. The enhanced serial  
baud rate control SFR (SBAUDT, Address 0x9E) and UART  
timer fractional divider SFR (SBAUDF, Address 0x9D) are used  
to configure the UART timer and to indicate the enhanced  
UART errors.  
Variable baud rates are defined by using an internal timer to  
generate any rate between 300 bauds/sec and 115,200 bauds/sec.  
The UART serial interface provided in the ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 is a full-duplex serial interface. It is also  
receive buffered by storing the first received byte in a receive  
buffer until the reception of the second byte is complete. The  
physical interface to the UART is provided via the RxD  
UART SFRS  
Table 139. Serial Port SFRs  
SFR  
Address  
Bit Addressable  
Description  
SCON  
SBUF  
SBAUDT  
SBAUDF  
0x98  
0x99  
0x9E  
0x9D  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Serial communications control (see Table 140).  
Serial port buffer (see Table 141).  
Enhanced serial baud rate control (see Table 142).  
UART timer fractional divider (see Table 143).  
Table 140. Serial Communications Control SFR (SCON, Address 0x98)  
Bit  
Bit Address  
Mnemonic Default Description  
[7:6]  
0x9F, 0x9E  
SM0, SM1 00 UART serial mode select bits. These bits select the serial port operating mode.  
SM0, SM1  
Result (Selected Operating Mode)  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Mode 0, shift register, fixed baud rate (fCORE/12).  
Mode 1, 8-bit UART, variable baud rate.  
Mode 2, 9-bit UART, fixed baud rate (fCORE/32) or (fCORE/16).  
Mode 3, 9-bit UART, variable baud rate.  
5
0x9D  
SM2  
0
Multiprocessor communication enable bit. Enables multiprocessor communication in  
Mode 2 and Mode 3 and framing error detection in Mode 1.  
In Mode 0, SM2 should be cleared.  
In Mode 1, if SM2 is set, RI is not activated if a valid stop bit was not received.  
If SM2 is cleared, RI is set as soon as the byte of data is received.  
In Mode 2 or Mode 3, if SM2 is set, RI is not activated if the received ninth data bit in RB8 is 0.  
If SM2 is cleared, RI is set as soon as the byte of data is received.  
4
3
2
1
0x9C  
0x9B  
0x9A  
0x99  
REN  
TB8  
RB8  
TI  
0
0
0
0
Serial port receive enable bit. Set by user software to enable serial port reception.  
Cleared by user software to disable serial port reception.  
Serial port transmit (Bit 9). The data loaded into TB8 is the ninth data bit transmitted in  
Mode 2 and Mode 3.  
Serial port receiver (Bit 9). The ninth data bit received in Mode 2 and Mode 3 is latched  
into RB8. For Mode 1, the stop bit is latched into RB8.  
Serial port transmit interrupt flag. Set by hardware at the end of the eighth bit in Mode 0 or  
at the beginning of the stop bit in Mode 1, Mode 2, and Mode 3.  
TI must be cleared by user software.  
0
0x98  
RI  
0
Serial port receive interrupt flag. Set by hardware at the end of the eighth bit in Mode 0 or  
halfway through the stop bit in Mode 1, Mode 2, and Mode 3.  
RI must be cleared by user software.  
Rev. B | Page 126 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 141. Serial Port Buffer SFR (SBUF, Address 0x99)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
SBUF  
0
Serial port data buffer.  
Table 142. Enhanced Serial Baud Rate Control SFR (SBAUDT, Address 0x9E)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
OWE  
0
Overwrite error. This bit is set when new data is received and RI = 1 (Bit 0 in the SCON SFR, Address  
0x98). It indicates that SBUF was not read before the next character was transferred in, causing the  
prior SBUF data to be lost. Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
6
5
FE  
BE  
0
0
Frame error. This bit is set when the received frame does not have a valid stop bit. This bit is read  
only and updated every time a frame is received.  
Break error. This bit is set whenever the receive data line (Rx) is low for longer than a full transmission  
frame, which is the time required for a start bit, eight data bits, a parity bit, and half a stop bit. This  
bit is updated every time a frame is received.  
[4:3]  
[2:0]  
SBTH  
DIV  
0
0
Extended divider ratio for baud rate setting as shown in Table 144.  
Binary divider. See Table 144.  
DIV[2:0]  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
Result  
Divide by 1.  
Divide by 2.  
Divide by 4.  
Divide by 8.  
Divide by 16.  
Divide by 32.  
Divide by 64.  
Divide by 128.  
Table 143. UART Timer Fractional Divider SFR (SBAUDF, Address 0x9D)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
UARTBAUDEN  
0
UART baud rate enable. Set to enable UART timer to generate the baud rate. When set, the SMOD  
bit (PCON[7]), the TCLK bit (T2CON[4]), and the RCLK bit (T2CON[5]) are ignored.  
Cleared to let the baud rate be generated as per a standard 8052.  
6
[5:0]  
Not implemented, write don’t care.  
UART timer fractional divider Bit 5.  
SBAUDF  
0
Rev. B | Page 127 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 144. Common Baud Rates Using UART Timer with a 4.096 MHz PLL Clock  
Ideal Baud  
115,200  
115,200  
57,600  
57,600  
38,400  
38,400  
38,400  
19,200  
19,200  
19,200  
19,200  
9600  
9600  
9600  
9600  
9600  
4800  
4800  
4800  
4800  
4800  
4800  
2400  
2400  
2400  
2400  
2400  
2400  
2400  
300  
CD  
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
0
1
2
3
0
1
2
3
4
0
1
2
3
4
5
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SBTH  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
DIV  
1
0
2
1
2
1
0
3
2
1
0
4
3
2
1
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
7
7
6
5
4
3
2
SBAUDT  
0x01  
0x00  
0x02  
0x01  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
0x05  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
0x06  
0x05  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
0x17  
0x0F  
0x07  
0x06  
0x05  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
SBAUDF  
0x87  
0x87  
0x87  
0x87  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
0xAB  
% Error  
+0.16  
+0.16  
+0.16  
+0.16  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
−0.31  
300  
300  
300  
300  
300  
300  
300  
Rev. B | Page 128 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
All of the following conditions must be met at the time the final  
shift pulse is generated to receive a character:  
UART OPERATION MODES  
Mode 0 (Shift Register with Baud Rate Fixed at fCORE/12)  
If the extended UART is disabled (EXTEN = 0 in the CFG  
SFR, Address 0xAF)), RI must be 0 to receive a character.  
This ensures that the data in the SBUF SFR is not  
overwritten if the last received character has not been read.  
If frame error checking is enabled by setting SM2, the  
received stop bit must be set to receive a character. This  
ensures that every character received comes from a valid  
frame, with both a start bit and a stop bit.  
Mode 0 is selected when the SM0 and SM1 bits in the serial  
communications control register SFR (SCON, Address 0x98)  
are cleared. In this shift register mode, serial data enters and  
exits through the RxD pin. TxD outputs the shift clock. The baud  
rate is fixed at fCORE/12. Eight data bits are transmitted or received.  
Transmission is initiated by any instruction that writes to the  
serial port buffer SFR (SBUF, Address 0x99). The data is shifted  
out of the RxD line. The eight bits are transmitted with the least  
significant bit (LSB) first.  
If any of these conditions is not met, the received frame is  
irretrievably lost, and the receive interrupt flag (RI) is not set.  
Reception is initiated when the serial port receive enable bit  
(REN, Bit 4) is 1 and the serial port receive interrupt bit (RI, Bit  
0) is 0. When RI is cleared, the data is clocked into the RxD line,  
and the clock pulses are output from the TxD line as shown in  
Figure 104.  
If the received frame has met these conditions, the following  
events occur:  
The eight bits in the receive shift register are latched into  
the SBUF SFR.  
The ninth bit (stop bit) is clocked into RB8 in the SCON SFR.  
The receiver interrupt flag (RI) is set.  
RxD  
(DATA OUT)  
DATA BIT 0  
DATA BIT 1  
DATA BIT 6  
DATA BIT 7  
TxD  
(SHIFT CLOCK)  
Mode 2 (9-Bit UART with Baud Fixed at fCORE/64 or fCORE/32)  
Figure 104. 8-Bit Shift Register Mode  
Mode 2 is selected by setting SM0 and clearing SM1. In this  
mode, the UART operates in 9-bit mode with a fixed baud rate.  
The baud rate is fixed at fCORE/64 by default, although setting the  
SMOD bit in the program control SFR (PCON, Address 0x87)  
doubles the frequency to fCORE/32. Eleven bits are transmitted or  
received: a start bit (0), eight data bits, a programmable ninth  
bit, and a stop bit (1). The ninth bit is most often used as a parity  
bit or as part of a multiprocessor communication protocol,  
although it can be used for anything, including a ninth data bit,  
if required.  
Mode 1 (8-Bit UART, Variable Baud Rate)  
Mode 1 is selected by clearing SM0 (Bit 7) and setting SM1 (Bit  
6). Each data byte (LSB first) is preceded by a start bit (0) and  
followed by a stop bit (1). Therefore, each frame consists of 10  
bits transmitted on the TxD pin or received on the RxD pin.  
The baud rate is set by a timer overflow rate. Timer 1 or Timer 2  
can be used to generate baud rates, or both timers can be used  
simultaneously where one generates the transmit rate and the  
other generates the receive rate. There is also a dedicated timer  
for baud rate generation, the UART timer, which has a fractional  
divisor to precisely generate any baud rate (see the UART Timer  
Generated Baud Rates section).  
To use the ninth data bit as part of a communication protocol for  
a multiprocessor network such as RS-485, the ninth bit is set to  
indicate that the frame contains the address of the device with  
which the master wants to communicate. The devices on the  
network are always listening for a packet with the ninth bit set  
and are configured such that if the ninth bit is cleared, the frame  
is not valid, and a receive interrupt is not generated. If the ninth  
bit is set, all devices on the network receive the address and obtain a  
receive character interrupt. The devices examine the address and, if  
it matches one of the preprogrammed addresses of the devices,  
that device configures itself to listen to all incoming frames, even  
those with the ninth bit cleared. Because the master has initiated  
communication with that device, all the following packets with  
the ninth bit cleared are intended specifically for that addressed  
device until another packet with the ninth bit set is received. If  
the address does not match, the device continues to listen for  
address packets.  
Transmission is initiated by a write to the serial port buffer SFR  
(SBUF, Address 0x99). Next, a stop bit (1) is loaded into the  
ninth bit position of the interval serial port shift register. The  
data is output bit-by-bit until the stop bit appears on TxD and  
the transmit interrupt flag (TI) is automatically set as shown in  
Figure 105.  
STOP BIT  
START  
BIT  
D0 D1 D2  
D3  
D4  
D5 D6  
D7  
TxD  
TI  
(SCON.1)  
SET INTERRUPT  
(FOR EXAMPLE,  
READY FOR MORE DATA)  
Figure 105. 8-Bit Variable Baud Rate  
Reception is initiated when a 1-to-0 transition is detected on  
the RxD pin. Assuming that a valid start bit is detected,  
character reception continues. The eight data bits are clocked  
into the serial port shift register.  
Rev. B | Page 129 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
To transmit, the eight data bits must be written into the serial  
port buffer SFR (SBUF, Address 0x99). The ninth bit must be  
written to TB8 (Bit 3) in the serial communications control  
Register Bit Description SFR (SCON, 0x98). When transmission  
is initiated, the eight data bits from SBUF are loaded into the  
transmit shift register (LSB first). The ninth data bit, held in  
TB8, is loaded into the ninth bit position of the transmit shift  
register. The transmission starts at the next valid baud rate  
clock. The serial port transmit interrupt flag (TI, Bit 1) is set as  
soon as the transmission completes, when the stop bit appears  
on TxD.  
UART BAUD RATE GENERATION  
Mode 0 Baud Rate Generation  
The baud rate in Mode 0 is fixed.  
f
CORE  
Mode 0 Baud Rate =  
12  
Mode 2 Baud Rate Generation  
The baud rate in Mode 2 depends on the value of the PCON.7  
(SMOD) bit in the program control SFR (PCON, 0x87). If  
SMOD = 0, the baud rate is 1/32 of the core clock. If SMOD = 1,  
the baud rate is 1/16 of the core clock.  
All of the following conditions must be met at the time the final  
shift pulse is generated to receive a character:  
2SMOD  
Mode 2 Baud Rate =  
× fCORE  
32  
If the extended UART is disabled (EXTEN = 0 in the CFG  
SFR), RI must be 0 to receive a character. This ensures that  
the data in SBUF is not overwritten if the last received  
character has not been read.  
If multiprocessor communication is enabled by setting  
SM2, the received ninth bit must be set to receive a character.  
This ensures that only frames with the ninth bit set, which  
are frames that contain addresses, generate a receive  
interrupt.  
Mode 1 and Mode 3 Baud Rate Generation  
The baud rates in Mode 1 and Mode 3 are determined by the  
overflow rate of the timer generating the baud rate, that is,  
Timer 1, Timer 2, or the dedicated baud rate generator, UART  
timer, which has an integer and a fractional divisor.  
Timer 1 Generated Baud Rates  
When Timer 1 is used as the baud rate generator, the baud rates  
in Mode 1 and Mode 3 are determined by the Timer 1 overflow  
rate. The value of SMOD is as follows:  
If any of these conditions is not met, the received frame is  
irretrievably lost, and the receive interrupt flag (RI) is not set.  
Mode 1 or Mode 3 Baud Rate =  
Reception for Mode 2 is similar to that of Mode 1. The eight  
data bytes are input at the RxD pin (LSB first) and loaded onto  
the receive shift register. If the received frame has met the  
previous criteria, the following events occur:  
2SMOD  
32  
× Timer 1 Overflow Rate  
The Timer 1 interrupt should be disabled in this application.  
The timer itself can be configured for either timer or counter  
operation and in any of its three running modes. In the most  
typical application, it is configured for timer operation in  
autoreload mode (high nibble of TMOD = 0010 binary). In that  
case, the baud rate is given by the following formula:  
The eight bits in the receive shift register are latched into  
the SBUF SFR.  
The ninth data bit is latched into RB8 in the SCON SFR.  
The receiver interrupt flag (RI) is set.  
Mode 3 (9-Bit UART with Variable Baud Rate)  
2SMOD  
fCORE  
Mode 1 or Mode 3 Baud Rate =  
×
Mode 3 is selected by setting both SM0 and SM1. In this mode,  
the 8052 UART serial port operates in 9-bit mode with a variable  
baud rate. The baud rate is set by a timer overflow rate. Timer 1  
or Timer 2 can be used to generate baud rates, or both timers  
can be used simultaneously where one generates the transmit  
rate and the other generates the receive rate. There is also a  
dedicated timer for baud rate generation, the UART timer,  
which has a fractional divisor to precisely generate any baud  
rate (see the UART Timer Generated Baud Rates section). The  
operation of the 9-bit UART is the same as for Mode 2, but the  
baud rate can be varied.  
32  
(256 TH1)  
Timer 2 Generated Baud Rates  
Baud rates can also be generated by using Timer 2. Using Timer 2  
is similar to using Timer 1 in that the timer must overflow 16 times  
before a bit is transmitted or received. Because Timer 2 has a  
16-bit autoreload mode, a wider range of baud rates is possible.  
1
16  
Mode 1 or Mode 3 Baud Rate =  
× Timer 2 Overflow Rate  
Therefore, when Timer 2 is used to generate baud rates, the  
timer increments every two clock cycles rather than every core  
machine cycle as before. It increments six times faster than  
Timer 1, and, therefore, baud rates six times faster are possible.  
In all four modes, transmission is initiated by any instruction  
that uses SBUF as a destination register. Reception is initiated in  
Mode 0 when RI = 0 and REN = 1. Reception is initiated in the  
other modes by the incoming start bit if REN = 1.  
Rev. B | Page 130 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Because Timer 2 has 16-bit autoreload capability, very low baud  
fCORE  
rates are still possible. Timer 2 is selected as the baud rate  
generator by setting TCLK and/or RCLK in Timer/Counter 2  
control SFR (T2CON, Address 0xC8). The baud rates for transmit  
and receive can be simultaneously different. Setting RCLK  
and/or TCLK puts Timer 2 into its baud rate generator mode, as  
shown in Figure 107.  
TIMER 1/TIMER 2  
Tx CLOCK  
FRACTIONAL  
DIVIDER  
÷(1 + SBAUDF/64)  
TIMER 1/TIMER 2  
Rx CLOCK  
1
0
0
DIV + SBTH  
÷2  
Rx CLOCK  
1
÷32  
In this case, the baud rate is given by the following formula:  
UARTBAUDEN  
Tx CLOCK  
UART TIMER  
Rx/Tx CLOCK  
Mode 1 or Mode 3 Baud Rate =  
fCORE  
Figure 106. UART Timer, UART Baud Rate  
Two SFRs, enhanced serial baud rate control SFR (SBAUDT,  
Address 0x9E) and UART timer fractional divider SFR  
(SBAUDF, Address 0x9D), are used to control the UART timer.  
SBAUDT is the baud rate control SFR; it sets up the integer  
divider (DIV) and the extended divider (SBTH) for the UART  
timer.  
(
16×  
65536 RCAP2H : RCAP2L  
[ ( )])  
UART Timer Generated Baud Rates  
The high integer dividers in a UART block mean that high speed  
baud rates are not always possible. In addition, generating baud  
rates requires the exclusive use of a timer, rendering it unusable  
for other applications when the UART is required. To address  
this problem, each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 has a dedicated baud rate timer (UART  
timer) specifically for generating highly accurate baud rates. The  
UART timer can be used instead of Timer 1 or Timer 2 for gener-  
ating very accurate high speed UART baud rates, including  
115,200 bps. This timer also allows a much wider range of baud  
rates to be obtained. In fact, every desired bit rate from 12 bps  
to 393,216 bps can be generated to within an error of 0.8%. The  
UART timer also frees up the other three timers, allowing them  
to be used for different applications. A block diagram of the  
UART timer is shown in Figure 106.  
The appropriate value to write to DIV (Bits [2:0]) and SBTH  
(Bits [4:3]) bits can be calculated using the following formula  
where fCORE is defined in the POWCON SFR (see Table 26).  
Note that the DIV value must be rounded down to the nearest  
integer.  
fCORE  
16×Baud Rate  
log  
DIV + SBTH =  
log  
(
2
)
TIMER 1  
OVERFLOW  
2
0
1
SMOD  
CONTROL  
fCORE  
C/T2 = 0  
TIMER 2  
OVERFLOW  
1
1
0
0
TL2  
(8 BITS)  
TH2  
(8 BITS)  
RCLK  
16  
C/T2 = 1  
T2  
PIN  
Rx  
CLOCK  
TR2  
TCLK  
16  
RELOAD  
Tx  
CLOCK  
NOTE: AVAILABILITY OF ADDITIONAL  
EXTERNAL INTERRUPT  
RCAP2H  
RCAP2L  
TIMER 2  
INTERRUPT  
T2EX  
PIN  
EXF 2  
CONTROL  
EXEN2  
TRANSITION  
DETECTOR  
Figure 107. Timer 2, UART Baud Rates  
Rev. B | Page 131 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
START  
STOP  
SBAUDF is the fractional divider ratio required to achieve the  
D0  
D1  
D2  
D3  
D4  
D5  
D6  
D7  
Rx  
required baud rate. The appropriate value for SBAUDF can be  
calculated with the following formula:  
RI  
fCORE  
FE  
EXTEN = 1  
SBAUDF = 64×  
1  
DIV +SBTH  
16×2  
× Baud Rate  
Figure 108. UART Timing in Mode 1  
Note that SBAUDF should be rounded to the nearest integer.  
After the values for DIV and SBAUDF are calculated, the actual  
baud rate can be calculated with the following formula:  
START  
STOP  
D0  
D1  
D2  
D3  
D4  
D5  
D6  
D7  
D8  
Rx  
RI  
fCORE  
Actual Baud Rate =  
SBAUDF  
16×2DIV +SBTH × 1+  
FE  
EXTEN = 1  
64  
Figure 109. UART Timing in Mode 2 and Mode 3  
For example, to obtain a baud rate of 9600 bps while operating  
at a core clock frequency of 4.096 MHz with the PLL CD bits  
equal to 0,  
The 8052 standard UART does not provide break error detection.  
However, for an 8-bit UART, a break error can be detected when  
the received character is 0, a null character, and when there is  
no stop bit because the RB8 bit is low. Break error detection is  
not possible for a 9-bit 8052 UART because the stop bit is not  
recorded. The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 enhanced break error detection is available  
through the BE bit in the SBAUDT SFR.  
4,096,000  
16×9600  
log  
DIV + SBTH =  
= 4.74 = 4  
log  
2
( )  
Note that the DIV result is rounded down.  
4,096,000  
SBAUDF = 64×  
1 = 42.67 = 0x2B  
The 8052 standard UART prevents overwrite errors by not  
allowing a character to be received when the RI, receive interrupt  
flag, is set. However, it does not indicate if a character has been  
lost because the RI bit is set when the frame is received. The  
enhanced UART overwrite error detection provides this infor-  
mation. When the enhanced 8052 UART is enabled, a frame is  
received regardless of the state of the RI flag. If RI = 1 when a  
new byte is received, the byte in SCON is overwritten, and the  
overwrite error flag is set. The overwrite error flag is cleared  
when SBUF is read.  
16×23 ×9600  
Thus, the actual baud rate is 9570 bps, resulting in a 0.31% error.  
UART ADDITIONAL FEATURES  
Enhanced Error Checking  
The extended UART provides frame error, break error, and  
over-write error detection. Framing errors occur when a stop  
bit is not present at the end of the frame. A missing stop bit  
implies that the data in the frame may not have been received  
properly. Break error detection indicates whether the Rx line  
has been low for longer than a 9-bit frame. It indicates that the  
data just received, a 0 or null character, is not valid because the  
master has disconnected. Overwrite error detection indicates when  
the received data has not been read fast enough and, as a result, a  
byte of data has been lost.  
The extended UART is enabled by setting the EXTEN bit in the  
Configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF).  
UART TxD Signal Modulation  
There is an internal 38 kHz signal that can be ORed with the  
UART transmit signal for use in remote control applications  
(see the 38 kHz Modulation section).  
The 8052 standard UART offers frame-error checking for an 8-bit  
UART through the SM2 and RB8 bits. Setting the SM2 bit prevents  
frames without a stop bit from being received. The stop bit is  
latched into the RB8 bit in the serial communications control  
SFR (SCON, Address 0x98). This bit can be examined to  
determine if a valid frame was received. The 8052 does not,  
however, provide frame error checking for a 9-bit UART. This  
enhanced error checking functionality is available through the  
frame error bit, FE, in the enhanced serial baud rate control SFR  
(SBAUDT, Address 0x9E). The FE bit is set on framing errors  
for both 8-bit and 9-bit UARTs.  
One of the events that can wake the MCU from sleep mode is  
activity on the Rx pin (see the 3.3 V Peripherals and Wake-Up  
Events section).  
Rev. B | Page 132 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE (SPI)  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 integrate a complete hardware serial peripheral  
interface on-chip. The SPI is full duplex so that eight bits of data  
are synchronously transmitted and simultaneously received.  
This SPI implementation is double buffered, allowing users to  
read the last byte of received data while a new byte is shifted in.  
The next byte to be transmitted can be loaded while the current  
byte is shifted out.  
SS  
(P0.7/ /T1) pins, while the firmware interface is via the SPI  
Configuration SFR 1 (SPIMOD1, Address 0xE8), the SPI  
Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9), the SPI  
interrupt status SFR (SPISTAT, Address 0xEA), the SPI/I2C  
transmit buffer SFR (SPI2CTx, Address 0x9A), and the SPI/I2C  
receive buffer SFR (SPI2CRx, Address 0x9B).  
Note that the SPI pins are shared with the I2C pins. Therefore, the  
user can enable only one interface at a time. The SCPS bit in the  
configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF) selects which peripheral  
is active.  
The SPI port can be configured for master or slave operation.  
The physical interface to the SPI is via the MISO (P0.5/MISO),  
SS  
MOSI (P0.4/MOSI/SDATA), SCLK (P0.6/SCLK/T0), and  
SPI REGISTERS  
Table 145. SPI SFR List  
SFR Address  
Mnemonic R/W  
Length (Bits)  
Default  
Description  
0x9A  
0x9B  
0xE8  
0xE9  
SPI2CTx  
SPI2CRx  
SPIMOD1  
SPIMOD2  
SPISTAT  
W
R
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
8
8
8
8
8
0
0
0x10  
0
0
SPI/I2C transmit buffer (see Table 146).  
SPI/I2C receive buffer (see Table 147).  
SPI Configuration SFR 1 (see Table 148).  
SPI Configuration SFR 2 (see Table 149).  
SPI/I2C interrupt status (see Table 150).  
0xEA  
Table 146. SPI/I2C Transmit Buffer SFR (SPI2CTx, Address 0x9A)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
SPI2CTx  
0
SPI or I2C transmit buffer. When the SPI2CTx SFR is written, its content is transferred to the transmit  
FIFO input. When a write is requested, the FIFO output is sent on the SPI or I2C bus.  
Table 147. SPI/I2C Receive Buffer SFR (SPI2CRx, Address 0x9B)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
[7:0]  
SPI2CRx  
0
SPI or I2C receive buffer. When SPI2CRx SFR is read, one byte from the receive FIFO output is  
transferred to SPI2CRx SFR. A new data byte from the SPI or I2C bus is written to the FIFO input.  
Rev. B | Page 133 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 148. SPI Configuration SFR 1 (SPIMOD1, Address 0xE8)  
Bit  
Address  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
[7:6]  
0xEF to  
0xEE  
Reserved  
0
Reserved.  
5
4
0xED  
0xEC  
INTMOD  
AUTO_SS  
0
SPI interrupt mode.  
INTMOD  
Result  
0
1
SPI interrupt is set when the SPI Rx buffer is full.  
SPI interrupt is set when the SPI Tx buffer is empty.  
1
Master mode, SS output control (see Figure 110).  
AUTO_SS Result  
0
The SS pin is held low while this bit is cleared. This allows manual chip select  
control using the SS pin.  
1
Single byte read or write. The SS pin goes low during a single byte  
transmission and then returns high.  
Continuous Transfer. The SS pin goes low during the duration of the multibyte  
continuous transfer and then returns high.  
3
2
0xEB  
0xEA  
SS_EN  
0
0
Slave mode, SS input enable.  
When this bit is set to Logic 1, the SS pin is defined as the slave select input pin for the SPI  
slave interface.  
RxOFW  
Receive buffer overflow write enable.  
RxOFW  
Result  
0
If the SPI2CRx SFR has not been read when a new data byte is received,  
the new byte is discarded.  
1
If the SPI2CRx SFR has not been read when a new data byte is received,  
the new byte overwrites the old data.  
[1:0]  
0xE9 to  
0xE8  
SPIR  
0
Master mode, SPI SCLK frequency.  
SPIR  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Result  
fCORE/8 = 512 kHz (if fCORE = 4.096 MHz).  
fCORE/16 = 256 kHz (if fCORE = 4.096 MHz).  
fCORE/32 = 128 kHz (if fCORE = 4.096 MHz).  
fCORE/64 = 64 kHz (if fCORE = 4.096 MHz).  
Rev. B | Page 134 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 149. SPI Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9)  
Bit Mnemonic Default Description  
7
SPICONT  
0
Master mode, SPI continuous transfer mode enable bit.  
SPICONT Result  
0
The SPI interface stops after one byte is transferred and SS is deasserted. A new data transfer  
can be initiated after a stalled period.  
1
The SPI interface continues to transfer data until no valid data is available in the SPI2CTx SFR.  
SS remains asserted until the SPI2CTx SFR and the transmit shift registers are empty.  
6
5
SPIEN  
0
0
SPI interface enable bit.  
SPIEN  
Result  
0
1
The SPI interface is disabled.  
The SPI interface is enabled.  
SPIODO  
SPI open-drain output configuration bit.  
SPIODO  
Result  
0
1
Internal pull-up resistors are connected to the SPI outputs.  
The SPI outputs are open drain and need external pull-up resistors. The pull-up voltage should  
not exceed the specified operating voltage.  
4
3
SPIMS_b  
SPICPOL  
0
0
SPI master mode enable bit.  
SPIMS_b Result  
0
1
The SPI interface is defined as a slave.  
The SPI interface is defined as a master.  
SPI clock polarity configuration bit (see Figure 112).  
SPICPOL Result  
0
The default state of SCLK is low, and the first SCLK edge is rising. Depending on the SPICPHA bit,  
the SPI data output changes state on the falling or rising edge of SCLK while the SPI data input is  
sampled on the rising or falling edge of SCLK.  
1
The default state of SCLK is high, and the first SCLK edge is falling. Depending on the SPICPHA  
bit, the SPI data output changes state on the rising or falling edge of SCLK while the SPI data  
input is sampled on the falling or rising edge of SCLK.  
2
SPICPHA  
0
SPI clock phase configuration bit (see Figure 112).  
SPICPHA Result  
0
The SPI data output changes state when SS goes low at the second edge of SCLK and then every  
two subsequent edges, whereas the SPI data input is sampled at the first SCLK edge and then  
every two subsequent edges.  
1
The SPI data output changes state at the first edge of SCLK and then every two subsequent  
edges, whereas the SPI data input is sampled at the second SCLK edge and then every two  
subsequent edges.  
1
0
SPILSBF  
TIMODE  
0
1
Master mode, LSB first configuration bit.  
SPILSBF  
Result  
0
1
The MSB of the SPI outputs is transmitted first.  
The LSB of the SPI outputs is transmitted first.  
Transfer and interrupt mode of the SPI interface.  
TIMODE Result  
1
This bit must be set to 1 for proper operation.  
Rev. B | Page 135 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 150. SPI Interrupt Status SFR (SPISTAT, Address 0xEA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic Default Description  
7
BUSY  
0
SPI peripheral busy flag.  
BUSY  
Result  
0
1
The SPI peripheral is idle.  
The SPI peripheral is busy transferring data in slave or master mode.  
6
MMERR  
0
SPI multimaster error flag.  
MMERR  
Result  
0
1
A multiple master error has not occurred.  
If the SS_EN bit (SPIMOD1, Address 0xE8) is set, enabling the slave select input and  
asserting the SS pin while the SPI peripheral is transferring data as a master, this flag is  
raised to indicate the error.  
Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
5
4
SPIRxOF  
SPIRxIRQ  
0
0
SPI receive overflow error flag. Reading the SPI2CRx SFR clears this bit.  
SPIRxOF  
TIMODE Result  
0
1
X
1
The SPI2CRx SFR (Address 0x9B) contains valid data.  
This bit is set if the SPI2CRx SFR is not read before the end of the next byte  
transfer. If the RxOFW bit (SPIMOD1, Address 0xF8) is set and this condition  
occurs, SPI2CRx is overwritten.  
SPI receive mode interrupt flag. Reading the SPI2CRx SFR clears this bit.  
SPIRxIRQ TIMODE Result  
0
1
X
0
The SPI2CRx register does not contain new data.  
This bit is set when the SPI2CRx register contains new data. If the SPI/I2C  
interrupt is enabled, an interrupt is generated when this bit is set. If the SPI2CRx  
register is not read before the end of the current byte transfer, the transfer stops  
and the SS pin is deasserted.  
1
1
The SPI2CRx register contains new data.  
3
2
SPIRxBF  
SPITxUF  
0
0
Status bit for SPI Rx buffer. When set, the Rx FIFO is full. A read of the SPI2CRx clears this flag.  
Status bit for SPI Tx buffer. When set, the Tx FIFO is underflowing and data can be written into SPI2CTx  
(Address 0x9A). Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
1
SPITxIRQ  
0
SPI transmit mode interrupt flag. Writing new data to the SPI2CTx SFR clears this bit.  
SPITxIRQ TIMODE Result  
0
1
1
X
0
1
The SPI2CTx SFR is full.  
The SPI2CTx SFR is empty.  
This bit is set when the SPI2CTx SFR is empty. If the SPI/I2C interrupt is enabled,  
an interrupt is generated when this bit is set. If new data is not written into the  
SPI2CTx SFR before the end of the current byte transfer, the transfer stops, and  
the SS pin is deasserted. Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
0
SPITxBF  
0
Status bit for the SPI Tx buffer. When set, the SPI Tx buffer is full. Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
SCLK (Serial Clock I/O Pin)  
SPI PINS  
The master serial clock (SCLK) is used to synchronize the data  
being transmitted and received through the MOSI and MISO  
data lines. The SCLK (P0.6/SCLK/T0) pin is configured as an  
output in master mode and as an input in slave mode.  
MISO (Master In, Slave Out Data I/O Pin)  
The MISO (P0.5/MISO) pin is configured as an input line in  
master mode and as an output line in slave mode. The MISO line  
on the master (data in) should be connected to the MISO line in  
the slave device (data out). The data is transferred as byte-wide  
(8-bit) serial data, MSB first.  
In master mode, the bit rate, polarity, and phase of the clock are  
controlled by the SPI Configuration SFR 1 (SPIMOD1, Address  
0xE8) and SPI Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9).  
MOSI (Master Out, Slave In Pin)  
In slave mode, the SPI Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2,  
Address 0xE9) must be configured with the phase and polarity  
of the expected input clock.  
The MOSI (P0.4/MOSI/SDATA) pin is configured as an output  
line in master mode and as an input line in slave mode. The  
MOSI line on the master (data out) should be connected to the  
MOSI line in the slave device (data in).The data is transferred as  
byte-wide (8-bit) serial data, MSB first.  
Rev. B | Page 136 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
In both master and slave modes, the data is transmitted on one  
Continuous Mode, SPICONT (SPIMOD2[7]) = 1  
edge of the SCLK signal and sampled on the other. It is important,  
therefore, that the SPICPHA and SPICPOL bits be configured  
the same for the master and slave devices.  
1. Write to the SPI2CTx SFR.  
2.  
is asserted low, and a write routine is initiated.  
SS  
3. Wait for the SPITxIRQ interrupt flag to write to SPI2CTx SFR.  
4. Transfer continues until the SPI2CTx register and transmit  
shift registers are empty.  
5. The SPITxIRQ interrupt flag is set when the SPI2CTx  
register is empty.  
(Slave Select Pin)  
SS  
In SPI slave mode, a transfer is initiated by the assertion of  
low. The SPI port then transmits and receives 8-bit data until  
SS  
SS  
the data is concluded by the deassertion of according to the  
SS  
6.  
is deasserted high.  
SS  
SPICON bit setting. In slave mode, is always an input.  
7. Write to SPI2CTx SFR to clear the SPITxIRQ interrupt flag.  
SS  
In SPI master mode, the (P0.7/T1) can be used to control  
Figure 110 shows the SPI output for certain automatic chip select  
and continuous mode selections. Note that if the continuous mode  
is not used, a short delay is inserted between transfers.  
data transfer to a slave device. In the automatic slave select  
SS  
control mode, the is asserted low to select the slave device  
and then raised to deselect the slave device after the transfer is  
complete. Automatic slave select control is enabled by setting the  
AUTO_SS bit in the SPI Configuration SFR 1 (SPIMOD1,  
Address 0xE8).  
SS  
SCLK  
SS  
In a multimaster system, the can be configured as an input so  
AUTO_SS = 1  
SPICONT = 1  
that the SPI peripheral can operate as a slave in some situations  
and as a master in others. In this case, the slave selects for the  
slaves controlled by this SPI peripheral should be generated  
with general I/O pins.  
DIN  
DIN1  
DIN2  
DOUT  
DOUT1  
DOUT2  
SPI MASTER OPERATING MODES  
The double buffered receive and transmit registers can be used to  
maximize the throughput of the SPI peripheral by continuously  
streaming out data in master mode. The continuous transmit mode  
is designed to use the full capacity of the SPI. In this mode, the  
master transmits and receives data until the SPI/I2C transmit  
buffer SFR (SPI2CTx, Address 0x9A) is empty at the start of  
a byte transfer. Continuous mode is enabled by setting the  
SPICONT bit (Bit 7) in the SPI Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2,  
Address 0xE9). The SPI peripheral also offers a single byte  
read/write function.  
SS  
SCLK  
AUTO_SS = 1  
SPICONT = 0  
DIN  
DIN1  
DIN2  
DOUT  
DOUT1  
DOUT2  
SS  
In master mode, the type of transfer is handled automatically,  
depending on the configuration of the SPICONT bit in the SPI  
Configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, 0xE9). The following  
procedures show the sequence of events that should be  
SCLK  
AUTO_SS = 0  
SPICONT = 0  
(MANUAL SS CONTROL)  
SS  
DIN  
DIN1  
DIN2  
performed for each master operating mode. Based on the  
configuration, some of these events take place automatically.  
Procedures for Using SPI as a Master  
DOUT  
DOUT1  
DOUT2  
Single Byte Write Mode, SPICONT (SPIMOD2[7]) = 0  
Figure 110. Automatic Chip Select and Continuous Mode Output  
1. Write to the SPI2CTx SFR.  
Note that reading the content of the SPI/I2C receive buffer SFR  
(SPI2CRx, Address 0x9B) should be done using a 2-cycle  
instruction set such as MOV A or SPI2CRX. Using a 3-cycle  
instruction such as MOV 0x3D or SPI2CRX does not transfer  
the right information into the target register.  
2.  
is asserted low, and a write routine is initiated.  
SS  
3. The SPITxIRQ interrupt flag is set when the SPI2CTx  
register is empty.  
4.  
5. Write to SPI2CTx SFR to clear the SPITxIRQ interrupt  
flag.  
is deasserted high.  
SS  
6. Write to SPI2CTx SFR to clear the SPITxIRQ interrupt  
flag.  
Rev. B | Page 137 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
(SPI2CRx, Address 0x9B) is not read before new data is ready to  
SPI INTERRUPT AND STATUS FLAGS  
be loaded into the SPI/I2C receive buffer SFR (SPI2CRx,  
Address 0x9B), an overflow condition has occurred. This  
overflow condition, indicated by the SPIRxOF flag, forces the  
new data to be discarded or overwritten if the RxOFW bit  
(SPIMOD1, Address 0xE8) is set.  
The SPI interface has several status flags that indicate the status  
of the double-buffered receive and transmit registers. Figure 111  
shows when the status and interrupt flags are raised. The transmit  
interrupt occurs when the internal serial port shift register is loaded  
with the data in the SPI/I2C transmit buffer SFR (SPI2CTx,  
Address 0x9A) register. If the SPI master is in transmit  
operating mode, and the SPI/I2C transmit buffer SFR (SPI2CTx,  
Address 0x9A) register has not been written with new data by  
the beginning of the next byte transfer, the transmit operation  
stops.  
SPITx  
SPIRx  
SPITxIRQ = 1  
SPIRxIRQ = 1  
TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER  
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER  
SPITx (EMPTY)  
SPIRx (FULL)  
STOPS TRANSFER IF TIMODE = 1  
SPIRxOF = 1  
TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER  
When a new byte of data is received in the SPI/I2C receive  
buffer SFR (SPI2CRx, Address 0x9B), the SPI receive interrupt  
flag is raised. If the data in the SPI/I2C receive buffer SFR  
Figure 111. SPI Receive and Transmit Interrupt and Status Flags  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL = 1)  
SCLK  
(SPICPOL=0)  
SS_b  
MISO  
MOSI  
?
?
MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB  
MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB  
SPICPHA = 1  
SPIRx1 AND  
SPITx1 FLAGS  
SPIRx0 AND  
SPITx0 FLAGS  
MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB  
MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB  
?
?
MISO  
MOSI  
SPICPHA = 0  
SPIRx1 AND  
SPITx1 FLAGS  
SPIRx0 AND  
SPITx0 FLAGS  
Figure 112. SPI Timing Configurations  
Rev. B | Page 138 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
I2C-COMPATIBLE INTERFACE  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 support a fully licensed I2C interface. The I2C  
interface is implemented as a full hardware master.  
The bit rate is defined in the I2CMOD SFR as follows:  
fCORE  
fSCLK  
=
16×2I2CR[1:0]  
SDATA (P0.4/MOSI/SDATA) is the data I/O pin, and SCLK  
(P0.6/SCLK/T0) is the serial clock. These two pins are shared  
with the MOSI and SCLK pins of the on-chip SPI interface.  
Therefore, the user can enable only one interface or the other  
on these pins at any given time. The SCPS bit (Bit 5) in the  
configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF) selects which  
peripheral is active.  
SLAVE ADDRESSES  
The I2C slave address SFR (I2CADR, Address 0xE9) contains  
the slave device ID. The LSB of this register contains a  
read/write request. A write to this SFR starts the I2C  
communication.  
I2C REGISTERS  
The I2C peripheral interface consists of five SFRs:  
The two pins used for data transfer, SDATA and SCLK, are  
configured in a wire-AND format that allows arbitration in  
a multimaster system.  
The transfer sequence of an I2C system consists of a master device  
initiating a transfer by generating a start condition while the bus  
is idle. The master transmits the address of the slave device and  
the direction of the data transfer in the initial address transfer. If  
the slave acknowledges, the data transfer is initiated. This continues  
until the master issues a stop condition and the bus becomes idle.  
I2CMOD  
SPI2CSTAT  
I2CADR  
SPI2CTx  
SPI2CRx  
Because the SPI and I2C serial interfaces share the same pins,  
they also share the same SFRs, such as the SPI2CTx and SPI2CRx  
SFRs. In addition, the I2CMOD, I2CADR, and SPI2CSTAT, and  
SPI2CTx SFRs are shared with the SPIMOD1, SPIMOD2, and  
SPISTAT SFRs, respectively.  
SERIAL CLOCK GENERATION  
The I2C master in the system generates the serial clock for a  
transfer. The master channel can be configured to operate in  
fast mode (256 kHz) or standard mode (32 kHz).  
Table 151. I2C SFR List  
SFR Address  
Mnemonic  
SPI2CTx  
SPI2CRx  
I2CMOD  
I2CADR  
SPI2CSTAT  
R/W  
W
R
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Length  
Default  
Description  
0x9A  
0x9B  
0xE8  
0xE9  
8
8
8
8
8
SPI/I2C transmit buffer (see Table 146).  
SPI/I2C receive buffer (see Table 147).  
I2C mode (see Table 152).  
0
0
0
0
I2C slave address (see Table 153).  
I2C interrupt status register (see Table 154).  
0xEA  
Table 152. I2C Mode SFR (I2CMOD, Address 0xE8)  
Bit  
Bit Address Mnemonic Default Description  
7
0xEF  
I2CEN  
0
I2C enable bit. When this bit is set to Logic 1, the I2C interface is enabled. A write to the  
I2CADR SFR starts a communication.  
[6:5]  
0xEE to 0xED I2CR  
0
I2C SCLK frequency.  
I2CR  
00  
01  
10  
11  
Result  
fCORE/16 = 256 kHz if fCORE = 4.096 MHz.  
fCORE/32 = 128 kHz if fCORE = 4.096 MHz.  
fCORE/64 = 64 kHz if fCORE = 4.096 MHz.  
fCORE/128 = 32 kHz if fCORE = 4.096 MHz.  
[4:0]  
0xEC to 0xE8 I2CRCT  
0
Configures the length of the I2C received FIFO buffer. The I2C peripheral stops when the  
I2CRCT bits + 1 byte have been read, or if an error occurs.  
Table 153. I2C Slave Address SFR (I2CADR, Address 0xE9)  
Bit  
[7:1]  
0
Mnemonic  
I2CSLVADR  
I2CR_W  
Default  
Description  
0
0
Address of the I2C slave being addressed. Writing to this register starts the I2C transmission (read or write).  
Command bit for read or write. When this bit is set to Logic 1, a read command is transmitted on the  
I2C bus. Data from the slave in the SPI2CRx SFR (Address 0x9B) is expected after a command byte.  
When this bit is set to Logic 0, a write command is transmitted on the I2C bus. Data to slave is expected  
in the SPI2CTx SFR.  
Rev. B | Page 139 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 154. I2C Interrupt Status Register SFR (SPI2CSTAT, Address 0xEA)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default Description  
7
I2CBUSY  
0
0
This bit is set to Logic 1 when the I2C interface is used. When set, the Tx FIFO is emptied.  
6
I2CNOACK  
I2C no acknowledgement transmit interrupt. This bit is set to Logic 1 when the slave device  
does not send an acknowledgement. The I2C communication is stopped after this event.  
Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
5
I2CRxIRQ  
0
0
0
I2C receive interrupt. This bit is set to Logic 1 when the receive FIFO is not empty.  
Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
I2C Transmit Interrupt. This bit is set to Logic 1 when the transmit FIFO is empty.  
Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
4
I2CTxIRQ  
[3:2]  
I2CFIFOSTAT  
Status bits for 3- or 4-bytes deep I2C FIFO. The FIFO monitored in these two bits is the one currently  
used in I2C communication (receive or transmit) because only one FIFO is active at a time.  
I2CFIFOSTAT  
Result  
00  
01  
10  
11  
FIFO empty  
Reserved  
FIFO half full  
FIFO full  
1
0
I2CACC_ERR  
0
0
Set when trying to write and read at the same time. Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
Set when a write was attempted when the I2C transmit FIFO was full. Write a 0 to this bit to clear it.  
I2CTxWR_ERR  
READ AND WRITE OPERATIONS  
1
9
1
9
1
9
SCLK  
A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 R/W  
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0  
SDATA  
START BY  
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0  
ACK BY  
SLAVE  
ACK BY  
MASTER  
NACK BY  
MASTER  
STOP BY  
MASTER  
MASTER  
FRAME 1  
FRAME 2  
DATA BYTE 1 FROM MASTER  
FRAME N + 1  
SERIAL BUS ADDRESS BYTE  
DATA BYTE N FROM SLAVE  
Figure 113. I2C Read Operation  
1
9
1
9
SCLK  
A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 R/W  
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0  
SDATA  
START BY  
ACK BY  
SLAVE  
ACK BY  
SLAVE  
STOP BY  
MASTER  
MASTER  
FRAME 1  
FRAME 2  
DATA BYTE 1 FROM MASTER  
SERIAL BUS ADDRESS BYTE  
Figure 114. I2C Write Operation  
Reading the SPI/I2C Receive Buffer SFR (SPI2CRx,  
Address 0x9B)  
Figure 113 and Figure 114 depict I2C read and write operations,  
respectively. Note that the LSB of the I2CADR SFR is used to  
select whether a read or write operation is performed on the  
slave device. During the read operation, the master acknowledges  
are generated automatically by the I2C peripheral. The master  
generated NACK (no acknowledge) before the end of a read  
operation is also automatically generated after the I2CRCT bits  
have been read from the slave. If the I2CADR register is  
updated during a transmission, instead of generating a stop at  
the end of the read or write operation, the master generates a  
start condition and continues with the next communication.  
Reading the SPI2CRx SFR should be done with a 2-cycle  
instruction, such as  
Mov a, spi2crx or Mov R0, spi2crx.  
A 3-cycle instruction such as  
Mov 3dh, spi2crx  
does not transfer the right data into RAM Address 0x3D.  
Rev. B | Page 140 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
I2C RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT FIFOS  
is full. If the peripheral is reading from a slave address, the  
communication stops when the number of received bytes equals  
the number set in the I2CRCT bits. An error, such as not  
receiving an acknowledge, also causes the communication to  
terminate.  
The I2C peripheral has a 4-byte receive FIFO and a 4-byte  
transmit FIFO. The buffers reduce the overhead associated with  
using the I2C peripheral. Figure 115 shows the operation of the  
I2C receive and transmit FIFOs.  
CODE TO FILL Tx FIFO:  
CODE TO READ Rx FIFO:  
The Tx FIFO can be loaded with four bytes to be transmitted to  
the slave at the beginning of a write operation. When the  
transmit FIFO is empty, the I2C transmit interrupt flag is set,  
and the PC vectors to the I2C interrupt vector if this interrupt is  
enabled. If a new byte is not loaded into the Tx FIFO before it is  
needed in the transmit shift register, the communication stops.  
An error, such as not receiving an acknowledge, also causes the  
communication to terminate. In case of an error during a write  
operation, the Tx FIFO is flushed.  
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
MOV I CTx, TxDATA1  
MOV A, I CRx; RESULT: A = RxDATA1  
MOV I CTx, TxDATA2  
MOV A, I CRx; RESULT: A = RxDATA2  
MOV I CTx, TxDATA3  
MOV A, I CRx; RESULT: A = RxDATA3  
MOV I CTx, TxDATA4  
MOV A, I CRx; RESULT: A = RxDATA4  
2
2
I CRx  
I CTx  
TxDATA4  
TxDATA3  
RxDATA1  
RxDATA2  
4 BYTE FIFO  
4 BYTE FIFO  
TxDATA2  
TxDATA1  
RxDATA3  
RxDATA4  
TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER  
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER  
The Rx FIFO allows four bytes to be read in from the slave  
before the MCU has to read the data. A receive interrupt can  
be generated after each byte is received or when the Rx FIFO  
Figure 115. I2C FIFO Operation  
Rev. B | Page 141 of 152  
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
I/O PORTS  
Weak Internal Pull-Ups Enabled  
PARALLEL I/O  
A pin with weak internal pull-up enabled is used as an input by  
writing a 1 to the pin. The pin is pulled high by the internal pull-  
ups, and the pin is read using the circuitry shown in Figure 116.  
If the pin is driven low externally, it sources current because of  
the internal pull-ups.  
The ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 use three input/output ports to exchange data with  
external devices. In addition to performing general-purpose  
I/O, some are capable of driving an LCD or performing alternate  
functions for the peripherals available on-chip. In general, when  
a peripheral is enabled, the pins associated with it cannot be  
used as a general-purpose I/O. The I/O port can be configured  
through the SFRs listed in Table 155.  
A pin with internal pull-up enabled is used as an output by  
writing a 1 or a 0 to the pin to control the level of the output. If  
a 0 is written to the pin, it drives a logic low output voltage  
(VOL) and is capable of sinking 1.6 mA.  
Table 155. I/O Port SFRs  
Open Drain (Weak Internal Pull-Ups Disabled)  
SFR  
Address Bit Addressable Description  
When the weak internal pull-up on a pin is disabled, the pin  
becomes open drain. Use this open-drain pin as a high impedance  
input by writing a 1 to the pin. The pin is read using the circuitry  
shown in Figure 116. The open-drain option is preferable for  
inputs because it draws less current than the internal pull-ups  
that were enabled.  
P0  
P1  
P2  
EPCFG  
0x80  
0x90  
0xA0  
0x9F  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Port 0 register.  
Port 1 register.  
Port 2 register.  
Extended port  
configuration.  
Port 0 weak  
pull-up enable.  
Port 1 weak  
pull-up enable.  
PINMAP0 0xB2  
PINMAP1 0xB3  
PINMAP2 0xB4  
No  
No  
No  
38 kHz Modulation  
Every ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 provides a 38 kHz modulation signal. The 38 kHz  
modulation is accomplished by internally XOR’ing the level  
written to the I/O pin with a 38 kHz square wave. Then, when  
a 0 is written to the I/O pin, it is modulated as shown in  
Figure 117.  
Port 2 weak  
pull-up enable.  
The three bidirectional I/O ports have internal pull-ups that can  
be enabled or disabled individually for each pin. The internal  
pull-ups are enabled by default. Disabling an internal pull-up  
causes a pin to become open drain. Weak internal pull-ups are  
configured through the PINMAPx SFRs.  
LEVEL WRITTEN  
TO MOD38  
38kHz MODULATION  
SIGNAL  
Figure 116 shows a typical bit latch and I/O buffer for an I/O  
pin. The bit latch (one bit in the SFR of each port) is represented  
as a Type D flip-flop, which clocks in a value from the internal  
bus in response to a write-to-latch signal from the CPU. The  
Q output of the flip-flop is placed on the internal bus in response  
to a read latch signal from the CPU. The level of the port pin  
itself is placed on the internal bus in response to a read pin  
signal from the CPU. Some instructions that read a port activate  
the read latch signal, and others activate the read pin signal. See  
the Read-Modify-Write Instructions section for details.  
OUTPUT AT  
MOD38 PIN  
Figure 117. 38 kHz Modulation  
Uses for this 38 kHz modulation include IR modulation of  
a UART transmit signal or a low power signal to drive an  
LED. The modulation can be enabled or disabled with the  
MOD38EN bit (Bit 4) in the CFG SFR (Address 0xAF). The  
38 kHz modulation is available on eight pins, selected by the  
MOD38[7:0] bits in the extended port configuration SFR  
(EPCFG, Address 0x9F).  
DV  
DD  
INTERNAL  
PULL-UP  
ALTERNATE  
OUTPUT  
FUNCTION  
READ  
LATCH  
CLOSED: PINMAPx.x = 0  
OPEN: PINMAPx.x = 1  
Px.x  
PIN  
INTERNAL  
BUS  
D
Q
Q
WRITE  
TO LATCH  
CL  
LATCH  
READ  
PIN  
ALTERNATE  
INPUT  
FUNCTION  
Figure 116. Port 0 Bit Latch and I/O Buffer  
Rev. B | Page 142 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
I/O REGISTERS  
Table 156. Extended Port Configuration SFR (EPCFG, Address 0x9F)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
MOD38_FP21  
MOD38_FP22  
MOD38_FP23  
MOD38_TxD  
MOD38_CF1  
MOD38_SSb  
MOD38_MISO  
MOD38_CF2  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P1.6/FP21 pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P1.5/FP22 pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P1.4/T2/FP23 pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P1.1/TxD pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P0.2/CF1/RTCCAL pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P0.7/SS/T1 pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P0.5/MISO pin.  
This bit enables 38 kHz modulation on the P0.3/CF2 pin.  
1
0
Table 157. Port 0 Weak Pull-Up Enable SFR (PINMAP0, Address 0xB2)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
PINMAP0.7  
PINMAP0.6  
PINMAP0.5  
PINMAP0.4  
PINMAP0.3  
PINMAP0.2  
PINMAP0.1  
PINMAP0.0  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The weak pull-up on P0.7 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.6 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.5 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.4 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.3 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.2 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.1 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P0.0 is disabled when this bit is set.  
Table 158. Port 1 Weak Pull-Up Enable SFR (PINMAP1, Address 0xB3)  
Bit  
Mnemonic  
PINMAP1.7  
PINMAP1.6  
PINMAP1.5  
PINMAP1.4  
PINMAP1.3  
PINMAP1.2  
PINMAP1.1  
PINMAP1.0  
Default  
Description  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The weak pull-up on P1.7 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.6 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.5 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.4 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.3 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.2 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.1 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P1.0 is disabled when this bit is set.  
Table 159. Port 2 Weak Pull-Up Enable SFR (PINMAP2, Address 0xB4)  
Bit  
[7:6]  
5
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description  
Reserved  
PINMAP2.5  
Reserved  
PINMAP2.3  
PINMAP2.2  
PINMAP2.1  
PINMAP2.0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved. Should be left cleared.  
The weak pull-up on RESET is disabled when this bit is set.  
Reserved. Should be left cleared.  
4
3
2
1
Reserved. Should be left cleared.  
The weak pull-up on P2.2 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P2.1 is disabled when this bit is set.  
The weak pull-up on P2.0 is disabled when this bit is set.  
0
Rev. B | Page 143 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 160. Port 0 SFR (P0, Address 0x80)  
Bit  
Bit Address  
Mnemonic Default  
Description1  
7
0x87  
T1  
T0  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
This bit reflects the state of the P0.7/SS/T1 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.6/SCLK/T0 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.5/MISO pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.4/MOSI/SDATA pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.3/CF2 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.2/CF1 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P0.1/FP19 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the BCTRL/INT1/P0.0 pin. It can be written to or read.  
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x86  
0x85  
0x84  
0x83  
0x82  
0x81  
0x80  
CF2  
CF1  
INT1  
1 When an alternate function is chosen for a pin of this port, the bit controlling this pin should always be set.  
Table 161. Port 1 SFR (P1, Address 0x90)  
Bit  
Bit Address  
Mnemonic Default  
Description1  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x97  
0x96  
0x95  
0x94  
0x93  
0x92  
0x91  
0x90  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
This bit reflects the state of the P1.7/FP20 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.6/FP21 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.5/FP22 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.4/T2/FP23 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.3/T2EX/FP24 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.2/FP25 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.1/TxD pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P1.0/RxD pin. It can be written to or read.  
T2  
T2EX  
TxD  
RxD  
1 When an alternate function is chosen for a pin of this port, the bit controlling this pin should always be set.  
Table 162. Port 2 SFR (P2, Address 0xA0)  
Bit  
[7:4]  
3
Bit Address  
0x97 to 0x94  
0x93  
Mnemonic  
Default  
Description1  
0x1F  
These bits are unused and should remain set.  
P2.3  
P2.2  
P2.1  
P2.0  
1
1
1
1
This bit reflects the state of the P2.3/SDEN pin. It can be written only.  
This bit reflects the state of the P2.2/FP16 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P2.1/FP17 pin. It can be written to or read.  
This bit reflects the state of the P2.0/FP18 pin. It can be written to or read.  
2
0x92  
1
0x91  
0
0x90  
1 When an alternate function is chosen for a pin of this port, the bit controlling this pin should always be set.  
Rev. B | Page 144 of 152  
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Table 163. Port 0 Alternate Functions  
Pin No. Alternate Function  
Alternate Function Enable  
P0.0  
BCTRL external battery control input  
Set INT1PROG = X01 in the interrupt pins configuration SFR (INTPR,  
Address 0xFF).  
INT1 external interrupt  
Set EX1 in the interrupt enable SFR (IE, Address 0xA8).  
INT1 wake-up from PSM2 operating mode  
Set INT1PROG = 11X in the interrupt pins configuration SFR (INTPR,  
Address 0xFF).  
P0.1  
P0.2  
FP19 LCD segment pin  
Set FP19EN in the LCD Segment Enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
CF1 ADE calibration frequency output  
Clear the DISCF1 bit in the ADE energy measurement internal MODE1  
register (Address 0x0B).  
P0.3  
P0.4  
CF2 ADE calibration frequency output  
MOSI SPI data line  
Clear the DISCF2 bit in the ADE energy measurement internal MODE1  
register (Address 0x0B).  
Set the SCPS bit in the configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF) and set the  
SPIEN bit in the SPI configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9).  
SDATA I2C data line  
Clear the SCPS bit in the configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF) and set the  
I2CEN bit in the I2C Mode SFR (I2CMOD, Address 0xE8).  
P0.5  
P0.6  
MISO SPI data line  
Set the SCPS bit in the configuration SFR (CFG, Address 0xAF) and set the  
SPIEN bit in the SPI configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9).  
Set the I2CEN bit in the I2C Mode SFR (I2CMOD, Address 0xE8) or the SPIEN bit  
in the SPI configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9) to enable the I2C or  
SPI interface.  
SCLK serial clock for I2C or SPI  
T0 Timer 0 input  
Set the C/T0 bit in the Timer/Counter 0 and Timer/Counter 1 Mode SFR (TMOD,  
Address 0x89) to enable T0 as an external event counter.  
P0.7  
SS SPI slave select input for SPI in slave mode  
SS SPI slave select output for SPI in master mode  
T1 Timer 1 input  
Set the SS_EN bit in the SPI configuration SFR 1 (SPIMOD1, Address 0xE8).  
Set the SPIMS_b bit in the SPI configuration SFR 2 (SPIMOD2, Address 0xE9).  
Set the C/T1 bit in the timer/counter 0 and timer/counter 1 mode SFR (TMOD,  
Address 0x89) to enable T1 as an external event counter.  
Table 164. Port 1 Alternate Functions  
Pin No. Alternate Function  
Alternate Function Enable  
P1.0  
RxD receiver data input for UART  
Set the REN bit in the serial communications control register bit description  
SFR (SCON, Address 0x98).  
Rx edge wake-up from PSM2 operating mode  
Set RXPROG[1:0] = 11 in the peripheral configuration SFR (PERIPH, Address  
0xF4).  
P1.1  
P1.2  
P1.3  
TxD transmitter data output for UART  
FP25 LCD segment pin  
FP24 LCD segment pin  
T2EX Timer 2 control input  
FP23 LCD segment pin  
T2 Timer 2 input  
This pin becomes TxD as soon as data is written into SBUF.  
Set FP25EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
Set FP24EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
Set EXEN2 in the timer/counter 2 control SFR (T2CON, Address 0xC8).  
Set FP23EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
P1.4  
Set the C/T2 bit in the timer/counter 2 control SFR (T2CON, Address 0xC8) to  
enable T2 as an external event counter.  
P1.5  
P1.6  
P1.7  
FP22 LCD segment pin  
FP21 LCD segment pin  
FP20 LCD segment pin  
Set FP22EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
Set FP21EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
Set FP20EN in the LCD segment enable SFR (LCDSEGE, Address 0x97).  
Table 165. Port 2 Alternate Functions  
Pin No. Alternate Function  
Alternate Function Enable  
P2.0  
P2.1  
P2.2  
P2.3  
FP18 LCD segment pin  
FP17 LCD segment pin  
FP16 LCD segment pin  
Set FP18EN in the LCD segment enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
Set FP17EN in the LCD Segment enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
Set FP16EN in the LCD segment enable 2 SFR (LCDSEGE2, Address 0xED).  
Enabled by default.  
SDEN serial download pin sampled on reset.  
P2.3 is an output only.  
Rev. B | Page 145 of 152  
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
Port 1 pins also have various secondary functions as described  
PORT 0  
in Table 164. The alternate functions of Port 1 pins can be  
activated only if the corresponding bit latch in the Port 1 SFR  
contains a 1. Otherwise, the port pin remains at 0.  
Port 0 is controlled directly through the bit-addressable Port 0  
SFR (P0, Address 0x80). The weak internal pull-ups for Port 0  
are configured through the Port 0 weak pull-up Enable SFR  
(PINMAP0, Address 0xB2); they are enabled by default. The  
weak internal pull-up is disabled by writing a 1 to PINMAP0.x.  
Port 0 pins also have various secondary functions, as described  
in Table 163.  
PORT 2  
Port 2 is a 4-bit bidirectional port controlled directly through  
the bit-addressable Port 2 SFR (P2, Address 0xA0). Note that  
P2.3 can be used as an output only. Consequently, any read  
operation, such as a CPL P2.3, cannot be executed on this I/O.  
The weak internal pull-ups for Port 2 are configured through  
the Port 2 weak pull-up enable SFR (PINMAP2, Address 0xB4);  
they are enabled by default. The weak internal pull-up is  
disabled by writing a 1 to PINMAP2.x.  
The alternate functions of Port 0 pins can be activated only if  
the corresponding bit latch in the Port 0 SFR contains a 1.  
Otherwise, the port pin remains at 0.  
PORT 1  
Port 1 is an 8-bit bidirectional port controlled directly through  
the bit-addressable Port 1 SFR (P1, Address 0x90). The weak  
internal pull-ups for Port 1 are configured through the Port 1  
weak pull-up enable SFR (PINMAP1, Address 0xB3); they are  
enabled by default. The weak internal pull-up is disabled by  
writing a 1 to PINMAP1.x.  
Port 2 pins also have various secondary functions as described  
in Table 165. The alternate functions of Port 2 pins can be  
activated only if the corresponding bit latch in the Port 2 SFR  
contains a 1. Otherwise, the port pin remains at 0.  
Rev. B | Page 146 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
DETERMINING THE VERSION OF THE PART  
Each ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/  
ADE7569 holds in its internal flash registers a value that defines  
its version. This value helps to determine whether users have the  
latest version of the part. The version of the ADE7116/ADE7156/  
ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569 that corresponds to  
this data sheet is ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/  
ADE7566/ADE7569 V3.4.  
This value can be accessed as follows:  
1. Launch HyperTerminal with a 9600 baud rate.  
2. Put the part in serial download mode by first holding  
SDEN  
to logic low, then resetting the part.  
SDEN  
3. Hold the  
pin.  
RESET  
4. Press and release the  
pin.  
A string should appear on the HyperTerminal screen containing  
the part name and version number, for example, ADE7116V3.4,  
ADE7156V3.4, ADE7166V3.4, ADE7169V3.4, ADE7566V3.4,  
or ADE7569V3.4.  
Rev. B | Page 147 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
OUTLINE DIMENSIONS  
12.20  
12.00 SQ  
11.80  
0.75  
0.60  
0.45  
1.60  
MAX  
64  
49  
1
48  
PIN 1  
10.20  
10.00 SQ  
9.80  
TOP VIEW  
(PINS DOWN)  
1.45  
1.40  
1.35  
0.20  
0.09  
7°  
3.5°  
0°  
0.08  
COPLANARITY  
16  
33  
0.15  
0.05  
SEATING  
PLANE  
17  
32  
VIEW A  
0.27  
0.22  
0.17  
0.50  
BSC  
LEAD PITCH  
VIEW A  
ROTATED 90° CCW  
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MS-026-BCD  
Figure 118. 64-Lead Low Profile Quad Flat Package [LQFP]  
(ST-64-2)  
Dimensions shown in millimeters  
0.30  
0.25  
0.18  
9.00  
BSC SQ  
0.60 MAX  
0.60 MAX  
PIN 1  
INDICATOR  
64  
49  
48  
1
PIN 1  
INDICATOR  
*
4.85  
4.70 SQ  
4.55  
8.75  
BSC SQ  
TOP  
VIEW  
EXPOSED PAD  
(BOTTOM VIEW)  
0.50  
33  
32  
16  
0.40  
0.30  
17  
7.50  
REF  
0.80 MAX  
0.65 TYP  
1.00  
0.85  
0.80  
12° MAX  
FOR PROPER CONNECTION OF  
THE EXPOSED PAD, REFER TO  
THE PIN CONFIGURATION AND  
FUNCTION DESCRIPTIONS  
0.05 MAX  
0.02 NOM  
SEATING  
PLANE  
SECTION OF THIS DATA SHEET.  
0.50 BSC  
0.20 REF  
*
COMPLIANT TO JEDEC STANDARDS MO-220-VMMD-4  
EXCEPT FOR EXPOSED PAD DIMENSION  
Figure 119. 64-Lead Lead Frame Chip Scale Package [LFCSP_VQ]  
9 mm × 9 mm Body, Very Thin Quad  
(CP-64-1)  
Dimensions shown in millimeters  
Rev. B | Page 148 of 152  
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
ORDERING GUIDE  
Anti-  
Tamper Interface  
di/dt Sensor  
Temperature  
Flash (kB) Range  
Package  
Option  
Model1  
ADE7116ASTZF162,  
VAR  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Package Description  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
3,  
4
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
16  
16  
8
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
−40°C to +85°C  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
CP-64-1  
CP-64-1  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ST-64-2  
ADE7116ASTZF16-RL2, 3, 4  
ADE7116ASTZF82, 3, 4  
ADE7116ASTZF8-RL2, 3, 4  
ADE7156ASTZF162, 4  
ADE7156ASTZF16-RL2, 4  
ADE7156ASTZF82, 4  
ADE7156ASTZF8-RL2, 4  
ADE7166ACPZF82  
ADE7166ACPZF8-RL2  
ADE7166ACPZF162  
ADE7166ACPZF16-RL2  
ADE7166ASTZF82  
ADE7166ASTZF8-RL2  
ADE7166ASTZF162  
ADE7166ASTZF16-RL2  
ADE7169ACPZF162  
ADE7169ACPZF16-RL2  
ADE7169ASTZF82  
ADE7169ASTZF8-RL2  
ADE7169ASTZF162  
ADE7169ASTZF16-RL2  
ADE7566ACPZF82  
ADE7566ACPZF8-RL2  
ADE7566ACPZF162  
ADE7566ACPZF16-RL2  
ADE7566ASTZF82  
ADE7566ASTZF8-RL2  
ADE7566ASTZF162  
ADE7566ASTZF16-RL2  
ADE7569ACPZF162  
ADE7569ACPZF16-RL2  
ADE7569ASTZF82  
ADE7569ASTZF8-RL2  
ADE7569ASTZF162  
ADE7569ASTZF16-RL2  
ADE8052Z-PRG12  
ADE8052Z-DWDL12  
ADE8052Z-EMUL12  
EVAL-ADE7169F16EBZ2  
EVAL-ADE7569F16EBZ2  
8
16  
16  
8
8
8
8
16  
16  
8
8
16  
16  
16  
16  
8
8
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
16  
16  
8
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ  
64-Lead LFCSP_VQ, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
64-Lead LQFP  
64-Lead LQFP, Reel  
ADE Programmer  
ADE Downloader  
ADE Emulator  
8
16  
16  
8
8
16  
16  
16  
16  
8
8
16  
16  
Evaluation Board  
Evaluation Board  
1 All models have W + VA + rms, 5 V LCD, and RTC.  
2 Z = RoHS Compliant Part.  
3 The ADE7116 does not support battery and temperature ADC measurements.  
4 The ADE7116 and the ADE7156 do not have internally adjustable LCD levels.  
Rev. B | Page 149 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
NOTES  
Rev. B | Page 150 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
NOTES  
Rev. B | Page 151 of 152  
ADE7116/ADE7156/ADE7166/ADE7169/ADE7566/ADE7569  
NOTES  
Purchase of licensed I2C components of Analog Devices or one of its sublicensed Associated Companies conveys a license for the purchaser under the Philips I2C Patent  
Rights to use these components in an I2C system, provided that the system conforms to the I2C Standard Specification as defined by Philips.  
©2007–2008 Analog Devices, Inc. All rights reserved. Trademarks and  
registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
D06353-0-11/08(B)  
Rev. B | Page 152 of 152  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

相关型号:

SI9130DB

5- and 3.3-V Step-Down Synchronous Converters

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1-E3

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135_11

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9136_11

Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130CG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130LG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130_11

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137DB

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137LG

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9122E

500-kHz Half-Bridge DC/DC Controller with Integrated Secondary Synchronous Rectification Drivers

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY